0 0 Pearson Education Ltd Edinburgh Gate Harlow Essex CM20 2JE England and Associated Companies throughout the world. www.pearsonelt.com © Pearson Education Limited 2014 The right of Chris Sowton and David Albery to be identified as the authors of this Work has been asserted by them in accordance with the Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988. All rights reserved; no part of this publication may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or otherwise without the prior written permission of the Publishers. First published 2014 ISBN 978-1-4479-4842-1 Photocopiable activities only Illustrations by: Kathy Baxendale; Beehive Illustration (Roger Wade-Walker) The Publisher grants permission for the photocopying of those pages marked ‘photocopiable’ according to the following conditions. Individual purchasers may make copies for their own use or for use by the classes they teach. Institutional purchasers may make copies for use by their staff and students, but this permission does not extend to additional institutions or branches. Under no circumstances may any part of this book be photocopied for resale. 0 0 NEW LANGUAGE LEADER UPPER INTERMEDIATE TEACHER’S NOTES INTRODUCTION Teacher’s notes: Chris Sowton and David Albery Course authors: David Cotton, David Falvey and Simon Kent 0 0 How language is developed INTRODUCTION FROM THE AUTHORS Welcome to New Language Leader. In this introduction we outline some of our ideas about the course and introduce you to the features of the new edition. We have done our best to create course materials that teachers and students will enjoy using, and to enhance the new edition with improvements and exciting new features. We very much hope that we share with you – as teachers – a common set of beliefs and practices, and a common sense of purpose. Our approach New Language Leader is an international course with a global focus, and is aimed at citizens of the 21st century world – people who cross (and communicate across) national borders. We believe that students are curious about the modern world, and that this course engages with it. New Language Leader enables students to be better informed and helps them understand and express their ideas and feelings about the world. Whilst the course is designed for anyone who appreciates a content-rich, intelligent approach to learning, it is particularly suited for students in universities, other higher education institutions, and students preparing for university study (for example, on foundation or other ‘university pathway’ courses). New Language Leader is not a course in English for Academic Purposes: however, it contains ‘general English with an academic flavour’ and can help students cross the ‘bridge’ from General English to being able to use English in a more specialised academic context. We believe it is important to offer students stimulating topics that engage their interest and increase their motivation for learning. As authors, we have made use of our diverse backgrounds, personalities and interests to provide students with a rich variety of different topics. Each unit contains an ‘umbrella topic’ with a different subtopic in each lesson, allowing us to explore a range of issues within a single topic and also to recycle vocabulary. The intelligent approach to the topics in the course is intended to challenge students and allow them to develop their powers of expression and analysis – and in particular, their critical thinking skills. New Language Leader reflects our belief that language learning is not merely a form of training, but should be situated in a broader educational context. We hope that students who use the series will not only learn English, but – through English – will also learn interesting things about the world and about themselves. These insights should be transferable to the world of academic studies and employment. New Language Leader is based on a broadly communicative approach, with language contextualised in texts and a task-based approach to practice and language exploration. Pair and group work is an important part of the learning process. The Common European Framework and the Global Scale of English has informed many of the speaking activities. Throughout the units, there is careful development and logical staging of new language, as well as substantial recycling of previous language, enabling students to move forward rapidly. The Language Reference and Extra Practice sections consolidate and extend students’ learning, as do the activities available on the MyEnglishLab. The texts in New Language Leader not only provide context for grammar and vocabulary, but also systematically develop students’ reading and listening skills. The reading texts are authentic or semi-authentic, or at lower levels based on real sources, and are taken from a variety of genres (for example, newspapers, magazines, literature and publicity materials). Listening skills are also developed throughout the course. Each unit has a number of listening activities and there is a wide variety of different listening texts (for example, radio programmes, conversations, interviews, talks and lectures), as well as a varied range of activity types. There is considerable variety in the length of these reading and listening texts: some are relatively short, but New Language Leader also offers students an opportunity to deal – in a supported way – with some longer texts. Students who suddenly find themselves in an English-speaking environment – whether in their home country or abroad – often have difficulty with the large quantities of spoken and written English that they are exposed to. This course helps them to build up their confidence in handling extended amounts of English. In addition, many of the reading and listening exercises are based on exam-type questions, including task types from IELTS (International English Language Testing System) and PTE-A (Pearson Test of English – Academic), major global tests of English used in university entrance contexts. There are constant opportunities throughout the course for students to improve their speaking skills, with speaking activities in every lesson. Students can comment on the topics and discuss the issues that arise, as well as talk about more personal experiences and knowledge, through a variety of activities, such as information gaps, personalised question and answer activities, role plays and debates. The Scenario lessons are an important communicative feature of New Language Leader. Every unit includes a Scenario lesson, devoted to extended speaking practice in a real-life situation. Information has to be processed – and decisions made – leading to a specific outcome. Students are given support to carry out the task, including a pretask listening activity and a focus on key language. The course contains comprehensive coverage of the key English grammar. Grammar is contextualised and students are encouraged to analyse and understand grammar through an inductive approach with reference to examples in reading and listening texts. The grammar is practised in motivating and interesting activities. The Language reference and Extra practice section at the back of the book extends students’ knowledge of grammar and provides further practice. These sections can be used in class or for independent study at home. Lack of vocabulary is one of the main problems many students face. Consequently, students struggle to make 2 0 0 sense of texts and express themselves. Put simply, they need more words, and this need is especially acute in a university context, with the additional demands of subject study. New Language Leader has a wide range of vocabulary, contextualised in texts and recycled through the course. The Language Reference section now identifies not only words taught in vocabulary activities, but other vocabulary occurring in the course which is intended to become part of the students’ active vocabulary. Critical thinking, critical reading, and critical listening In the new edition, the skills work has been enhanced with additional activities which focus on important academic and career skills such as critical thinking, critical reading, and critical listening. These are flagged up in the Coursebook with a sub-heading in the task instructions, in green, identifying the skill that students are developing: whether that is reacting authentically to the text, identifying its genre, exploring the assumptions made by the author, paraphrasing key ideas, offering an alternative point of view, and so on. These activities aim to make the students more aware as learners of the skills they bring to texts, and also to help learn to read and listen – even in a foreign language – in a more personally engaged, purposeful, and questioning way. A high value is placed on the ability to handle texts in this way in many academic and university contexts. Indeed, it is sometimes the case that learners finish a university foundation course with excellent English, but remain unable to participate meaningfully in academic life, because they have not developed the ability to engage with texts in this more critical fashion. Writing skills and Study skills Writing in English is often a student’s weakest skill. Even with very able students, it often drags down their scores in examinations in which they would otherwise perform well. It is, however, an essential skill for university students, as well as in many employment contexts. We consider that writing is a skill in which – with a little help – students can make significant progress. New Language Leader has a page in every unit that is devoted to the development of writing skills, and there are also further writing activities throughout the course. Because of the systematic approach to the development of writing skills in the course, students should be able to make real progress in their writing, and derive great satisfaction from this. Again, there is a wide variety in the length and type of tasks. We place considerable emphasis, even at the lower levels, on discourse features of written English, with frequent analysis of text models and plenty of writing practice at both paragraph and text level. In addition, we have included activities designed to encourage students to be rigorous in checking their own writing. Each unit also includes a Study Skills page, which encourages students to be independent learners with a high level of self-awareness. The skills that we cover in this section are not just for students who are on educational courses in universities, colleges and schools; they are also transferable skills which will be useful to students in many different contexts, including their careers and personal lives. Study Skills are not just about the written language, and in the new edition, three of the Study Skills sections at each level are based on video clips (see below). 0 Flexibility Of course, we hope that your teaching context allows you to use every page in the book! But the New Language Leader format can lend itself to different teaching situations and can be adapted easily depending on the length and type of course you are teaching. Teachers are best placed to decide on these adaptations for their own context, but for shorter courses, you might consider setting longer reading work, Meet the Expert video viewings, and Writing Skills work as homework, and use classroom time to focus more on the development of speaking skills, including the motivating, extended Scenarios. To conclude, we trust that you and your students will find New Language Leader interesting, motivating and enjoyable. We also hope that it will meet your students’ needs as well as providing something new. We welcome your comments on the course and hope to have the pleasure of meeting you in the future. David Cotton, David Falvey, Simon Kent (Intermediate, Upper Intermediate, and Advanced) Gareth Rees, Ian Lebeau (Elementary, Pre-intermediate, and Advanced) COURSE DESCRIPTION New Language Leader is a general English series for adults and young adults. The course has a topic-based multi-strand syllabus which includes comprehensive work on grammar, vocabulary, pronunciation and the four skills. A significant emphasis is placed on reading, writing and study skills (suitable for learners in a university or university ‘pathway’ context) as well as speaking and listening. New Language Leader has five levels and takes learners from Elementary to Advanced. Each level offers 90 – 120 hours of work in the Coursebook, including the Meet the Expert video materials. COMPONENTS OF NEW LANGUAGE LEADER Coursebook The twelve Coursebook units are divided into doublepage lessons, each with clear aims, which are designed to make the course flexible and easy-to-use. • Introduction lesson: in New Language LeaderUpper Intermediate the first spread is where the unit topic is presented with core vocabulary and lexis through reading and listening texts, and where students discuss some of the themes of the unit and activate any previous knowledge and vocabulary. • Input lessons: there are two further input lessons in each unit (Lessons 2 & 3 in each unit). Here, new language is presented through informative texts with a balanced mix of grammar, vocabulary, pronunciation and skills work. • Scenario: in the fourth lesson, learners integrate and practise the language presented in the previous lessons through a more extended communicative task. This major speaking activity is carefully staged; the Key language section gives extra support by 3 0 developing functional exponents. The final Task is where students are really challenged to use English at the limits of their competence and – through careful preparation and post-task reflection – to become more proficient and confident users of the language • Study and Writing Skills: the fifth lesson consists of a Study skills section, followed by Writing skills, which helps students to write a text in a particular genre (frequently based on a familiar academic text genre, of the kind required in exams such as IELTS). At the back of the Coursebook, you will find: • Language reference/ Extra practice: this section consists of one cross-referenced spread for each unit. The left-hand page includes a grammar summary for the unit, plus reference lists for Key language and Vocabulary. The right-hand page provides extra practice for consolidation. As with all truly unscripted, authentic material, the language level of the interviews will be found challenging by some classes, but we feel that the authenticity of the interview is a powerful motivator to understanding, and the judicious use of transcripts, and splitting the material into shorter chunks, will help students who are in difficulty. The importance of exposure to real English speech is clear: many users of New Language Leader will have a pressing need to understand authentic speech on academic topics, and many others will already be familiar with authentic English-language video online. In Upper Intermediate the Meet the Expert clips are: Unit and lesson Description 2 Environment Dr Andrew McGonigle, a volcanologist, gives a talk about the importance of understanding active volcanoes and different ways of preventing eruptions. 2.3 Extreme environment • Communication activities: supporting material for the information-gap, role-play and similar tasks used throughout the course. • Meet the Expert: material accompanying video clips (see below). 3 Sport 3.3 Getting to the top| • Audio scripts: transcripts of all the audio used in the course. Video materials New Language Leader is enhanced with two entirely new strands of video-based content which bring topics to life and develop important learner skills. The video clips for the course are available on the teacher and student resource sites, as well as on the Teacher’s eText for IWB and the Students’ eText Coursebook. Activities for using the video in class are in the Coursebook, and there are additional video activities on the MyEnglishLab. The materials in the Coursebook focus on the engaging content of the video, while the activities on the MyEnglishLab explore the language further. 4 Medicine 4.3 Bionic Eye 5 Transport 5.3 Great railway journeys 7 Architecture Every unit of the course contains a video clip, and there are two distinct strands of video material. 7.1 Iconic buildings Meet the Expert 8 Globalisation In nine units, there is an authentic video interview with an expert from a field of work related to the unit topic. The purpose of these interviews is to bring the topic to life, provide fresh angles, realistic spoken models of language use, and allow students to relate the topics they have been studying to their possible future fields of academic study or careers. Many of the interviewees are leading academics in their fields giving insights into their research and others are major authors or figures in their professions. They have all been selected first and foremost for the fresh angles they can provide on the topics and because they have something to say which will be new to the learners. Freestanding classroom activities (approximately 45 minutes of additional classroom material per clip) are provided in the back of the Coursebook. These are signposted prominently at the end of the main lesson the clip accompanies. This is the recommended point at which classes could use the clips, although teachers may vary this, for example using the clip at the beginning of the relevant lesson as a lead-in. 8.1 Globalisation – good or bad? 9 Art 9.3 Contemporary sculptors 10 Pyschology 10.3 Pyschology at work 11 Cultures 11.3 Understanding cultures Dr Elizabeth Pummell, a sports psychologist, talks about the science of sports Psychology and how different mental techniques can enhance athletes’ performance and promote well-being. Dr Tina Chowdhury, a lecturer in Musculoskeletal Science, talks about medical bionics i.e. products that mimic the functionality of the human body. Monisha Rajesh, a journalist and travel writer, talks about a spectacular train journey she made around India. Laura Mark, an architectural journalist, talks about one of her favourite buildings, the Sesc Pompeia in Sao Paulo, Brazil. Richard Cook, a consultant and coach, talks about the different issues involved in working in a global business environment. Yulia Podolska, a sculptor who grew up in Ukraine, talks about her work and influences. Dr Jack Lewis, a neuroscientist, talks about his work and experience of studying the human brain. Anna Colquhoun, a culinary anthropologist and food writer, talks about the impact of our cultural surroundings on our food, taste and ideas. 4 0 0 TEACHER’S ONLINE RESOURCES Study Skills video In three of the units (Units 1, 6 and 12) the video clip accompanies the Study Skills section, and focuses on key skills students need for English studies, academic life and careers (listening to lectures and talks; making presentations; understanding and taking part in group discussions). Each of these clips provides a model for the students to view and analyse, and the accompanying material focuses attention on the language used and the communication skills on display (including non-verbal communication, such as gesture and body language). In these units, the video material is integrated into the core lesson, rather than being in the back of the Coursebook. In Upper Intermediate, the Study Skills clips are: Unit and lesson Description 1 Communication Students watch a lecture about public speaking, practise taking notes and reflect on the advice the speaker gives about ways to structure a presentation and conquer nerves. 1.5 Taking notes while listening 6 Literature and film 6.5 Making an effective presentation 12 Technology 12.5 Following a panel discussion Students watch a presentation at a university film society, reflect on the rhetorical techniques used by the presenter and then make their own short presentations. Students watch a panel discussion about plagiarism, make notes about the main reasons for plagiarising and discuss the difference between acceptable paraphrasing and plagiarism. Audio The audio material which accompanies the Coursebook can be streamed or downloaded from the teacher and student resource sites. The class audio is also available to purchase as audio CDs. MYENGLISHLAB MyEnglishLab is Pearson’s easy to use Learning Management System, now on a new, improved software platform. The New Language Leader Intermediate MyEnglishLab provides over 300 interactive activities, focusing on grammar, vocabulary, pronunciation and the four skills, in a media-rich environment, with plenty of audio and video support. MyEnglishLab gives students instant, targeted feedback, including answer-specific hints and tips to help them work out language points for themselves. Students and teachers alike can easily track their progress through the grade book. Teachers can assign tasks easily, monitor task completion and performance across their classes, and create Common Error reports enabling them to focus on class and individual weaknesses and strengths. In addition to the practice activities, teachers can also assign all the course tests and assessments through the MyEnglishLab. The teacher’s resource site contains all the support teachers need: detailed teaching notes which accompany the course; extra photocopiable activities; class audio and video; a comprehensive testing and assessment package. Teacher’s Notes There are warning points to alert teachers about possible problem areas as well as teaching tips to help them. Taking into account teachers’ busy schedules, the Teacher’s Notes are designed as lesson plans, with ideas for extension and adjustment, which are especially useful for mixed ability groups. There are also suggestions for adapting material to focus on academic English, or on exams skills. warning points extension teaching tips adjustment academic English focus exams skills focus Testing and Assessment package New Language Leader contains a comprehensive testing and assessment package. Printable, photocopiable tests are contained on the teacher’s resource site with full instructions for their use. There is a short Achievement Test for each unit, which has grammar, vocabulary and integrated skills sections. For a more developed assessment of students there is a Mid-course Assessment, to be carried out after the students have completed units 1-6 of the course, and an End-ofcourse Assessment, to be carried out after units 7–12. The two major Assessments are based on descriptors from the Global Scale of English, and they test Reading, Listening, Language Use, Writing and Speaking separately. The sections of these Assessments can be split out and used over several lessons if preferred. For teachers using the MyEnglishLab with their classes, the full testing and assessment package is also available on the MyEnglishLab. This takes a significant marking chore away from the teacher, as it is scored automatically within the MyEnglishLab – apart from the mid-course and end of course Writing and Speaking tests, which are submitted to the teacher for moderation. SYLLABUS AREAS Topics: the units are based on up-to-date topics of international interest or new angles on familiar subjects and many of the texts have been substantially revised for the new edition. Themes have been carefully chosen to engage the learners and to provide a springboard for their own ideas and communicative needs. The video material is completely new for the new edition. Grammar: New Language Leader follows an established syllabus progression and learners are actively involved in developing their knowledge of grammar. The Grammar sections in the input lessons focus on the main language 5 0 0 points presented through the texts and learners are encouraged to work out the rules for themselves. They are supported by the Grammar tip boxes and cross-referred to the corresponding Language reference and Extra practice pages at the back of the book for reinforcement. Vocabulary: vocabulary input is derived from the unit topics and texts, allowing the teacher to build on words and phrases the students already know to create lexical sets. Additional attention is paid to word building and lexical patterns. The vocabulary is recycled through the speaking activities in each unit, revised in the Extra practice and practised further in the MyEnglishLab. Pronunciation: regular pronunciation sections are integrated with the presentation of new language or included on the Scenario spread as part of the communicative task. The pronunciation syllabus covers word and sentence stress, difficult sounds, contractions and intonation. Reading: there is a wide range of reading material in New Language Leader and a variety of exercise types developing the reading skills. The informative texts have been chosen for their interest and to provide a context for the grammar and vocabulary items being studied. The texts are based on real-life sources (magazines, websites, etc) and related activities include comprehension, vocabulary and reading sub-skills work, as well as a strong focus on critical reading (see above). ALIGNED WITH GLOBAL LANGUAGE SCALES AND EXAMINATIONS Common European Framework of Reference: the ethos of the CEFR is reflected throughout New Language Leader in a variety of ways. For example, the outcomes of the Scenario lessons reflect the ‘Can do’ descriptors and help students use the language they have learnt effectively. Also, great emphasis is placed on the development of independent learning across the course including the extensive work on study skills, good study habits and self-assessment. The Global Scale of English: New Language Leader is informed by the descriptors of the Global Scale of English, which sets out detailed descriptions of language skills and competence on a scale, aligned to the CEFR, from 10 to 90. Link to examinations: New Language Leader can be used to help prepare students for a range of common exams, especially those used internationally for university entrance. Activities in the Coursebook, the MyEnglishLab and the Testing and Assessment package reflect task types used in IELTS (International English Language Testing System) and PTE-A (Pearson Test of English – Academic). The Teacher’s Notes also contain regular suggestions for lightly adapting course material for exams-focused classes. Listening: students are given many opportunities to develop a wide range of listening skills in New Language Leader, both in terms of text types and activity types (e.g. checking predictions, table and note-completion). Students have access to class audio for additional practice, and there is more listening practice on the MyEnglishLab to further build the learners’ confidence. Speaking: opportunities for oral practice of language and freer discussion appear regularly in every lesson. There is at least one speaking activity per lesson (and more opportunities for speaking embedded in other activities), and a major communicative task in the Scenario lesson. Many of the speaking and discussion activities are designed to engage students’ critical thinking skills. Writing: the writing syllabus introduces students to different genres and develops students’ writing through analysis of models and practice in producing different text styles. Study skills: a systematic approach to developing study skills fosters independent dictionary use, gives students help in approaching exams, learning outside the classroom, taking part in discussions, taking notes in lectures, giving presentations, and so on. 6 0 0 HOW A UNIT WORKS (UPPER INTERMEDIATE) Introduction & input lesson The contents of each unit are clearly labelled at the top of the opening page. 2 Environment LOCAL ENVIRONMENT 4 Collocations Underline the main stress in each collocation in Exercise 3. Then listen and check. IN THIS UNIT 2.2 Noisy neighbours and all the things that drive us mad READING GRAMMAR • pre s e nt pe rfe ct s imple and co ntinuo us • indire ct que s tio ns 5 Work with a partner and discuss this list of problems. Which are the worst, do you think? Can you add any others? VOCABULARY • lo cal e nviro nme nt co llo catio ns • the e nviro nme nt • adve rbs • • • • • SCENARIO • ag re e ing and dis ag re e ing po lite ly, po lite que s tio ns • atte nding a fo rmal me e ting Stimulating topic-related quotation to engage learners. noise from traffic people drinking in the street young people/children misbehaving abandoned vehicles noise from neighbours BY ROSS LYDALL Noisy neighbours, uncollected litter and graffiti are among the things that really annoy us, according to a new survey. The findings come from a Mori poll of more than 2,000 residents in three UK cities – London, Dundee and Newcastle. • graffiti • litter/rubbish • dog mess • vandalism The government-commissioned survey revealed that other issues, such as dog mess and abandoned vehicles, also cause so much anxiety that they can affect our quality of life. Designed to measure how people respond to noise, the survey also established the extent to which we are troubled by other anti-social problems. 6 Read the article and answer the questions. How many people took part in the survey? Which groups of people have a particular problem with noisy neighbours? 3 According to the survey, how many people have protested to their local government, the police or to their neighbours? 4 According to the article, why is transport noise not a bigger problem? 1 2 STUDY SKILLS • de s ig ning a que s tio nnaire WRITING SKILLS • writing a que s tio nnaire Match words or phrases in the article with their meaning s 1–8. 1 results (paragraph 1) 2 survey (paragraph 1) 3 subjects often discussed or argued about (paragraph 2) 4 size/level (paragraph 3) 5 become unaffected by (paragraph 4) 6 closely connected with (paragraph 4) 7 not thinking about other people’s feelings (paragraph 4) 8 something very important (paragraph 5) The enviro nment is everything which isn’t me. Albert Einstein, 1879–1955, German-born physicist 3 Complete collocations 1–20 with the words in the boxes. Listen ag ain to check. LOCAL ENVIRONMENT COLLOCATIONS Vocabulary exercises present and practise topicspecific lexis. 1 1 Work with a partner and answer the questions. What sort of area do you live in? Choose words from the box. urban rural suburban residential traditional smart inner-city coastal up-and-coming long-established recently developed 2 How would you describe your area to a visitor? 2 2.1 Listen to three people taking part in a survey about their local area. Complete the table. 1 2 3 Type of building atmosphere hour rate environment 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 abandoned friendly transport renewable Where they live Problems area points pollution activities The study – carried out for the Department for Environment, Food and Rural Affairs – found that loud music, shouting and banging attracted far more complaints than noisy parties. As many as two in five people annoyed by noise have complained to their council or the police, while one in four have complained directly to neighbours. The survey finds that while people are able to develop ‘immunity’ to traffic and trains, they see neighbourhood noise as being synonymous with a ‘lack of consideration’. The Environment Minister said tackling noise pollution was a government priority. 7b Match the hig hlig hted phrases in the article with functions 1–4. 1 2 3 4 introduce who asked for the survey (2 phrases) gives the purpose of the survey (1 phrase) compare two results of the survey (2 phrases) introduce facts from the survey (3 phrases) 8a Identifying similarities and differences Look ag ain at the facts in the article and make notes on the similarities and differences between the article and your country in g eneral, and your local area. apartment mindlesss environmental urban 8b traffic open Writing exercises practise short contextualised text construction. Work with a partner to summarise your ideas. SPEAKING AND WRITING neighbourhood spaces connections vandalism congestion energy issue cars block environment 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 What they like house farm detached rush desirable noise natural wind cultural cosmopolitan crime recycling Pronunciation exercises cover problem areas related to the vocabulary being studied. While almost one in three people said noisy neighbours were a problem, they placed it eighth on a list of what troubled them most. They were more than twice as concerned about litter and rubbish – the main problem to affect their quality of life. They said noise was a problem of similar scale to abandoned cars and drinking in the street. However, the effect of noisy neighbours ranked much more highly among residents already dissatisfied with their home – jumping to second place. It is also the second biggest quality-of-life issue among residents in medium- or high-rise flats. 7a LISTENING AND VOCABULARY 2.1 PRONUNCIATION 2.1 LOCAL ENVIRONMENT 9 Work with a partner to discuss solutions to the problems you identified in Exercise 5. 10 Write a parag raph summarising your solution to one of the problems. 16 17 Input lesson (1) The informative reading text provides a context for the language and vocabulary being studied. 2.2 CHANGING ENVIRONMENT CHANGING ENVIRONMENT Climate change impacts READING AND VOCABULARY 2.2 GRAMMAR PRESENT PERFECT SIMPLE AND CONTINUOUS 1 Work in g roups and discuss these questions. Can you give an example of extreme weather in your country? 2 What are the causes of climate change? 3 What effects of global warming can be seen today? 1 2 1 2 3 4 5 a b c d e Reading exercises aid comprehension of the text and develop skills. f g h i j Match words 1–10 with their meaning s a–j. emissions 6 habitat fossil fuels 7 ecosystem deforestation 8 glaciers species 9 drought extinction 10 famine a group of animals or plants of the same kind when a type of animal or plant stops existing the natural environment in which a plant or animal lives a long period of weather when there is not enough water fuels such as coal or oil that are produced by animals or plants decaying over millions of years when a large number of people have little food for a long time and some people die all the animals and plants in an area and their relationship to each other and their environment substances that are sent out into the air a large mass of ice that moves slowly down a mountain valley when all the trees in an area are destroyed T he e ffe cts o f warming o n o ur wo rld can be se e n to d ay 1 Loss of species Coral whitening Thousands of species risk extinction from disappearing habitat and changing ecosystem s. According to the IPCC, clim ate change will put som e 20–30 percent of species globally at an increasingly high risk of extinction, possibly by 2100. Coral reefs are highly sensitive to sm all changes in water tem perature. Heat causes corals to lose the algae that feed them , which leaves coral white. Continued warm ing could cause coral whitening to becom e an annual event within the next few decades, destroying m any reef ecosystem s. 1 The US Geological Survey reports that slight changes in the clim ate m ay result in sudden changes in ecosystem s. These m ay be im possible to reverse. The Rocky Mountains in Canada and the US have been losing their forests at a worrying rate since 2000 due to the increase of tree-killing insects. Arctic sea ice is the polar bear's feeding habitat. As sea ice disappears, the death rate of bears rises. The US Geological Survey has warned that two-thirds of the world's polar bear populations could be lost by the m id-century as sea ice continues to retreat. f g h i j 3 4 A recent IPCC report predicts that sea levels could rise 25–38 centim etres by 2100 if current warm ing patterns continue. 5 A 2005 survey of 442 glaciers from the World Glacier Monitoring Service found that 90 percent of the world's glaciers are shrinking as the planet warm s. 4 Read the article ag ain and decide what these numbers refer to. 1.1–6.4 20–30 90 2000–2009 Critical thinking tasks encourage students to analyse and react to the text. two-thirds 50 2005 Threats to people around the globe 442 Extrem e weather will becom e m ore frequent – and m ore dangerous. The World Meteorological Organisation reported that 2000–2009 was the hottest decade on record, with eight of the hottest 10 years having occurred since 2000. 5 Identifying sources Underline all the sources in the article and answer the questions. 1 What information are they linked to? 2 What phrase (e.g. according to) is used? 6 1 2 3 4 Thinning ice, rising seas Satellite im ages show that the extent of Arctic sum m er sea ice has been m elting at an increasing rate and alm ost 9 percent of it has disappeared per decade since 1979. More wildfires Sea level rise Increased flooding More intense hurricanes Threats to forests 6 The recent IPCC report concludes that very heavy rain has increased in frequency during the last 50 years and that global warm ing has been a factor. Work with a partner and discuss the questions. Which of the effects of global warming do you think is the most dramatic? If you could save one species at threat from extinction (e.g. polar bears, tigers, gorillas, giant pandas), which would it be? ‘Global warming is a myth.’ Do you agree? What can people do to be more environmentally friendly? 2 3 4 5 2 Rising seas are one of the m ost certain effects of global warm ing, as warm ing ocean waters expand and m elting glaciers, ice caps and ice sheets add m ore water to the oceans. Read the article and complete g aps 1–8 with heading s a–j. There are two extra heading s. Melting glaciers Spread of disease Arctic sea ice is shrinking Decline in polar bears Increased drought Read these sentences that describe a similar situation and answer the questions. a I’ve been working for the US Geological Survey for the last three months on a temporary contract. b I’ve worked for the US Geological Survey for three months now and this is my last day in the office. Impacts on the world around us 3 a b c d e 7a The E arth could warm between 1.1 and 6.4°C this century if we fail to reduce em issions from burning fossil fuels and deforestation – devastating the natural world we love. 7 There have also been increased periods of drought, particularly in parts of Africa and Asia suffering from fam ine. According to the National Centre for Atm ospheric Research, the percentage of the Earth's surface suffering drought has m ore than doubled since the 1970s. Which sentence uses the present perfect simple? Which uses the present perfect continuous? Do both sentences refer to the same period of time? Do both sentences refer to a time starting three months ago and lasting up to now? Which sentence emphasises a completed action? Which sentence sees the action as temporary and incomplete at the moment that it is talked about? 7b Underline examples of the present perfect simple and the present perfect continuous in the article. Why has the writer used these forms in each case? Lang uag e reference and extra practice, pag es 126–149 ¬¬ 8 Complete the sentences with the present perfect simple or present perfect continuous form of the verbs in brackets. Sometimes both forms are correct. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 (disappear) at an alarming rate. In Iceland, the ice The Dead Sea (shrink) at the rate of one metre per year. Rising sea levels mean that some reclaimed land in low-lying areas (already/vanish). I (work) on the environmental project all year. The Environment Agency (send) over 115,000 warnings to people at risk of flooding. The environmental lobby (try) to get the government to reduce CO2 emissions for ages. Some scientists (question) the impact of climate change. The IPCC (just/publish) their latest report. SPEAKING 9 Work in g roups. Talk about your environment using the present perfect simple and continuous. Discuss some of these topics. • the weather • the seasons • wildlife • endangered species • sea levels Our class has been paying a lot of attention to local environmental news over the past couple of years, and we now know that honey bees have been disappearing at an alarming rate. A top scientist has warned that these bees could be wiped out in a few years. 8 Diseases such as m alaria could becom e m ore difficult to control in areas where it is currently too cold for them to spread year round. As tem peratures rise, diseases can grow. 18 Clear presentation of grammar followed by useful practice. Speaking exercises personalise the language and encourage communication. 19 7 0 0 Input lesson (2) 2.3 EXTREME ENVIRONMENT SPEAKING AND LISTENING 5c Look ag ain at the indirect questions in Exercise 5a. Are these statements true or false? 1 We use the word order of affirmative statements in indirect questions. 2 We use if or whether to introduce indirect yes/no questions. 3 We do not use the auxiliary do in present simple indirect questions. 4 Indirect questions always end with a question mark. 1 Work with a partner to brainstorm everything you know about volcanoes in two minutes. 2 Guess the answers to this quiz. What do you know about Volcanoes? Decide if these statements are true or false. 1 Volcanoes are a natural way that the Earth and other planets have of cooling off. 2 The biggest volcano on Earth is Mauna Loa in 6b Work with a partner. Ask and answer the indirect questions in Exercise 6a. Look at Audio script 2.3 on pag e 169 to help you. READING 3 2.3 Listen to someone talking about volcanoes and answer the questions. 3 4 a b c d e Listen ag ain and check your answers to the quiz. GRAMMAR Look at the direct questions below. Then look at Audio script 2.3 on pag e 169, find exactly how they were asked and write them in the table. Direct questions Indirect questions Can I ask what the the biggest volcano in the world is? 1 What is the biggest volcano in the world? a famous Italian volcano the evacuation of Yellowstone the width and thickness of the Yellowstone volcano the author meeting the park geologist earthquakes 8 Read the extracts ag ain and answer the questions in your own words. 1 What does the title, dangerous beauty, mean? 2 What are the approximate dimensions of Yellowstone Park? 3 Why, if Yellowstone blew, is ‘the cataclysm pretty well beyond imagining’? 4 Does Doss know how much warning would be given if Yellowstone was ‘going to go’? 5 Why does Doss say that warning signs of an eruption would not be easy to predict at Yellowstone? 6 Why would evacuating Yellowstone ‘never be easy’? INDIRECT QUESTIONS 5a Concept-check questions encourage students to work out the grammar rules themselves. 15 7 Read the extracts from Bill Bryson’s A Short History of Nea rly Everything on pag e 21 quickly and number the topics in the order they are mentioned. What is the situation? What is the relationship between the speaker and the listeners? How many questions are asked? 1 2 5 10 in the USA. 10 Vesuvius is a famous active volcano in Italy. 2 Can people go inside volcanoes? 3 Is Vesuvius an active volcano? ADVERBS 5 Is the Chilean Copahue volcano safe for local people? 20 25 YELLOWSTONE, IT TURNS OUT, IS A SUPERVOLCANO. It sits on top of an enormous hot spot, a reservoir of molten rock that begins at least 2,000 kilometres down in the Earth and rises to near the surface, forming what is known as a superplume. The heat from the hot spot is what powers all of Yellowstone’s vents, geysers, hot springs and popping mud pots. Beneath the surface is a magma chamber that is about 72 kilometres across – roughly the same dimensions as the park – and about 13 kilometres thick at its thickest point. The pressure that such a pool of magma exerts on the crust above has lifted Yellowstone and its surrounding territory about half a kilometre higher than they would otherwise be. If it blew, the cataclysm is pretty well beyond imagining. ‘It may not feel like it, but you’re standing on the largest active volcano in the world,’ Paul Doss, 30 Yellowstone National Park geologist, told me soon after climbing off an enormous Harley-Davidson motorcycle and 35 shaking hands when we met at the park headquarters at Mammoth Hot Springs early on a lovely morning in June. 70 I asked him what caused Yellowstone to blow when it did. 40 45 50 55 60 65 ‘Don’t know. Nobody knows. Volcanoes are strange things. We really don’t understand them at all. Vesuvius, in Italy, was active for three hundred years until an eruption in 1944 and then it just stopped. It’s been silent ever since. Some volcanologists think that it is recharging in a big way, which is a little worrying because two million people live on or around it. But nobody knows.’ ‘And how much warning would you get if Yellowstone was going to go?’ 9 Match the hig hlig hted adverbs in the extracts with adverbs in the box with a similar meaning . 5b Why does the professor use a direct question (What deliberately mainly normally perhaps relatively is a volcano?) and the students use indirect questions? slowly and carefully 75 80 85 He shrugged. ‘Nobody was around last time it blew, so nobody knows what the warning signs are. Probably you would have swarms of earthquakes and some surface uplift and possibly some changes in the patterns of behaviour of the geysers and steam vents but, nobody really knows.’ 90 95 ‘So it could just blow without warning?’ He nodded thoughtfully. The trouble, he explained, is that nearly all the things that would constitute warning signs already exist in some measure at Yellowstone. ‘Earthquakes are generally a precursor of volcanic eruptions, but the park already has lots of earthquakes – twelve hundred and sixty of them last year. Most of them are too small to be felt, but they are earthquakes nonetheless.’ Evacuating Yellowstone would never be easy. The park gets some three million visitors a year, mostly in the three peak summer months. The park’s roads are comparatively few and they are kept intentionally narrow, partly to slow traffic, partly to preserve an air of picturesqueness, and partly because of topographical constraints. At the height of summer, it can easily take half a day to cross the park and hours to get anywhere within it. Extract from Bill Bryson's A Short History of Nearly Everything SPEAKING MEET THE EXPERT 10a VOCABULARY 4 Why do volcanoes stop erupting? Cross reference directs students to the Language reference and Extra practice spread at the back of the book. DANGEROUS BEAUTY Chang e the direct questions into indirect questions. Use introductory phrases from Exercise 5a. 1 How high is Mauna Loa? I’d like to know how high Mauna Loa is. 2 How many volcanoes erupt each year? 3 What causes a volcano to erupt? 4 What is the biggest volcano in the USA? 5 Which volcano has been showing a lot of activity recently? 6 When did Vesuvius destroy Pompeii? 7 When did Vesuvius last erupt? 8 Do a lot of people live near Vesuvius? Hawaii. 3 Most volcanoes are found around the rim of the Atlantic Ocean. 4 There are volcanoes around the coastline of Antarctica. 5 There are no underwater volcanoes. 6 About fifty volcanoes erupt each year. 7 The temperature of lava flows can reach 1,250°C. 8 People can never go inside volcanoes. 9 There is a large volcano under Yellowstone Park Listening exercises guide students through audio texts and encourage different styles of listening. Yellowstone: Lang uag e reference and extra practice, pag es 126–149 ¬¬ 6a Work in g roups of three. Read one short text each about a volcano and make notes on the key points. Student A: look at page 155. Student B: look at page 157. Student C: look at page 161. Watch an interview with Dr Andrew McGonig le, a volcanolog ist, about active volcanoes. Turn to page 150 for video activities. Authentic video interviews provide additional input and discussion material, extending the topic. 10b Presenting Take turns to g ive a one-minute presentation on your volcano from your notes. At the end of each presentation, ask the presenter polite questions about their volcano. 20 21 Scenario Scenario lessons practise Key language from the unit through a meaningful final task. 2.4 SCENARIO 2.4 SPARROW HILL WIND FARM SITUATION The situation sets up the background information. A British power com pany has identified a good site for a wind farm in the north of England. The proposal is for a wind farm of eighty turbines over a large area. Each tower will be 60 m etres tall and have a turbine which is 35 m etres in diam eter. The wind farm will cover an area of several kilom etres and take five years to com plete. As fossil fuels such as coal, gas and oil are being used up, governm ents are keen to find alternative sources of energy, especially those that do not em it carbon dioxide. Nuclear power is one possible source, but m any people have doubts about its safety. Renewable energy sources include solar, wave and wind power. The UK Governm ent is keen to use these sources of power, and hopes to generate 15 percent of its energy needs from renewable sources by 2020. However, som e people feel that onshore wind farm s spoil the landscape, particularly in countryside areas where they are usually sited. Many people argue that they are unpleasant eyesores which dam age the enjoym ent of areas of outstanding natural beauty. Other people argue that wind power is sim ply not reliable as an energy source, as wind is variable and unpredictable. Students are given preparation for the task through different activities. SPARROW HILL WIND FARM 2 2.4 Listen to a g overnment official talking to a power company representative. They are discussing the proposed wind farm. Answer the questions. 1 2 3 TASK ATTENDING A FORMAL MEETING What is the attitude of each speaker to a public meeting? What is John Reynolds worried about? What do they decide in the end? PUBLIC MEETING KEY LANGUAGE AGREEING AND DISAGREEING POLITELY, POLITE QUESTIONS 3a Put words from the conversation in the correct order. Use contractions where necessary. 1 looking / one / it / way / is / but / at / that / of 2 are / because / right / you / absolutely 3 like / I / know / to / would 4 point / you / have / but / a / think / do / not / you 5 interested / I / knowing / am / in 6 very / is / true / that / because 7 go / there / I / because / you / along / would / with 3b Listen ag ain and check your answers. 4 Practise saying the expressions. Pay careful attention o pronunciation and use contractions. your opinions. Try to persuade the other people at the meeting to accept your ideas. 5c Meet as a class. Report back on the result of your meeting . 6 What do you think would happen in your country with a similar proposal? To discuss the Sparrow Hill wind farm proposals USEFUL PHRASES Date: 15 July Asking polite questions | Time: 7 p.m. Venue: Merlin Sports Centre Could you tell me (if/what) … ? I was wondering (if/what) … All welcome Putting your point of view across forcefully commited to greener energy 5a Work in g roups of five. You are g oing to attend the public meeting . Read your role cards and prepare for the meeting . You can add your own ideas. Student A: look at page 155. Student B: look at page 157. Student C: look at page 161. Student D: look at page 163. Student E: look at page 163. I’m absolutely certain that … I really believe that … There’s no doubt in my mind that … I’m totally convinced that … Being diplomatic That’s a good point, but … Yes, I see what you mean, but … The clear, well-structured communicative Task enables students to practise language in a meaningful context. 1 Read the situation and backg round information above and answer the questions. 1 What sources of energy are mentioned? What advantages and disadvantages are given for the energy sources? 2 Which facts and figures indicate that the wind farm will be large? 22 23 The Key language of the lesson is presented and practised. 8 0 0 Study and writing skills The Study skills section develops students’ ability to work on their own and in the classroom environment. STUDY AND WRITING SKILLS 2.5 STUDY SKILLS DESIGNING A QUESTIONNAIRE 1 Questionnaires are used to g ather data for surveys and reports. They usually provide up-to-date information or find out people’s attitudes and behaviour. 1 If you have answered a questionnaire recently, what was it about? 2 Which organisations frequently use questionnaires to gather information? 3 Which of the following are you most likely to answer: postal, telephone, or online questionnaires? Why? 2 STUDY AND WRITING SKILLS Question types Look at extracts A–G from a questionnaire and match them with the descriptions 1–7. 5a Descriptions of question types 1 Closed questions requiring the answer ‘yes’ or ‘no’. 2 Questions which require a respondent to indicate how frequently they do something. 3 Questions requiring respondents to tick items in lists or boxes. 4 Questions requiring a choice between alternatives. 5 Questions which require a figure or limited number of words. 6 Open questions beginning with what, who, why, etc. 7 Questions which require the respondent to choose a number on a scale. 5b Listen to a lecturer g iving a presentation about questionnaires. Answer the questions. 1 What two key points does she mention about designing questionnaires? 2 What two types of question are mentioned? 3 Which type of question will provide more information? Students are given real life tasks. 2.5 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 15–20 30+ 7 2.6 Lis ten to the firs t part of an SOE meeting . What bas ic information about res pondents will SOE as k for? 3 Do you have a gas boiler and is it new and fuel-efficient? 4 Do you replace light bulbs in your house/flat? 8 Listen ag ain. Note down the issues they plan to include in their questionnaire. Are they the same as the ones you chose in Exercise 6? 5 Which of the following energy-saving activities are you doing? Tick the appropriate boxes. Wearing jumpers and cardigans in the house to keep heating at a low temperature. Having fewer baths and more showers. Driving an energy-saving car (e.g. a hybrid car). Using as few lights as possible and turning them off assoon as you don’t need them. D Put a cross () on the scale to indicate your level of stress. Installing solar panels to light and heat your house. (1 = no stress, 5 = average stress, 10 = very stressed) 9 2.7 Listen to the next part of the meeting and tick the questions which will be included in the questionnaire. 1 How important each issue is for them. 2 Why they chose the most important issue. 3 What they do to protect the environment. 4 How aware and worried respondents are about each issue. 5 If respondents are able to give money to SOE. 6 If respondents are willing to join SOE’s campaigns. E What do you think are the main causes of stress 2 for students? F Which would you prefer? a fewer course assignments and more tests and examinations bfewer tests and examinations and more course assignments Students are given model texts to follow and analyse. Students are given a guided writing task. 10a Work in g roups of four and choose one of these tasks. 1 10 5 1 20–30 2 Do you believe it is necessary to save energy C Do you feel stressed during your studies? Yes No them to take action to protect the environment. Members of SOE are meeting to prepare a questionnaire which will be sent to young people aged 15–30. The questionnaire will gather information about young people’s attitudes to a number of environmental matters. 1 How old are you? Tick the appropriate box. in the home? Tick the appropriate box. No Yes 1 undergraduate postgraduate other 2 course research Short questions are better because if you ask long . ones, people won’t bother Open questions allow people to answer . With closed questions, the person answering has . It takes a lot longer to analyse the answers to . When using open questions, it is important to ask for only one . Questions should be clear and well structured so that people can see the point . At the start of a questionnaire, you should ask . When designing a questionnaire, you need to look ahead and consider how you’re going to . 6 Read about the Save Our Earth org anisation. What issues do you think SOE will list in the questionnaire they are g oing to prepare? Note down a few key environmental issues. Save Our Earth (SOE) is an environmental organisation founded two years ago. It aims to raise awareness among ENERGY QUESTIONNAIRE How many students are in your class? 3 Listen ag ain and complete the sentences. Use a maximum of three words for each sentence. 1 Work with a partner and discuss how to improve the ‘poor’ questions. Sug g est alternatives. A What department are you in? B Tick the boxes which apply to you. 2.5 Look at these questions from a questionnaire. Tick WRITING SKILLS the g ood questions and cross the poor questions. WRITING A QUESTIONNAIRE 4a Writing Skills focus on a different genre of writing in each unit. You work for SOE. Each student chooses one issue from Exercise 8. Write six questions to find out the respondents’ attitude to your issue. You are going to do a questionnaire about issues in your place of study/work. Each student chooses one issue that interests them (e.g. sports/catering/ parking facilities, how clean the building is, etc.). Write six questions to find out the respondents’ attitudes to your issue. 10b Show your questions to other members of your g roup. Correct the questions if there are any errors. 10c G How often do you feel stressed? Circle the Sug g est two more questions for each issue. 10d Prepare the questionnaire, adding the basic questions about the respondents from Exercise 7. appropriate letter. a never b rarely c sometimes d often e always 4b Work with a partner and discuss the advantag es and disadvantag es of using each type of question. 24 25 OTHER SECTIONS Meet the Expert Authentic video interviews provide motivating, reallife input. MEET THE EXPERT Carefullyscaffolded tasks make the authentic language accessible. 7 ARCHITECTURE 3b Watch the interview ag ain and complete the missing information. 1 Work with a partner. Look at the three building s in the photos and answer the questions. 4 Work in g roups and discuss the questions. 1 Are there any unusual buildings in your city? 2 What are your favourite buildings? Why do you like them? 3 If you could design a building for your local area, what would you design? 8 GLOBALISATION 1a Match the adjectives in the box with their meaning s below. egalitarian hierarchical stifling relationship-oriented task-driven 3a Work with a partner. Can you remember Richard’s answers to these questions? Make notes. global business environment mean to different companies? 2 What big differences are there between working in a global environment and ‘business as usual’? 3 What different ways of communicating do the two cultures he refers to have? 4 What do native English speakers do when they communicate? 5 How does he suggest adapting the phrase When in Rome, do as the Romans do? 3b Watch the interview ag ain and check your answers. 4a Interviewees are leading professionals and academics, providing fresh angles on the course topics. 1 The Mac 1 2 3 4 2 Park Hill 3 Sesc Pompeia Where do you think each building is? What do you think it’s used for? What adjectives would you use to describe each one? Which one do you like best? 2 7 Watch an interview with Laura Mark, a journalist for a mag azine on architecture, and tick which four of the sentences (a–g ) she says are unusual about the Sesc Pompeia building . a It wasn’t common at the time it was built for women architects to build large buildings. b Lina Bo Bardi had already built many buildings like this. c She changed a building that was there rather than building it fr d Before that, concrete had rarely been used on such a large scale. e She built the walls from plaster. f The windows look very different from the rest of the building. g The building was popular at the time, but not now. 3a Work with a partner and look at the notes below. Can you remember the missing information? area of Sao Paulo. in a 1 The Sesc Pompeia is located . where people can play 2 One of its uses is as a place it, also built 3 The organisatio n that built other centres across Brazil. in order to people local the 4 Lina Bo Bardi worked with . create a building which they high. 5 The towers are to the were in 6 The colours of the windows material of the rest of th e building. e of the building 7 Laura describes the appearanc . as when it first opened and 8 Local people loved th e building they still 1 a system where people are divided into levels of importance 2 focused more on results 3 a belief that everyone is equal and should have equal rights 4 a situation which stops you developing your own ideas and character 5 a belief that good contact with colleagues is important 1b Work in g roups. Which words/phrases would you use to describe the way people communicate in your culture? Which other words/phrases would you use? 8 Watch the interview with 2 Richard Cook, who talks about working in a g lobal environment, and put the quotes in the order he says them. a ‘… and this is because they maybe have different ways of communicating or different styles of leadership.’ b ‘Well, a global business environment can mean different things for different companies.’ c ‘The biggest block for native English speakers working globally is that they believe they don’t have to do anything differently when they communicate.’ d ‘The implications for people working in a global environment are that it cannot be business as usual. There are big differences.’ Work with a partner. You are g oing to g ive a short presentation on advice for people coming to work in your country. Make notes on these thing s, and think about how you are g oing to present your ideas. • communication styles • what people value most • how to get the best out of people 4b Give your presentation to the class. Discuss which you liked the best. 9 ART 1 Work with a partner and discuss the questions. movies adverts sculpture pottery theatre street performance jingles modern art graffiti photography 1 Which of these things do you consider to be art? What are the other things? 2 Which of them do you like most/least? 2 You are g oing to watch an interview with Yulia Podolska, a sculptor. Before you watch, match the words in the box with their meaning s 1–6 below. carve clay maquette marble plasticine sketch a hard, white rock which becomes smooth when it is polished a simple, quickly-made drawing which does not show much detail a small scale model, or rough draft of a sculpture a type of heavy, sticky earth that can be used for making pots and bricks a soft substance that comes in many colours and is used by children for making models 6 make an object or pattern by cutting a piece of wood or stone 1 2 3 4 5 9 Work in pairs. Put the stag es of the sculpting process in 3a order, then watch the interview and check your answers. a b c d e f Students are encouraged to discuss, react and take the topic in new directions. She makes a bigger sculpture out of clay. She has an idea in her head. She uses that to make a cast out of plaster. She makes a maquette. She carves the sculpture in marble. She plays with plasticine or does a pencil sketch. 3b Watch the interview ag ain and choose the correct option (a, b or c). 1 What inspired Yulia to become a sculptor? a her work as a doctor b a visit to a museum c her university professor in Kiev 2 Why is marble her favourite material? a you can make detailed sculptures with it b you can transform it into something very different c it’s easy to use 3 Which of these is not a material she has used in her work? a plastic toys b rubber c ice 4 Why does she refer to Renaissance and contemporary collections in Italy and France? a she wants to create better pieces b she wants to create something different c she wants to create her own place within this world 5 Where does she get most of her ideas from? a her emotions and political situations b her relationships c the TV 6 What does she say about the stone she used for The Cardinal? a it was difficult to find b she knew what it would be as soon as she saw it c it was a difficult piece to carve 4 Work in g roups and discuss the questions. 1 Yulia gives lots of examples of things that have inspired her. Can you think of an example of something which has inspired you to do something? 2 If you were going to create a piece of art (e.g. painting, sculpture, etc.), where do you think you’d get your ideas from? 3 Do you think people are born with artistic talent, or is it something that can be learnt? it in the same way now. 152 153 9 0 0 Language reference / Extra practice There is one Language reference and Extra practice spread for each unit at the back of the book. Grammar is cross-referenced to separate grammar points in each unit. The students are given a summary of the Key language and Vocabulary they have studied in the unit. 1 LANGUAGE REFERENCE GRAMMAR G1 THE CONTINUOUS ASPECT Use the continuous aspect to talk about: • an action which is in progress. Answer the door! I’m watching something. • an unfinished action. She was wo rking on a new novel when she died. • a temporary action. I’m us ing Jo’s laptop while mine is being repaired. • a trend, changing action or situation. Scientists say the weather is getting hotter. Compare the present simple and continuous: I live in a small flat. (permanent situation) I’m living with a host family for six weeks. (temporary situation) EXTRA PRACTICE PAST PERFECT The past perfect looks back from a time in the past to another time before that. She’d applied for ten jobs before she got this one. We can use the past perfect to describe a sequence of events. The past perfect describes the first action. When we arrived, the train had left. (First the train left, and then we arrived.) We can use just or already to show that the first action happened recently or earlier than expected. We arrived at six, but the train had jus t left. When they arrived, the film had already s tarted. We can use the past perfect for repeated earlier actions. By 2006, Deborah Tannen had written twenty books. G1 1 2 3 4 5 KEY LANGUAGE I’m watching the new series of Breaking Bad. It’s fantastic. (I watch it every Thursday evening.) We often use the past continuous and the past simple to talk about a long er backg round action in the past when a shorter action happens during it or interrupts it. I was washing the car when the pho ne rang . We can also use the present continuous to describe future arrang ements. We’re collecting our new car at the weekend. G2 STATE VERBS Some verbs describe something passive or a state. Examples of these verbs are: agree, believe, belong, depend, hate, hear, know, like, love, prefer, see, understand, want. We rarely use state verbs in the continuous: I’m not understanding this word. I don’t understand this word. G3 THE PERFECT ASPECT Use the perfect aspect to look back from one time to another. PRESENT PERFECT The present perfect looks back from now to a time before now. There are four main uses. • a state that started in the past and is still continuing I’ve lived here all my life. • a completed action in the past which has some relevance to the present (e.g. a present result) There has been a severe storm and the airport is now closed. • finished actions in a period of time that is still continuing I’ve been there once already today. • actions in the past which may happen again Deborah Tannen has written several books on communication. (She could write more books.) ! KL OUTLINING PROBLEMS AND OFFERING SOLUTIONS OUTLINING PROBLEMS The problem is … The trouble is … It’s a tricky situation because … It’s a vicious circle. 6 1 Choose the best explanation for each sentence. We were quite poor when I was growing up. a I’m an adult now. b I’m still a child. She’s on a diet so she isn’t eating any ice cream. a She ate ice cream in the past. b She never eats ice cream. By the end of the day we were feeling quite tired. a We got more tired as the day went on. b We felt tired all day. I was checking my emails when my computer stopped working. a I managed to check all my emails. b I only managed to check some of my emails. Michael’s doing a project on wind farms. a Michael has finished the project. b Michael has not finished the project yet. The family was living in a caravan at that time. a The family lived there for a temporary period. b The family always lived there. G2 2 Make questions from the prompts. Use a continuous form if possible. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 OFFERING SOLUTIONS One way of dealing with this could be … Well, there’s an obvious solution. We could talk to … The best way to deal with it is to … REACTING TO SUGGESTIONS That might well solve the problem. That seems the best way to deal with it. you / prefer / chicken or fish ? you / read / anything interesting at the moment ? this mobile phone / belong / to you ? your course / get / more difficult ? anyone / know / the answer to this question ? you / agree / with him ? the students / learn / about / pollution this week ? your parents / know / how to send emails ? G3 VOCABULARY V1 PHRASAL VERBS bump into, catch up with, get in touch with, keep track of, lose touch with, stay in touch with, track down V2 SCIENTIFIC STUDY concept, experiment, method, random, research, results, sample, theory analyse (v), confirm (v), prove (v), test (v) V3 IDIOMS actions speak louder than words, be on the same wavelength, get a word in edgeways, get straight to the point, have a quick word with someone, hear it on the grapevine, think before you speak V4 COLLOCATIONS display similarities, establish connections, establish rapport, exhibit knowledge, impart information, maintain status, negotiate relationships, negotiate status 3 Complete the text with the correct form of the verb in brackets. John Gray is a famous US psychologist and author. His best-known work is Men Are from Mars, Women Are (write) in 1992. By 2007, from Venus, which he 1 the book 2 (sell) over six million copies. For over twenty years he 3 (lead) seminars and courses on relationships and communication, and he 4 (appear) frequently on television shows, including Oprah and The Today Show. Gray was born in Houston, Texas, in 1951. He 5 (attend) high school and the University of Texas, but instead of completing his degree he 6 (decide) to move to Switzerland. After he 7 (be) in Switzerland for nine years, Gray decided to return to the USA, where he 8 (complete) a doctorate in Psychology at Columbia Pacific University. The research for his PhD formed the basis of Men Are from Mars, Women Are from Venus. Following the success of that book, Gray 9 (write) several more best-selling guides to relationships and communication. He now 10 (live) in California with his wife and three children. Use the past simple, not the present perfect, when talking about a definite time in the past. Our lesson has finished at four o’clock. Our lesson finished at four o’clock. 126 KL A: B: A: B: A: B: A: B: 1 4 Complete the dialog ue with one word in each g ap. What’s the problem? situation because my boss keeps Well, it’s a1 she expects – it’s a 2 circle. Well, there’s an 3 solution. Why don’t you just say ‘no’? The 4 is that she’ll think I’m lazy and I might lose my job … One way of 5 with this could be to explain your situation to her. I’m sure she’ll understand. I’m not sure. It’s a very tricky 6 . Well, maybe the best way to 7 with it is to talk to the area manager. He’s very helpful. OK. That might well 8 the problem. Extra practice exercises for the Grammar, Key language and Vocabulary studied in the unit. V1,2 5 Replace the words in italics with words from V1 or V2 with a similar meaning . It was great to meet my old boss by accident at the conference. It’s important to maintain a relationship with your customers. Can you help me find last year’s sales figures, please? We need to know for sure how many people to cater for. I’d like to tell you about the idea behind our new design. 6 We can’t just say our product is the best – we need to provide the facts to demonstrate it. 1 2 3 4 5 V3 6 1 2 3 4 5 Carol and Jim always have very different ideas. I can’t get a word in edgeways. They spend ages talking about irrelevant things. Can I have a quick word with the manager? It’s important to see what they’ve actually done. a b c d e After all, actions speak louder than words. They’re just not on the same wavelength. They should get straight to the point. They never stop talking. It won’t take very long. V3 1 2 3 4 5 6 a b c e f g Choose a–e to continue the sentences. 7 Choose a–g to continue the sentences. Although we want our products to look different, they need to have A big part of attending conferences is establishing new Face-to-face meetings are the best way to establish a He didn't get the job because he didn't exhibit enough The more information you can We have been working hard to maintain our status as the world leaders in mobile technology. connections with potential business partners. good rapport with your employees. knowledge of the construction industry. some similarities to create a common identity. impart, the more your employees will trust you. 127 MYENGLISHLAB A blended and personalised learning environment with materials that can be assigned at the click of a mouse. Rich media activities using audio, video, and ‘record yourself’ functionality. Interactive practice exercises with instant feedback and automatic gradebook. 10 0 0 MYENGLISHLAB Interactive practice exercises with instant feedback and automatic gradebook. Tips and feedback that direct learners to reference materials and encourage them to work out answers for themselves. • Achievement tests for each unit, and mid-course and end of course assessments. • Common error report that report that highlights mistakes that learners are making. 11 0 0 1 Communication Unit Objectives Grammar: Vocabulary: Scenario: Study skills: Writing skills: the continuous aspect; the perfect aspect phrasal verbs; scientific study; idioms; collocations outlining problems, offering solutions, reacting to suggestions; solving communication problems note-taking from listening to a talk writing and checking written communication SPEAKING AND LISTENING 1.1 CONNECTIONS IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging Students discuss the ways they currently communicate with other people. They listen to five people talking about their communication habits and learn some phrasal verbs to describe them (e.g. catch up with). Next, students read an article entitled Six degrees of separation and focus on vocabulary related to scientific study. Finally, students discuss non-verbal communication and write a list of advice about communicating in their own country. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • discussed the ways they currently communicate • extracted specific information from a listening and reading text • learnt phrasal verbs related to social media • learnt about non-verbal communication and written a list about it relating to their own country 1 Explain to students that they are going to discuss communication in their everyday lives. • Give students one minute to read the questions. Check that they understand all the language (e.g. online/virtual friends). Then put them in groups of three or four. • Students discuss the questions. Allow a maximum of five minutes for this activity. • For feedback, ask a few students to give one or two answers in open class. Answers will depend on students’ opinions. 2a Check that students know communication habits. • Students read the questions before listening to the recording. Explain that some questions can have more than one answer. • Student check their answers with a partner before you check in class. 1 People 1, 5 2 Person 3 3 Person 4 4 Person 2 5 Person 5 6 Person 2 Timings If short of time, omit Exercise 3 or set Exercise 11 for homework. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 5. Audio script 1.1 1 WARM-UP • Ask students to look at the main photo on page 6 and elicit what kind of communication dolphins use (i.e. whistling, tail slapping, visual signals – posture). • Give students one minute to write down as many forms of communication as they know. • Students compare their answers in pairs. Then create a ‘class list’ on the board. 2 New Language Leader Upper Intermediate Communication 0 0 Well, I have two phones, which I‘m always checking for messages, but actually I love getting and making calls. It’s just more personal than texting. I like hearing people’s voices. I find there can be a lot of misunderstandings with SMS and messaging apps, even if you use emoticons. I guess I’m addicted to my phones. They are the last thing I check before I go to sleep and the first thing I look at in the morning! I do use social media at the university for making arrangements with my classmates, but I tend to send a lot of SMS messages as well. I also like to use Facebook to keep track 12 3 4 5 of all my friends around the world. It’s fun – last month someone got in touch with me who I met on holiday two years ago. It was completely out of the blue and it was quite a surprise after all this time, but they tracked me down on Facebook. I also follow a few celebrities on social media. I think it’s funny, but I know a lot of people think it’s stupid. I’m a big fan of social media and I have my own blog, but I do send people real cards for birthdays and at Christmas. I really don’t like those electronic greeting cards. They are so impersonal. A funny thing happened to me last year. I had lost touch with one of my friends from school, but I bumped into them by chance when I was shopping in Paris. We stay in contact by using one of the various messaging apps. They’re really great. I keep track of all my friends on Facebook. I also tend to Skype a lot as I’m a student studying abroad. I Skype with my family at least once a week. I can catch up with all the news from home. Sometimes the connection isn’t very good though, which can make it difficult. Also, the time difference can cause problems, if I wake people up! I’m afraid I’m a bit unusual as I don’t use a mobile phone. I mean, I have one, but it’s only for emergencies. No one knows the number. I’m not a technophobe, I just don’t like phones! I tend to stay in touch with people by email, but really, I prefer to speak to people face to face. I think technology sometimes gets in the way of real communication, but I suppose I’m a bit oldfashioned. I mean, I still send real Christmas cards to people through the post – snail mail, I think it’s called, ha, ha! 2b Individually, students write down as many forms of social media mentioned by each speaker as they can remember before listening again. • Students may not be aware of the names of the forms of communication. Explain that they should write down what they think they hear. • When complete, students check their answers with a partner and correct as necessary. • In feedback, elicit the meaning of each answer. Students create a table with five columns, headed Person 1–5 and two rows. They write notes in the relevant column. Person 1: phones, SMS messages, messaging apps Person 2: social media, SMS messages, Facebook Person 3: social media, blog, (electronic) cards, messaging apps Person 4: Facebook, Skype Person 5: mobile phones, email, face to face conversation, (Christmas) cards 3 Students reflect on the questions individually before explaining to a partner which person they are most like, and why. Write the same table as described in 2b above on the board. Ask who was most like Person 1 and add their names to that column. Do the same for people 2–5. See which person the class is most like. Try and get students to explain why this is so. VOCABULARY: phrasal verbs 4 Ask the class to explain the meaning of phrasal verb (a verb composed of a main verb and a preposition) and when they are commonly used (in social, less formal English). • Individually, students match the phrasal verb with its definition. If they do not know the answer, they should make a ‘best guess’ based on the component parts of the verb. 1g 2d 3a 4e 5b 6c 7f 5 Explain that students should complete the sentences with relevant information. Allow them three or four minutes to complete them individually before they compare with a partner. • Take one or two example answers for each question from the class. With weaker classes, do Q1 as an example (e.g. to write them a letter/to contact their old school). Answers will depend on students’ opinions. READING 6a Explain that predicting the content of a text from its title is a useful skill, specifically in English exams. • Students discuss the title in pairs and guess what the text will be about. Hold a quick class discussion, asking each pair to explain the logic of their prediction. 6b Give students four or five minutes to read the article and check their prediction. 13 Communication 0 0 • Take class feedback. Discuss key points of the text, but not in too much detail at this stage. how closely related people are 7 Ensure that students have clearly read the instructions (i.e. no more than three words). This is a common requirement in English language exams, so this is good practice for exams like IELTS and PTE-A. • Students complete the sentences individually before checking with a partner. • Take class feedback. 10b Discuss this question in a whole class situation. Ensure students are clear why it is important (it can help to build trust, engage people, show you are interested, etc.) Students discuss situations in their life where they experienced good/bad non-verbal communication and the impact it had. 11 As students write their list, encourage them to use empathy (i.e. to think about the perspective of the person reading the information). • When students have finished writing their advice, they should circulate it to other members of the class, who may have questions to ask. HOMEWORK OPTIONS 1 five to ten 2 1929 / a 1929 book 3 test the theory 4 job and general 5 five and seven 6 Psychology Today 7 2003 8 721 million Students do the vocabulary, listening and reading exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. 8 Do a couple of examples with the class before students identify as many relevant nouns and verbs individually. In feedback, get as many answers as possible from the class. Motivate students by making it a race. Allow one minute for them to find as many as possible. Students do Exercise V1,2–5 on page 127 in the Language reference. research, theory, concept, to prove, method, to test , (random) sample, results, experiment, to confirm, to analyse 9 Critical thinking: Reacting to the text. It is important that students do not only read a text in a passive way, but that they are encouraged to actively reflect on its contents. These questions enable them to do this. • Students discuss in their groups before you take one or two sample answers for each question. SPEAKING AND WRITING Since non-verbal communication is a key aspect of communication, it is assessed in English speaking tests such IELTS and PTE-A. 10a Ask the class to define non-verbal communication. If necessary, provide your own definition (ways of communicating without using language). Explain that this is common in all languages, but that it is often expressed differently. • When forming groups for this activity, try to ensure as good a cultural mix as possible. If your class is multinational, this is easy. If it is not, then perhaps try to mix people from different regions together, to see if their answers are the same. 14 Communication 0 0 1.2 COMMUNICATING CONFIDENTLY IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging This lesson looks at ways of improving how you communicate in different situations. Students read a leaflet about a course on communication skills and learn idioms related to communication. Next, they focus on and practise using the continuous aspect. Finally, students use the continuous aspect to talk about current trends in communication. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information from a reading text • extended their range of idioms related to communication • revised/extended their understanding of the continuous aspect • practised using the continuous aspect in a speaking activity Timings If short of time, set Exercise 6a as homework and then discuss the questions in Exercise 6b next lesson. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 5. READING 1a If you used the Warm-up activity, use this as a lead-in to the three situations in this exercise. • Put students in groups to discuss the situations. Ask them to say why they feel the way they do. • In feedback, ask two or three groups how they feel about each situation and elicit reasons. 1b Do this activity as a whole class and elicit advice on the board. Answers will depend on students’ opinions. 2 Give students one minute to read the leaflet; refer them to the ideas from Exercise 1b on the board. • Tell students not to worry about unknown vocabulary at this stage. • Ask students to briefly compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. Answers will depend on students’ ideas in Exercise 1b. 3 Ask students to read the five extracts before they read the leaflet again. They can use their dictionaries for unknown vocabulary. • Ask students to briefly compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. Extract A: Week 3 Extract B: Week 11 Extract C: Week 5 Extract D: Week 1 Extract E: Week 2 WARM-UP This activity introduces the topic of communicating in different situations and how students feel about it. • Ask students how easy they find speaking to other people and elicit that it depends on the situation. • Write the following situations on the board: to an individual stranger at a party, to an individual student in class, to a teacher, to a police officer, to a stranger on the phone, to ask a stranger to do something for you, to ask someone you know if you could borrow a large sum of money, to a doctor when you’re feeling ill. • Ask students to rank the situations from most to least stressful. Put them in pairs to compare. • Finally, ask students if they agreed on the most and least stressful situations. If possible, get the class to agree on the most stressful situation. 4 Ask students to read the statements and check they understand speech impediment (a problem when speaking, e.g. a stammer – demonstrate a stammer, but be careful not to offend anyone in your class), assertive (being confident in what you say), interact (communicate with and respond to other people) and be yourself (behave naturally). • Ask students to try to decide if the statements are true or false before they read the leaflet again. • Give students four minutes to re-read the leaflet to check their ideas and answer any statements they couldn’t do in the previous stage. • Students compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. 1 NG 2 NG 3 F 4 T 5 T not makes this false.) 7 T 6 F (The word 15 Communication 0 0 5 Give students two minutes to think about these questions and then put them into pairs/small groups to discuss. Encourage them to say why they think they’re good at, or need to develop, some skills. To follow up, ask students if this is a course they’d be interested in doing and why. VOCABULARY: idioms 6a Elicit/Tell students that idioms may have a meaning that is not conveyed by individual words. • If students have good English–English dictionaries, ask them to use these to check their answers. Tell them to decide which the key words are in the idioms to help them find the entry. • Students work individually before comparing their answers with a partner. If they don’t know an idiom and aren’t using dictionaries, tell them to make a best guess. • Go through the answers with the class. 1f 2g 3d 4c 1 yes 2 no 3 no 4 temporary 5 while she was studying for her MBA 8 Keep students in the same pairs as for Exercises 7a and 7b. Students will benefit from having to think through their answers with another student, so don’t interrupt or prompt too much while they’re working. • Check answers with the class. • For further practice, ask students to do Exercises G1–1 and G2–2 on page 127 in the Language reference. For weaker groups, write up some of the key language on the board (permanent, temporary, habitual, etc.) so students learn the correct terminology. 1a The writing is in progress. 1b The writing is habitual. 2a permanent 2b temporary/in progress 3a The having dinner happened first and was in progress when the colleague arrived. 3b The having dinner happened second. 4a completed action in the past 4b background situation/setting the scene 5a permanent 5b temporary/in progress 6a habitual 6b temporary 5b 6a 7e 6b Give students a minute to think about their answers before putting them in pairs to discuss. • Encourage them to ask each other questions to find out as much information as possible. • Take class feedback. Ask three students for their feedback for each question. • For further practice, ask students to do Exercise V3–6 on page 127 in the Language reference. 9a Ask students to predict what kind of word (i.e. word class) will be the answer. They may be able to guess it is an adverb by looking at the question key word (how). Students answer the questions individually before you check in class. GRAMMAR: the continuous aspect 1 rapidly 2 dramatically 7a Elicit how the continuous aspect is formed (be + -ing) and any uses students already know. • Tell students to find the six remaining examples and underline them in the texts. Help any students that cannot find them all. • Put students in pairs to try to decide the time frame for each example (in progress, changing, etc.) before they look at Exercise 7b. is rising, is increasing, are taking, are talking, is carrying out, was studying, is communicating 7b Students answer the questions individually and then compare their answers with their partner from Exercise 7a. • If necessary, refer students to the Language reference on page 126. • Go through the answers with the class and check that they understand. • Read through the Grammar tip with the class. Elicit the word trend so that they understand the purpose of the tip (a general change in the way people are behaving). Also elicit collocate (when words are commonly used with other words). 9bEmphasise that students should use the language in the Grammar tip for this exercise. • Individually, students think of at least one sentence for each question 1–7. • Students then compare their answers in pairs or small groups. Encourage partners to ask follow-up questions (e.g. Why do you think that? What evidence do you have for that?). • For each question, ask two or three groups for an answer. Provide sample answers where necessary. 16 Communication 0 0 Sample answers 1 The use of tablets is increasing dramatically. 2 The web is changing our lives dramatically. 3 The universe is expanding constantly. 4 Hurricanes are occurring frequently. 5 Men are behaving differently. 6 The population is increasing rapidly. 7 Identity fraud is occurring frequently. SPEAKING 10a Individually, students have a few minutes to think about their ideas for some or all of the current trends in the list. • Put students in groups (of a maximum of four students) to discuss the trends, saying how and why they are in progress and/or changing. • For feedback, ask two or three groups to tell the class what they discussed for one of the items. • Ask students which item they think is changing most quickly and why. 10b Critical thinking: Considering consequences. Understanding the link between cause and effect is an important skill at this level – describing what happens, but also what the result will be. • Individually, students take two or three minutes to decide which single trend they would like to talk about. Emphasise that they can choose whether it is important, worrying or interesting. Also emphasise that they must say how this trend affects a particular group in society. • In groups of three or four, students then present their opinion. They should be encouraged to ask follow-up questions. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the grammar, vocabulary and listening exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Students choose a trend in progress other than those in Exercise 10a, research it and write a short presentation (about 150 words) on how and why it is changing. They can give their presentations in the following lesson. Take the presentations in for marking, paying particular attention to the present continuous and present simple. Students do Exercises V3–6, G1–1 and G2–2 on page 127 in the Language reference. 1.3 WHO DOES THE TALKING? IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging This lesson looks at the differences between men's and women’s communication. Students listen to a radio programme about a socio-linguist (Deborah Tannen), which contextualises the grammar for this lesson: the perfect aspect. Next, students read two extracts from Tannen’s book and focus on collocations related to communication. Finally, students do a speaking activity to practise using the language from the lesson. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from listening and reading texts • revised/extended their understanding of the perfect aspect, looking specifically at the present and past perfect, and the past simple • extended their range of collocations in the context of communication • participated in extended speaking practice on communication between men and women Timings If short of time, set exercise 10a as homework. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 6. WARM-UP This activity introduces the topic of differences between men’s and women’s communication. • Write the following two sentences on the board: Men are good communicators because … ; Women are good communicators because … • Divide the class in half. Tell one group to think of three reasons why men are good communicators and the other to do the same for women. You can either divide the class into groups of men and women or mix the sexes, depending on the number of each sex in your class. • In groups of four, allow five minutes for discussion. Encourage students to disagree! • Finally, ask the class to vote on which sex they think communicates better. 17 Communication 0 0 LISTENING R: 1 Where possible, ensure that groups for this exercise are mixed (i.e. males and females). Do not let this exercise take too long (unless students are enjoying it). Take brief class feedback afterwards. 2 Get students to read the exercise instructions and ensure that they are clear what they have to do. • Play the recording. Students complete the exercise individually and then check answers in pairs. Audio script 1.2 1 Welcome to today’s call in programme. As some of you may know, Deborah Tannen is most famous for her books Talking from 9 to 5, about women and men at work, and You Just Don’t Understand, about women and men in conversation. She has recently written a book about how sisters communicate called You Were Always Mom’s Favorite. However, in today’s programme we’re focusing on an essay she has recently written for the New York Times about interrupting, called Would You Please Let Me Finish? and I think a number of politicians might like to read it. I’ll just give a quick summary of what Professor Tannen thinks and then I’ll take some calls. A lot of Professor Tannen’s research has focused on the fact that conversation styles can vary greatly because of different factors – for example, your age, your gender, your culture. In this article she concentrates on the issue of interrupting, and how different ideas on what interrupting is and when it is good and bad can also vary greatly depending on gender, culture and so on. To back Tannen up, some recent surveys have shown that – surprise, surprise – women tend to be interrupted more than men and that women who interrupt others are seen more negatively than men who do the same thing. However, it has also been found that there are more interruptions overall in conversations when all the people involved are women. Although these interruptions are often seen as talking along with each other, rather than talking over each other. OK, I’ll take the first caller. 2 Rie, Mae R: I’ve just made a nice pot of tea, Mae. Would you like a cup? M: Oh yes, please. M: R: M: R: M: R: M: R: M: R: M: How are you feeling at the moment? You said on the phone yesterday that it’s been a bit rough recently. I don’t want to bore you, but the last few months have been terrible, Rie. I’m sorry to hear that. We’ve been married for nearly five years, but it has all gone wrong. We’ve had so many arguments recently and he has moved out. Oh, when did he leave? This evening. He phoned me from a café at 5 p.m. and asked me to meet him there after work to talk about our problems. But by the time I arrived at the café he had left. I’m sorry to hear that. It was alright until he found out that I had booked a vacation with all the girls. Well, you went on vacation every year with the girls before you got married. Exactly. He’s so controlling and it’s my money. I should have known that it wouldn’t have worked. And his mother hates me. When he introduced me to her, I knew I had seen her somewhere before. She had been a classmate of my mum and they had never been friends. Oh, that’s not good. And we … we just don’t do things together anymore. I’ve always been a sociable person but he just doesn’t like going out with me. And when we do go out in a group, he always dominates the conversation and shows off. He thinks he knows everything and he’s so insensitive. He interrupts me all the time in a group, but when it’s just the two of us he doesn’t talk and doesn’t listen. And he just won’t talk about our relationship. In extract 1 a radio presenter is talking about an essay recently written by Deborah Tanner. In extract 2, two women are talking together over a cup of tea. One woman talks about how her marriage has gone wrong. 3 Students read the questions and answer as many as they can based on the first listening. • Play the recording again. Students check/complete their answers. • Students check with a partner before you check answers in class. • Get students to correct each other if possible. You should give the correct answer where needed. 18 Communication 0 0 MYENGLISHLAB Interactive practice exercises with instant feedback and automatic gradebook. Tips and feedback that direct learners to reference materials and encourage 0 0 them to work out answers for themselves. • Achievement tests for each unit, and mid-course and end of course assessments. • Common error report that report that highlights mistakes that learners are making. 0 0 1 Communication Unit Objectives Grammar: Vocabulary: Scenario: Study skills: Writing skills: the continuous aspect; the perfect aspect phrasal verbs; scientific study; idioms; collocations outlining problems, offering solutions, reacting to suggestions; solving communication problems note-taking from listening to a talk writing and checking written communication 1.1 CONNECTIONS IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging Students discuss the ways they currently communicate with other people. They listen to five people talking about their communication habits and learn some phrasal verbs to describe them (e.g. catch up with). Next, students read an article entitled Six degrees of separation and focus on vocabulary related to scientific study. Finally, students discuss non-verbal communication and write a list of advice about communicating in their own country. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: 0 • discussed the ways they currently communicate 0 • extracted specific information from a listening and reading text SPEAKING AND LISTENING 1 Explain to students that they are going to discuss communication in their everyday lives. • Give students one minute to read the questions. Check that they understand all the language (e.g. online/virtual friends). Then put them in groups of three or four. • Students discuss the questions. Allow a maximum of five minutes for this activity. • For feedback, ask a few students to give one or two answers in open class. Answers will depend on students’ opinions. 2a Check that students know communication habits. • Students read the questions before listening to the recording. Explain that some questions can have more than one answer. • Student check their answers with a partner before • learnt phrasal verbs related to social media • learnt about non-verbal communication and written a list about it relating to their own country you check in class. 1 People 1, 5 2 Person 3 3 Person 4 4 Person 2 5 Person 5 6 Person 2 Timings If short of time, omit Exercise 3 or set Exercise 11 for homework. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 5. Audio script 1.1 1 WARM-UP • Ask students to look at the main photo on page 6 and elicit what kind of communication dolphins use (i.e. whistling, tail slapping, visual signals – posture). • Give students one minute to write down as many forms of communication as they know. • Students compare their answers in pairs. Then create a ‘class list’ on the board. 2 New Language Leader Upper Intermediate Communication 0 0 Well, I have two phones, which I‘m always checking for messages, but actually I love getting and making calls. It’s just more personal than texting. I like hearing people’s voices. I find there can be a lot of misunderstandings with SMS and messaging apps, even if you use emoticons. I guess I’m addicted to my phones. They are the last thing I check before I go to sleep and the first thing I look at in the morning! I do use social media at the university for making arrangements with my classmates, but I tend to send a lot of SMS messages as well. I also like to use Facebook to keep track 12 3 4 5 of all my friends around the world. It’s fun – last month someone got in touch with me who I met on holiday two years ago. It was completely out of the blue and it was quite a surprise after all this time, but they tracked me down on Facebook. I also follow a few celebrities on social media. I think it’s funny, but I know a lot of people think it’s stupid. I’m a big fan of social media and I have my own blog, but I do send people real cards for birthdays and at Christmas. I really don’t like those electronic greeting cards. They are so impersonal. A funny thing happened to me last year. I had lost touch with one of my friends from school, but I bumped into them by chance when I was shopping in Paris. We stay in contact by using one of the various messaging apps. They’re really great. I keep track of all my friends on Facebook. I also tend to Skype a lot as I’m a student studying abroad. I Skype with my family at least once a week. I can catch up with all the news from home. Sometimes the connection isn’t very good though, which can make it difficult. Also, the time difference can cause problems, if I wake people up! I’m afraid I’m a bit unusual as I don’t use a mobile phone. I mean, I have one, but it’s only for emergencies. No one knows the number. I’m not a technophobe, I just don’t like phones! I tend to stay in touch with people by email, but really, I prefer to speak to people face to face. I think technology sometimes gets in the way of real communication, but I suppose I’m a bit oldfashioned. I mean, I still send real Christmas cards to people through the post – snail mail, I think it’s called, ha, ha! 2b Individually, students write down as many forms of social media mentioned by each speaker as they can remember before listening again. • Students may not be aware of the names of the forms of communication. Explain that they should write down what they think they hear. • When complete, students check their answers with 0 a partner and correct as necessary. 0 • In feedback, elicit the meaning of each answer. Students create a table with five columns, headed Person 1: phones, SMS messages, messaging apps Person 2: social media, SMS messages, Facebook Person 3: social media, blog, (electronic) cards, messaging apps Person 4: Facebook, Skype Person 5: mobile phones, email, face to face conversation, (Christmas) cards 3 Students reflect on the questions individually before explaining to a partner which person they are most like, and why. Write the same table as described in 2b above on the board. Ask who was most like Person 1 and add their names to that column. Do the same for people 2–5. See which person the class is most like. Try and get students to explain why this is so. VOCABULARY: phrasal verbs 4 Ask the class to explain the meaning of phrasal verb (a verb composed of a main verb and a preposition) and when they are commonly used (in social, less formal English). • Individually, students match the phrasal verb with its definition. If they do not know the answer, they should make a ‘best guess’ based on the component parts of the verb. 1g 2d 3a 4e 5b 6c 7f 5 Explain that students should complete the sentences with relevant information. Allow them three or four minutes to complete them individually before they compare with a partner. • Take one or two example answers for each question from the class. With weaker classes, do Q1 as an example (e.g. to write them a letter/to contact their old school). Answers will depend on students’ opinions. READING 6a Explain that predicting the content of a text from its title is a useful skill, specifically in English exams. • Students discuss the title in pairs and guess what Students create a table with five columns, headed Person 1–5 and two rows. They write notes in the relevant column. the text will be about. Hold a quick class discussion, asking each pair to explain the logic of their prediction. 6b Give students four or five minutes to read the article and check their prediction. 13 Communication • Take class feedback. Discuss key points of the text, but not in too much detail at this stage. 0 how closely related people are 0 10b Discuss this question in a whole class situation. Ensure students are clear why it is important (it can help to build trust, engage people, show you are interested, etc.) Students discuss situations in their life where they 7 Ensure that students have clearly read the instructions (i.e. no more than three words). This is a common requirement in English language exams, so this is good practice for exams like IELTS and PTE-A. • Students complete the sentences individually before checking with a partner. • Take class feedback. experienced good/bad non-verbal communication and the impact it had. 11 As students write their list, encourage them to use empathy (i.e. to think about the perspective of the person reading the information). • When students have finished writing their advice, they should circulate it to other members of the class, who may have questions to ask. HOMEWORK OPTIONS 1 five to ten 2 1929 / a 1929 book 3 test the theory 4 job and general 5 five and seven 6 Psychology Today 7 2003 8 721 million Students do the vocabulary, listening and reading exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. 8 Do a couple of examples with the class before students identify as many relevant nouns and verbs individually. In feedback, get as many answers as possible from the class. Motivate students by making it a race. Allow one minute for them to find as many as possible. Students do Exercise V1,2–5 on page 127 in the Language reference. research, theory, concept, to prove, method, to test , (random) sample, results, experiment, to confirm, to analyse 9 Critical thinking: Reacting to the text. It is important that students do not only read a text in a passive way, but that they are encouraged to actively reflect on its contents. These questions enable them to do this. • Students discuss in their groups before you take one or two sample answers for each question. SPEAKING AND WRITING Since non-verbal communication is a key aspect of communication, it is assessed in English speaking tests such IELTS and PTE-A. 10a Ask the class to define non-verbal communication. If necessary, provide your own definition (ways of communicating without using language). Explain that this is common in all languages, but that it is often expressed differently. • When forming groups for this activity, try to ensure as good a cultural mix as possible. If your class is multinational, this is easy. If it is not, then perhaps try to mix people from different regions together, to see if their answers are the same. 14 Communication 0 0 1.2 COMMUNICATING CONFIDENTLY IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging This lesson looks at ways of improving how you communicate in different situations. Students read a leaflet about a course on communication skills and learn idioms related to communication. Next, they focus on and practise using the continuous aspect. Finally, students use the continuous aspect to talk about current trends in communication. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information from a reading text • extended their range of idioms related to 0 communication 0 • revised/extended their understanding of the continuous aspect READING 1a If you used the Warm-up activity, use this as a lead-in to the three situations in this exercise. • Put students in groups to discuss the situations. Ask them to say why they feel the way they do. • In feedback, ask two or three groups how they feel about each situation and elicit reasons. 1b Do this activity as a whole class and elicit advice on the board. Answers will depend on students’ opinions. 2 Give students one minute to read the leaflet; refer them to the ideas from Exercise 1b on the board. • Tell students not to worry about unknown vocabulary at this stage. • Ask students to briefly compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. Answers will depend on students’ ideas in Exercise 1b. • practised using the continuous aspect in a speaking activity Timings If short of time, set Exercise 6a as homework and then discuss the questions in Exercise 6b next lesson. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 5. WARM-UP This activity introduces the topic of communicating in different situations and how students feel about it. • Ask students how easy they find speaking to other people and elicit that it depends on the situation. • Write the following situations on the board: to an individual stranger at a party, to an individual student in class, to a teacher, to a police officer, to a stranger on the phone, to ask a stranger to do something for you, to ask someone you know if you could borrow a large sum of money, to a doctor when you’re feeling ill. • Ask students to rank the situations from most to least stressful. Put them in pairs to compare. • Finally, ask students if they agreed on the most and least stressful situations. If possible, get the class to agree on the most stressful situation. 3 Ask students to read the five extracts before they read the leaflet again. They can use their dictionaries for unknown vocabulary. • Ask students to briefly compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. Extract A: Week 3 Extract B: Week 11 Extract C: Week 5 Extract D: Week 1 Extract E: Week 2 4 Ask students to read the statements and check they understand speech impediment (a problem when speaking, e.g. a stammer – demonstrate a stammer, but be careful not to offend anyone in your class), assertive (being confident in what you say), interact (communicate with and respond to other people) and be yourself (behave naturally). • Ask students to try to decide if the statements are true or false before they read the leaflet again. • Give students four minutes to re-read the leaflet to check their ideas and answer any statements they couldn’t do in the previous stage. • Students compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. 1 NG 2 NG 3 F 4 T 5 T not makes this false.) 7 T 6 F (The word 15 Communication 0 0 5 Give students two minutes to think about these questions and then put them into pairs/small groups to discuss. Encourage them to say why they think they’re good at, or need to develop, some skills. To follow up, ask students if this is a course they’d be interested in doing and why. VOCABULARY: idioms 6a Elicit/Tell students that idioms may have a meaning that is not conveyed by individual words. • If students have good English–English dictionaries, ask them to use these to check their answers. Tell them to decide which the key words are in the idioms to help them find the entry. • Students work individually before comparing their answers with a partner. If they don’t know an idiom and aren’t using dictionaries, tell them to make a best guess. • Go through the answers with the class. 1f 2g 3d 4c 5b 6a 7e 6b Give students a minute to think about their answers before putting them in pairs to discuss. • Encourage them to ask each other questions to find out as much information as possible. • Take class feedback. Ask three students for their feedback for each question. • For further practice, ask students to do Exercise V3–6 on page 127 in the Language reference. 1 yes 2 no 3 no 4 temporary 5 while she was studying for her MBA 8 Keep students in the same pairs as for Exercises 7a and 7b. Students will benefit from having to think through their answers with another student, so don’t interrupt or prompt too much while they’re working. • Check answers with the class. • For further practice, ask students to do Exercises G1–1 and G2–2 on page 127 in the Language reference. For weaker groups, write up some of the key language on the board (permanent, temporary, habitual, etc.) so students learn the correct terminology. 1a The writing is in progress. 1b The writing is habitual. 2a permanent 2b temporary/in progress 3a The having dinner happened first and was in progress when the colleague arrived. 3b The having dinner happened second. 4a completed action in the past 4b background situation/setting the scene 5a permanent 5b temporary/in progress 6a habitual 6b temporary 9a Ask students to predict what kind of word (i.e. word class) will be the answer. They may be able to guess it is an adverb by looking at the question key word (how). Students answer the questions individually before you check in class. GRAMMAR: the continuous aspect 1 rapidly 2 dramatically 7a Elicit how the continuous aspect is formed (be + -ing) and any uses students already know. 0 • Tell students to find the six remaining examples 0 and underline them in the texts. Help any students that cannot find them all. • Read through the Grammar tip with the class. Elicit the word trend so that they understand the purpose of the tip (a general change in the way people are behaving). Also elicit collocate (when words are commonly used with other words). 9bEmphasise that students should use the language in the Grammar tip for this exercise. • Individually, students think of at least one sentence for each question 1–7. • Students then compare their answers in pairs or small groups. Encourage partners to ask follow-up questions (e.g. Why do you think that? What evidence do you have for that?). • For each question, ask two or three groups for an answer. Provide sample answers where necessary. • Put students in pairs to try to decide the time frame for each example (in progress, changing, etc.) before they look at Exercise 7b. is rising, is increasing, are taking, are talking, is carrying out, was studying, is communicating 7b Students answer the questions individually and then compare their answers with their partner from Exercise 7a. • If necessary, refer students to the Language reference on page 126. • Go through the answers with the class and check that they understand. 16 Communication 0 0 1.3 WHO DOES THE TALKING? Sample answers 1 The use of tablets is increasing dramatically. 2 The web is changing our lives dramatically. 3 The universe is expanding constantly. 4 Hurricanes are occurring frequently. 5 Men are behaving differently. 6 The population is increasing rapidly. 7 Identity fraud is occurring frequently. IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging SPEAKING 10a Individually, students have a few minutes to think about their ideas for some or all of the current trends in the list. • Put students in groups (of a maximum of four students) to discuss the trends, saying how and why they are in progress and/or changing. • For feedback, ask two or three groups to tell the class what they discussed for one of the items. • Ask students which item they think is changing most quickly and why. 10b Critical thinking: Considering consequences. Understanding the link between cause and effect is an important skill at this level – describing what happens, but also what the result will be. • Individually, students take two or three minutes to decide which single trend they would like to talk about. Emphasise that they can choose whether it is important, worrying or interesting. Also emphasise that they must say how this trend affects a particular group in society. • In groups of three or four, students then present their opinion. They should be encouraged to ask follow-up questions. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the grammar, vocabulary and listening exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Students choose a trend in progress other than those in Exercise 10a, research it and write a short presentation (about 150 words) on how and why it is changing. They can give their presentations in the following lesson. Take the presentations in for marking, paying particular attention to the present continuous and present simple. Students do Exercises V3–6, G1–1 and G2–2 on page 127 in the Language reference. 0 Communication This lesson looks at the differences between men's and women’s communication. Students listen to a radio programme about a socio-linguist (Deborah Tannen), which contextualises the grammar for this lesson: the perfect aspect. Next, students read two extracts from Tannen’s book and focus on collocations related to communication. Finally, students do a speaking activity to practise using the language from the lesson. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from listening and reading texts • revised/extended their understanding of the perfect aspect, looking specifically at the present and past perfect, and the past simple • extended their range of collocations in the context of communication • participated in extended speaking practice on communication between men and women Timings If short of time, set exercise 10a as homework. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 6. WARM-UP This activity introduces the topic of differences between men’s and women’s communication. • Write the following two sentences on the board: Men are good communicators because … ; Women are good communicators because … • Divide the class in half. Tell one group to think of three reasons why men are good communicators and the other to do the same for women. You can either divide the class into groups of men and women or mix the sexes, depending on the number of each sex in your class. • In groups of four, allow five minutes for discussion. Encourage students to disagree! • Finally, ask the class to vote on which sex they think communicates better. 0 17 LISTENING R: 1 Where possible, ensure that groups for this exercise are mixed (i.e. males and females). Do not let this exercise take too long (unless students are enjoying it). Take brief class feedback afterwards. 2 Get students to read the exercise instructions and ensure that they are clear what they have to do. • Play the recording. Students complete the exercise individually and then check answers in pairs.0 0 Audio script 1.2 How are you feeling at the moment? You said on the phone yesterday that it’s been a bit rough recently. M: I don’t want to bore you, but the last few months have been terrible, Rie. R: I’m sorry to hear that. M: We’ve been married for nearly five years, but it has all gone wrong. We’ve had so many arguments recently and he has moved out. R: Oh, when did he leave? M: This evening. He phoned me from a café at 5 p.m. and asked me to meet him there after work to talk about our problems. But by the time I arrived at the café he had left. R: I’m sorry to hear that. M: It was alright until he found out that I had booked a vacation with all the girls. R: Well, you went on vacation every year with the girls before you got married. M: Exactly. He’s so controlling and it’s my money. I should have known that it wouldn’t have worked. And his mother hates me. When he introduced me to her, I knew I had seen her somewhere before. She had been a classmate of my mum and they had never been friends. R: Oh, that’s not good. M: And we … we just don’t do things together anymore. I’ve always been a sociable person but he just doesn’t like going out with me. And when we do go out in a group, he always dominates the conversation and shows off. He thinks he knows everything and he’s so insensitive. He interrupts me all the time in a group, but when it’s just the two of us he doesn’t talk and doesn’t listen. And he just won’t talk about our relationship. 1 Welcome to today’s call in programme. As some of you may know, Deborah Tannen is most famous for her books Talking from 9 to 5, about women and men at work, and You Just Don’t Understand, about women and men in conversation. She has recently written a book about how sisters communicate called You Were Always Mom’s Favorite. However, in today’s programme we’re focusing on an essay she has recently written for the New York Times about interrupting, called Would You Please Let Me Finish? and I think a number of politicians might like to read it. I’ll just give a quick summary of what Professor Tannen thinks and then I’ll take some calls. A lot of Professor Tannen’s research has focused on the fact that conversation styles can vary greatly because of different factors – for example, your age, your gender, your culture. In this article she concentrates on the issue of interrupting, and how different ideas on what interrupting is and when it is good and bad can also vary greatly depending on gender, culture and so on. To back Tannen up, some recent surveys have shown that – surprise, surprise – women tend to be interrupted more than men and that women who interrupt others are seen more negatively than men who do the same thing. However, it has also been found that there are more interruptions overall in conversations when all the people involved are women. Although these interruptions are often seen as talking along with each other, rather than talking over each other. OK, I’ll take the first caller. 2 Rie, Mae R: I’ve just made a nice pot of tea, Mae. Would you like a cup? M: Oh yes, please. In extract 1 a radio presenter is talking about an essay recently written by Deborah Tanner. In extract 2, two women are talking together over a cup of tea. One woman talks about how her marriage has gone wrong. 3 Students read the questions and answer as many as they can based on the first listening. • Play the recording again. Students check/complete their answers. • Students check with a partner before you check answers in class. • Get students to correct each other if possible. You should give the correct answer where needed. 18 Communication 0 0 1 • Talking from 9 to 5 is about men and women at work. • You Just Don’t Understand is about women and men in conversation. •You were Always Mom’s favourite is about how sisters communicate. 2 Would You Please Let Me Finish? is about interrupting. 3 age, gender and your culture 4 Women tend to be interrupted more than men. 5 nearly five years 6 Her marriage has gone wrong. 7 very badly 8 no 1 Tannen wrote has written many books. 2 In 2009, Tannen has written wrote You Were Always Mom’s Favorite! 3 Correct 4 When has this book been was this book published? 5 I realised that we met had met before. 6 Is this the first time she spoke has spoken in public? 7 Last night there have been was an all-women panel on the show. 8 When I arrived at the conference, the main speaker already finished had already finished. GRAMMAR: the perfect aspect 4a Before students answer these questions individually, explain that the purpose of the exercise is to get them thinking about time (rather than as a comprehension exercise). • Allow students two or three minutes to complete this individually before they compare in pairs. • Ensure you go through the answers in class as students will need the correct answers to do 4b. 1 no 2 yes 3 her husband 4 No 5 He left. 4b Students should discuss these questions with a partner before you discuss with the class. 0 1 the present perfect 2 the past perfect 0 Students may ask when a contraction of have/has should be used. It is common after a subject pronoun (I, you, he, she, etc.) and after the relative pronoun who. It is not as common after a proper noun (e.g. costs) in the written form. Generally, the contracted form is more common in speaking. 6 Allow students a minute to read the questions and think about (a) how they might form the questions and (b) what responses they might give. This will hopefully ensure a more fluent conversation. Encourage them not to rush the conversation – they should try and ask follow-up questions. • Students create a dialogue in pairs. You should monitor closely and help any groups who are finding this difficult. It may make the conversation more fluent and accurate if at first you check students know the past participle of each verb since some are irregular. Draw timelines on the board to help students understand the difference between the two tenses. 4c First, elicit the form of the present perfect (have + past participle) and past perfect (had + past participle), and a few examples of the past simple (started, wrote, etc.). • Then ask students to underline examples in the audio script on page 168 and compare with a partner before you check with the class. • For further practice, ask students to do Exercise G3–3 on page 127 in the Language reference. If possible, reproduce the audio script so that the whole class can see it (perhaps on the Interactive Whiteboard or an OHP). When you check answers with the class, mark the text to show examples. 5 Encourage students to think about the definitions in Exercise 4b to help do this exercise. • Students should complete the activity individually before checking with a partner. • Ensure that in class feedback, you (or the students) clearly explain not only what the mistake is, but also why it is a mistake. READING 7a Explain to students that they are going to read extracts from Deborah Tannen’s book. Quickly ask again what the book is about. • Put students in small groups to discuss the statements. Ask them to support their opinions. • In feedback, ask two students their opinion for each statement and ask others if they agree. 7b Tell students not to worry about unknown vocabulary at this stage. • Give students four minutes to read and highlight the parts of the text giving the answers. • Ask them to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. • To follow up, ask students if their own experience supports the author’s ideas. 19 Communication 0 0 1 Women are believed to talk more than men but the evidence shows the opposite. Men talk more outside the home and in public, women may talk more at home and in private. 2 They don’t specifically mention sports or feelings, but they do say women use conversation to establish connections/negotiate relationships (which may be connected to feelings). Men use conversation to negotiate status and talk about knowledge and skill (which may be connected to sports). 3 The author claims that this is true. See the examples given in 1 and 2 above. 8a Ask students to read the statements and try to answer before they read the texts again. • Allow five minutes for students to read the texts and use their dictionaries if necessary. • Don’t check answers with the class at this stage. 1M 2W 3M 4M 5W 6M 8b Give students two minutes to underline sections of the text and then three minutes to compare with their partner before you check answers. 9 Critical thinking: Identifying stylistic devices. Stylistic devices can make writing and speech more interesting for a reader or listener. This is a particularly useful skill for academic presentations because if a speaker can engage the audience’s interest, they are more likely to enjoy the presentation. • Students work with a partner to find the devices in the texts. • In feedback, ensure you spend time explaining each point in as much detail as needed. anecdotes: I was sitting … question: Who talks more, women or men? contrast: For most women, … . For most men, … direct speech: ‘It’s true,’ he explained. 10b Students complete the sentences individually and then check in pairs. 1 established connections 2 exhibit knowledge 3 negotiate relationships 4 display similarities 5 maintain status 6 impart information SPEAKING 11a Give students a few minutes to think about what advice they would give, then put them in pairs. • Encourage students to give as much information as possible and to ask each other questions. They should also try and practise the new grammar and vocabulary from this lesson. • While students are speaking, monitor to note mistakes when using the perfect aspect, the past simple and the collocations from Exercise 10a. • If necessary, prompt students with some of the points noted in the initial discussions, the listening and the reading. 11b Put pairs together. At first they should present their ideas to each other. After that, they should decide which three bits of advice are best. • Finally, ask each group to present their one best piece of advice to the rest of the class. • If appropriate, correct some of the grammar and vocabulary mistakes you noted earlier. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the listening, vocabulary and grammar exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Students listen to conversations at home, in school, while out with friends. They note who speaks more (men or women) and what they speak about. They then write a short letter or email to the producers of the radio programme, saying whether their research agrees or disagrees with Tannen’s claims. Students do Exercise G3–3 on page 127 in the Language reference. VOCABULARY: collocations 0 10a Give a strict time limit of two minutes for this 0 activity. Students should quickly scan the text for the words listed and identify the collocations. • Check answers in class. In feedback, check they understand the meaning of all the phrases. 1 connections, rapport 2 relationships, status 3 similarities 4 status 5 knowledge/skill 6 information 20 Communication 1.4 SCENARIO: 0 0 SITUATION FLAT-SHARING 1 Focus students on the poster and remind them that one source of help suggested in the Warm-up activity was a student counsellor. • Put students in pairs to briefly discuss the questions. If you think your students will find the first part of question 2 too personal, change it to Do you know anyone who has used a service like this? • If you used the Warm-up activity, students will already have listed different problems, so make this exercise and the feedback brief. 2 Read through the introduction with the class and get them to read the questions. • Play the recording without pausing. Students answer individually and then check in pairs. IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging This lesson focuses on outlining problems and offering solutions. Students are introduced to the scenario through a student advice centre and the service it provides. They listen to counsellors discussing a problem one student is having with paying his rent and then focus on the Key language. In the Task students read about four students sharing a flat and discuss the advice given to each of them by a counsellor. Finally, students decide on the best solution. 1 2 Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from reading and listening texts • learnt useful phrases for outlining problems and offering solutions • used this language in a ‘real-life’ situation to discuss problems faced by students living together • participated in extended speaking practice Timings If short of time, omit Exercise 7. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 4. WARM-UP This activity introduces the topic of problems. • Ask the class what kind of problems students (whether at university or school) often have. • Write their ideas on the board and, if necessary, add some of the following: can’t afford to eat properly, can’t finish an essay, can’t find the book you want, late handing in your work, failed an exam. • Then write a second column containing the following words: your parents, your best friend, your teacher, a student counsellor. • Tell students that they must decide which person would be best to talk to about which problem. Emphasise that there are no right answers, but that students must justify their ideas. • In pairs, students share their ideas. When finished, ask each pair what they decided and why. 3 He has been spending too much. He doesn’t have a lot of money for his everyday expenses, so he works part-time, quite long hours, to pay for his studies. talk to the owner of the flat; stick to a weekly budget; pay his rent by direct debit Audio script 1.3 Carol, Jean C: I saw Marco in your office again this morning, Jean. J: Yeah, it was the usual thing, he needs money. He shares a flat with two other students, as you know, and the problem is, he’s been spending too much money once again – he can’t pay this month’s rent. The others aren’t happy because they’ll have to pay more than usual to stay in the flat. C: Mmm, well, the way to sort it out, surely, is to tell him to get a loan from the Student Union. J: I’m not sure it’s the right thing to do, Carol. The trouble is, it’s the third time he’s run out of money. It’s always the same story. He spends too much, can’t pay the rent and then gets a loan from friends or the Student Union. C: Mmm, he’s not very good at managing his money, is he? He can’t go on like that. You know, one way of dealing with this could be to look at his weekly expenses. Then work out a budget and tell him he’s got to stick to it. J: Mmm, good idea. I’ll be seeing him again tomorrow, I’ll suggest that. I’ve already advised him to contact his bank to pay for his rent by direct debit. That way, his rent will always be paid regularly. 21 Communication 0 0 C: Was he OK about that? J: Yes, he thought it was a good idea. But unfortunately, he has another financial problem. You see, they have a lot of parties in his flat and during one of them, they broke an expensive lamp. The owner of the flat wants to charge them to replace it. Marco doesn’t have the money to pay his share of the cost. C: So, what are we going to do to help him? J: It’s not going to be easy, Carol, he’s in a difficult situation. He doesn’t have a lot of money for his everyday expenses, so he works part-time, quite long hours, to pay for his studies. But when he gets money, he likes to spend it. I told him I’d talk to you and we’d sort something out for him. What do 0 0 you think? C: Well, there’s an obvious solution. We could outlining problems: 1, 4, 5 offering solutions: 2, 6, 8, 9 reacting to suggestions: 3, 7, 10 3c In pairs, students practise saying the expressions to each other. Partners should say if they think they got the pronunciation or emphasis wrong. Monitor to check whether the pronunciation is correct, and to be ‘referee’. 3dIndividually, students match the expression to the function. They then check in pairs. outlining problems: b, d, f offering solutions: c reacting to suggestions: a, d, e, g Students practise saying these expressions, as per Exercise 3c. 4 Emphasise that the purpose of this exercise is to talk to the owner of the flat and ask her to give Marco more time to pay for his share of the lamp. You know the owner, she’s a reasonable person; I’m sure she’ll be understanding. J: Right. That makes sense to me. You know, if Marco sticks to his weekly budget and pays his rent by direct debit, we may not see him here so often. C: Let’s hope so. practise the expressions that have just been taught. Also explain that there is not one answer to this situation – students should discuss all possibilities and decide which is best. Identify three possible solutions discussed by students and get the class to vote on which one they think is best. TASK: solving communication problems KEY LANGUAGE: outlining problems, offering solutions, reacting to suggestions 3a Students read the questions and, individually, answer as many as they can based on the first listening. • Play the listening again. Students check/complete their answers. • Students check in pairs. Check answers together in class. Get students to correct each other if possible. You should give the correct answer where needed. Expressions 7 and 10 are not mentioned. The other expressions are found in the audio script. 3b Give students two minutes for this activity and then ask them to compare with a partner before checking answers with the class. Emphasise they should use all the expressions (i.e. 1–10), not just the ones which were actually in the text. 5 Read the introduction with the class and allow five minutes for students to read the descriptions and discuss the possible problems. If possible, students do this activity in groups of four. • In feedback, elicit ideas from two or three groups. 6a If possible, keep students in the same groups of four as the previous exercises. If you have an odd number in your class, form groups of three and omit the Stewart text as most information was introduced in Exercise 5. • Give students three minutes to read their information and note the key points. 6bAllow five minutes in total for students to present their information. 6c Ask students to read the questions and then remind them of the Key language on page 12. • Allow at least 15 minutes for the discussion and monitor to note errors with students’ use of the Key language. • When they have finished, correct some of the mistakes you noted earlier. Don’t elicit solutions to the problems students discussed as this is done in Exercise 7 below. 22 Communication 0 0 6d This activity gives students an opportunity to use the Key language again. • If you have a large class, divide students into two groups to discuss the solutions they thought of in Exercise 6c. • Allow about ten minutes for this activity and when they have finished, ask the class to vote on the best solution. 7dAllow students a short amount of time to think about their answer before they discuss in pairs. Emphasise that they should justify their answer. Students could create a questionnaire, where they ask some or all the members of the class these questions. A ‘class response’ to the question could then be identified. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the Key language and listening exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Students use the problems and solutions they discussed in Exercises 6c and 6d to write an advice sheet from the student advice centre for students sharing a flat. The advice sheet should give tips for a harmonious life. Students do Exercise KL–4 on page 127 in the Language reference. 1.5 STUDY AND WRITING SKILLS IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging This lesson focuses on making notes while listening and writing/checking emails. Students focus on the structure of talks. They watch a lecture about public speaking, focus on techniques for note-taking and make notes of the main points. Next, students focus on the formal and informal register of emails before writing one themselves. Finally, students look at criteria for judging writing and check their partner’s email. Study skills video Watch the video to hear a lecture about public speaking. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from reading and listening texts • learnt (more) about techniques for note-taking and practised taking notes while listening • extended their knowledge of formal and informal register in emails and practised writing one • learnt criteria for checking written work and practised on another student’s work Timings 0 0 If short of time, omit Exercise 8 or set Exercise 15 as homework, which can be checked in pairs next class. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 8. WARM-UP To lead in to the activities on note-taking, ask students if they find taking notes while listening difficult (the answer will probably be ‘yes’!). • In pairs, students list their reasons. • Explain that students are going to look at ways of taking notes. After Exercise 4, ask students if the techniques they have used help them with the difficulties they listed. STUDY SKILLS: note-taking 1 Ensure the class is clear what is meant by public speaking. Students discuss the questions in small groups. Take brief feedback. 23 Communication 0 0 2a Structure of talks • Read through the introduction with the class and tell them that the examples (a–e) are ‘signposts’ (bits of language that point you in the right direction). • Check that students understand exemplifying (giving an example) in item 5. • Students match the headings with the examples (signposts). Check answers with the class. 1b 2e 3d 4c 5a 2bStudents discuss in pairs/small groups. Then get suggestions from the class and write them on the board so that all students can copy them. Suggested answers: 1 I’m going to talk about … ; This talk will look at … 2 Secondly, … ; Then … ; Next, … ; After that … 3 The crux of the matter is … ; The main point is … 4 Alternatively, … ; To put it another way, … 5 For example, … ; To give an example, …3 Note-taking • First ask students for a few suggestions for good note-taking. Give general, brief feedback on these points, but do not go into too much detail yet. • Tell students not to worry if they find this activity difficult. They will compare their notes with another student. • Refer students to the ideas discussed in Exercise 1 as this will help them predict the content. • Play the video and get students to take notes. Study skills video 1.1 Good evening, everyone. Did you know that in many surveys the worst phobia for many people is public speaking? Not spiders or rats or heights, but having to face an audience and talk to them. How do people react when put in this situation? Well, there are a number of things which happen to our bodies when we are put in stressful situations, and making a speech is no different. Basically, your body goes into the classic ‘fight or flight’ response. In other words, your hands may sweat and your mouth may go dry. Your heart may beat faster and you may start feeling sick. You may sound strained – for instance, the audience will probably notice that you are 0 0 speaking fast and that your voice is weak and with a higher pitch than normal. You will want to rush to the end of the talk and may even ignore the audience. There is a strong feeling of wanting to run away. But making a speech to a group of people is, in fact, a great opportunity to impress them and really show what you can do, so why do so many people have a phobia about it? Well, there are several reasons. Firstly, people feel they’ll make mistakes and lose their way. Secondly, the speaker may fear that the audience won’t like them personally. And finally, they may worry that the audience will not like or really understand what they’re trying to say. All of these fears create a sense of looking a fool in front of other people, which is the main reason for all of our worries and fears – no one wants to look a fool. Now, this response is more than just nerves. That’s normal and it would be strange not to feel nervous. Nerves will keep you alert and stop you feeling too relaxed. If controlled well, nerves can make the difference between an average speech and one which keeps people listening and wanting to hear more. 4a Ask students to compare the main points and then focus them on the questions in this exercise. • Go through answers. Elicit useful note-taking techniques to the board for use in Exercise 4b. 1 main points: Public speaking is the worst phobia (much more than just nerves) for many people. People react with a ‘fight or flight’ response. Making a speech is an opportunity to impress/show what you can do. People worry about making mistakes, not being liked or understood. 2 Answers will depend on students’ notes. 3 in other words, for instance 4bIn class discussion, talk about the techniques in the coursebook and any other suggestions by the students. Explain, as necessary, how each point works. Depending on your class, they may have a lot, or not much, understanding of these points. Emphasise that note-taking is a personal issue and students should make their own choices. 5 Emphasise that this is an opportunity for students to try some new note-taking techniques. • Play the recording and, if necessary, pause it two or three times to allow students writing time. This will be helpful if students are using new techniques for the first time. 24 Communication main points: Rehearsal is essential. Practise your speech. Memorise your introduction. Begin with some kind of hook to get people’s attention. Take deep breaths before you start. Try and look confident. Focus on something other than yourself. Use plenty of eye contact. 0 Change the pace of your delivery. Change the volume of your voice and move around a bit. Don’t worry about mistakes. Use humour. 0 voice and perhaps move around a bit. Don’t worry too much about mistakes. A few mistakes are all right – they show the audience you’re human. One way you can really engage with your audience is humour: tell a joke! If you aren’t good at jokes, tell a story, or draw on your personal experience to connect with your audience. The main rule about public speaking is that there are no rules! This seems a strange thing to say, but it’s true. Everyone is an individual and so you have to find what works for you in terms of delivering a speech. The most important thing is to control your nerves, build your confidence and learn to enjoy it! There are no rules – find what works for you. Study skills video 1.2 So how can we control our nerves and become more confident about making a speech? Well, the most important thing is to get your nerves to work for you rather than against you. I intend to discuss a number of things you can do to help. First of all, I can say that rehearsal is essential. Nerves are caused by fear and being unfamiliar with things, so take time to practise your speech to feel comfortable with what you’re going to say. Secondly, it’s a good idea to know your introduction by heart. You’ll feel most nervous at the beginning and may stumble over words. If you learn the beginning, this will become second nature and help you get into the main part of the speech more comfortably. Another good thing to do is begin with some kind of interest hook, such as an anecdote or diagram or photo. This will engage the audience and help you get over the beginning of the speech. Take some deep breaths before you start. This’ll help control your nerves. Breathe in slowly, count to three and then breathe out slowly. Finally, remember you will always be more nervous than you look. You can ‘trick’ your mind in a few simple ways to help you – try and look confident and you’ll become more confident. Stand in a relaxed way, hold your head up and smile. Look happy and enthusiastic, even if you’re not! One other thing is to focus on something other than yourself. Pay attention to the environment you’re in to distract yourself. Notice the audience. For example, how are they dressed? Who’s wearing glasses? Who’s the most attractive? All of this will help to trick your mind into not noticing the situation you’re in. The less you concentrate on how you’re feeling, the more confident you’ll become. You should use plenty of eye contact, change the pace of your delivery, change the volume of your 6 Ask students to tell a partner if their notes are clearer than the first attempt and why. • If you used the Warm-up activity, ask students if the techniques helped them with the difficulties they listed at the start of the lesson. 7 Tell students not to read the video script during this exercise, but to compare when done. In feedback, ask if their versions were similar. 8 These questions would probably work best as a short, whole-class discussion. Tell students that they are free to disagree with James, but they must justify their answer if they do. WRITING SKILLS: writing and checking written communication 9 Students discuss the questions in pairs. 10 Register. Elicit the meaning of register (the different language/structures used in different forms of communication). Explain that using the right register is very important in written communication. • Give students one minute to read the emails and then elicit answers from the class. Do not go into too much detail as this is the focus of Exercise 11. 1 They don’t know each other. (formal register) 2 They know each other. (informal register) 11 Give students five minutes to complete the table and then compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. 25 Communication 0 0 Greeting: Dear Mr Hammond (F/N); Hi James (I) Request: I would like to invite you to speak (F/N); Fancy giving a talk (I) Mention of attachment: Please find attached a document (F/N); See attached for the (I) Additional information: Should you have any further questions, please do not hesitate to contact me (F/N); Any problems or queries, just let me know (I) Future contact: I look forward to hearing from you (F/N); Hope to hear from you soon (I) Ending: Yours sincerely + full name (F/N); Best + first name (I) Informal language: more contractions; shortened words (e.g. invite for invitation) and abbreviations (e.g. Mon for Monday, prog for programme); elision: missing out words to shorten (e.g. (It was a) Great talk on …); more colloquial (e.g. let me know); informal form of words (e.g. want, not wish; can, not could); more similar to spoken language; short expressions and sentences; vague language (e.g. stuff, things); little use of passive voice. (Note: The opposite is true of formal language.) Students may find this easier if they do it in two stages: first they identify which sentences are formal/informal and then put them in order. Email 1: a, i, d, k, c, m, g 12 Give students five minutes for this activity. Ask them to compare with a partner before you check answers in class. Email 2: h, l, b, e, f, j, n 0 13 Students complete the table and then compare 0 15a Tell students they cannot choose the same email. • Give 20–30 minutes to write the email and monitor to help with vocabulary. Emphasise that they should use the models in the book as necessary. 15b Peer checking. • Elicit the benefits of peer checking. • Read through the introduction and GRASP. Tell students that the same procedure can be used when they check their own work. • Give students five minutes to read each other’s emails and note the corrections that are necessary. • Ask them to return the email to the student who wrote it, who then makes the necessary changes. • Students give their corrected emails back to their with a partner. Check answers with the class. partner to use in Exercise 15c. 15c Give students 20 minutes to write the reply. Tell them to pay attention to the type of mistakes they made in exercise 15a. Students then give the reply to their partner. Thanking: Thank you for your / inviting me to (F/N); Thanks for the invite to (I) Giving bad news: I am afraid that I will be unable to (F/N); Sorry, but I won’t be able to (I) Offering help: If you wish, I could (F/N); If you want, I can see if (I) Apologising: Once again, I would like to apologise (F/N); Anyway, sorry again for (I) Future contact: Please do not hesitate to contact me (F/N); Please let me know about (I) HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the vocabulary, listening, writing skills and academic collocations exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. 14 Students think about this question individually before discussing in pairs. Ensure all the answers noted below are mentioned. 26 Communication 0 0 2 Environment Unit Objectives Grammar: Vocabulary: Scenario: Study skills: Writing skills: present perfect simple and continuous; indirect questions local environment collocations; the environment; adverbs agreeing and disagreeing politely, polite questions; attending a formal meeting designing a questionnaire writing a questionnaire 2.1 LOCAL ENVIRONMENT IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging Students listen to three people talking about their local area and learn a set of vocabulary related to local environment. Students discuss local environment issues and read an article about noise/pollution. Students summarise similarities and differences between the text and where they live and write a solution to one of the problems. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from listening and reading texts • extended their range of vocabulary in the context of local environment issues • discussed urban and local environmental issues Timings If short of time, set Exercise 9 as homework. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 4. WARM-UP This activity introduces the topic of urban versus rural environments. • Divide the class into Group A and Group B. 0 0 • Group A list three advantages of living in an urban environment and three disadvantages of living in a LISTENING AND VOCABULARY: local environment collocations 1 Check students know all the words in the box. They should know, or be able to guess, the majority. • If possible, put students together who live in different areas (though this may be timeconsuming or not relevant to your class). • Students discuss the questions in pairs. Ask three or four pairs to feed back to the class. 2 Depending on your class, you may need to check they understand the concept of a survey. • Tell students not to worry about vocabulary at this stage as it is covered in Exercise 2. They should be able to guess most vocabulary from the context. • Play the recording without pausing. Individually, students complete the table. • Students compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. • Finally, ask students if any of the points made by the different speakers were similar to their own (or their partner’s) situation. Type of building: 1 detached house 2 farm cottage 3 apartment block Where they live: 1 suburb of a major city 2 countryside, edge of a very small village 3 city centre What they like: 1 access to facilities and shops, local area is green, good public transport connections 2 peace and quiet, rural environment. Group B do the opposite. • Put students in A–B pairs. Give them five minutes to persuade each other that their environment is better. • Take a class vote on which environment they would prefer to live in. Albert Einstein quote: This means that when compared against the wider environment, an individual is not very important. fresh air, no traffic congestion, little noise and light pollution, pace of life is slower, fantastic views 3 cosmopolitan atmosphere, plenty to do, wide range of shops, get whatever I want any time, liveliness, surrounded by people all the time, loads of police so feel very safe Problems: 1 mindless vandalism 2 wind farm for some, abandoned cars 3 litter New Language Leader Upper Intermediate Environment 0 0 27 People talk about the crime rate in the city, but where I live there always seems to be loads of police, so I feel very safe. The one thing that gets me down is the amount of litter people drop on the streets. It’s so unnecessary and just makes me feel depressed. Most of it could be recycled, it seems to me, if there were more recycling points. I guess a lot of people don’t really care about the way the urban environment looks. I sometimes feel like saying to them, ‘I have to live here with all your rubbish.’ The council could do more to keep the streets clean as well, I suppose, but we all have to pay for it in higher taxes. Audio script 2.1 1 2 3 Well, I live in a detached house in a suburb of a major city. Mmm, what do I like about it? Mmm, well, for a start it’s a friendly neighbourhood. I also like the access to all the facilities and shops, but what I really like is the fact that my local area is very green – you know, lots of parks and open spaces for the kids. The public transport connections are very good too, so I can be in the city centre in a very short time if I avoid the rush hour. So I guess you could say I have the best of both worlds! I suppose it’s what people call a ‘desirable area’. The only real problem, I think, is the mindless vandalism that goes on, you know, damage to cars and bus stops, which we all have to pay for in the end. It’s bored young people with nothing to do. I suppose it’s the price you pay for living in a city. I live in a farm cottage on the edge of a very small village, almost a hamlet, really, in the countryside. It really is very rural – about 25 kilometres to the nearest town. It’s the peace and quiet I like really, and the fresh air. There aren’t many vehicles on the roads – so no traffic congestion … the air’s very clean, and there’s very little noise and light pollution. The whole pace of life is much slower – no one rushes anywhere. Oh yes, and the fantastic views. The beautiful natural environment with the hills means I’m surrounded by magnificent scenery. There’s a bit of trouble with a wind farm which could spoil it for some people, but I guess renewable energy is the future. The main environmental issue we have at the moment is abandoned cars. People are dumping old cars they don’t want any more in the village at night. We then have to wait for ages before they’re taken away. I live in an apartment block in the city centre. It’s the cosmopolitan atmosphere I like. There’s always plenty to do and such a wide range of shops. I can go out at any time of the day or night and get whatever I want, either food and drink or entertainment. The cultural activities are endless. I love the liveliness of the city and being surrounded by people all the time – you know, that constant buzz of activity. 3 Students make as many combinations as they can before they compare with a partner. • Tell students to try to guess the meaning from the context and then play the recording again. • Check answers with the class and provide the meaning of unknown words if necessary. • For further practice, ask students to do Exercise V1, 2–6 on page 129 in the Language reference. (Stressed words/syllables are underlined.) 1 detached house 2 rush hour 3 desirable area 4 noise pollution 5 natural environment 6 wind farm 7 cultural activities 8 cosmopolitan atmosphere 9 crime rate 10 recycling points 11 friendly neighbourhood 12 open spaces 13 transport connections 14 mindless vandalism 15 traffic congestion 16 renewable energy 17 environmental issue 18 abandoned cars 19 apartment block 20 urban environment PRONUNCIATION 4 Critical thinking: Collocations. Understanding words that commonly collocate with other words will help students to sound more like native speakers. • Do the first item with the class. Agree the system for marking stress (e.g. underlining), then put them in pairs to mark the others. • When finished, play the recording, pausing after each item to allow students to check the stress. • Write the collocations on the board and mark stress as you check answers with the class. See answer key to Exercise 3 above. 28 Environment 0 0 In compound nouns (e.g. noise pollution, crime rate) the stress is usually on the first word or the first part if it is written as one word (e.g. whiteboard). If the phrase is adjective + noun (e.g. detached house, abandoned cars), the stress is mostly on the second word (i.e. the noun). However, this is dependent on context. READING 5 Put students in pairs to discuss the list and add other examples. Monitor to help with vocabulary if necessary. • Elicit answers and write useful additions on the 0 0 board so all students can copy them. Students must justify their answers in each case. 1 The government-commissioned survey, The study – carried out for 2 designed to measure 3 was a problem of similar scale, ranked much more highly 4 according to a new survey, the survey also established, the survey finds 8a Critical thinking: Identifying similarities and differences. Put students in small groups to identify the main facts of the article. Elicit the facts from them and write them on the board (e.g. Dog mess affects the quality of life. Noisy neighbours are not that much of a problem.). • Students make two sets of notes, about their country as a whole and their local area. Ask them to note if some points are the same for both. 6 • • • This exercise may work best if you ask groups to rank the problems 1–9 (where 1 = worst and 9 = least worst). Focus students on the photo and the title of the article and elicit what they think it is about. Tell students to read the questions before they read the article and not to worry about vocabulary as this will be covered in Exercise 7a. Ask them to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. Finally, ask students which ideas they discussed in Exercise 5 were mentioned in the article. 8bWhen making pairs, put students from different countries (or different local areas) together. • Take feedback from a sample of the class. Students could write their own newspaper story for their own area, based on the model on page 17 and using the language in Exercise 3. SPEAKING AND WRITING 9 Ideally, students should work with the same partner as in Exercise 5. • If time allows, put two pairs together to compare their answers. Encourage students to identify what they think is the best answer in each case. If possible, give students a sheet of paper which lists the nine points in Exercise 5 in a two-column table. This will make it easier for them to add their solutions next to each problem. 10 Encourage students to choose the problem which is most relevant to their particular country. • Ensure students plan the paragraph before writing it. 1 more than 2,000 2 residents who were already dissatisfied with their home, residents in medium- or high-rise flats 3 two in five (local council/police), one in four (neighbours) 4 because people are able to develop ‘immunity’ to it; they consider it part of the environment 7a Give students five minutes to find the vocabulary. They compare answers with a partner before you check with the class. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the vocabulary and pronunciation exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. 1 findings 2 poll 3 issues 4 scale 5 develop ‘immunity’ (Note: ‘immunity’ is in inverted commas because it is normally associated with disease.) 6 synonymous 7 lack of consideration 8 priority Students do exercise V1, 2–6 on page 129 in the Language reference. 7b Students work individually and then compare answers with a partner before you check with the class. Ensure they note that for questions 1, 3 and 4 more than one answer is needed. 29 Environment 0 0 2.2 CHANGING ENVIRONMENT forest in deforestation, the prefix ex- in extinction). • Students check their answers with a partner. They can use a dictionary if necessary. • Check answers with the class. IN THIS LESSON 1 h 2 e 3 j 4 a 5 b 6 c 7 g 8 i 9 d 10 f Lesson topic and staging 3 Explain that this kind of ‘matching paragraph headings’ activity is common in many English reading exams such as the IELTS Reading test. • Ask students to outline the best strategy for answering this kind of question (i.e. read all ten headings, read the paragraph, identify the main theme of the paragraph, choose heading). • Students match the headings individually before checking answers with a partner. • Check answers with the class. Students look at language connected to the changing environment and then read an article about the effects of global warming. Next, students look at the use of the present perfect simple and continuous in the article and practise using these tenses. Finally, they use this grammar to discuss environmental changes in their local environment. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from a reading text • expanded their range of vocabulary in the context of environmental change • revised/extended their knowledge of the present perfect simple and continuous • discussed changes in their own environments 1d 2j 3c 4g 5a 6h 7e 8b 4 Ask students to scan the text for the numbers and underline them. • Individually, students find the numbers in the text. and then write down briefly what they refer to. Do 2005 as an example. Timings If short of time, omit Exercise 6. Exercise 8 could be set as homework. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 6. WARM-UP 0 This activity introduces the topic of environmental change. 0 1.1–6.4 degrees centigrade that the earth could warm this century 20–30 % of species that climate change will put at risk two-thirds amount of the world’s polar bears that could be lost by mid-century 2005 the year a glacier survey was published 442 number of glaciers surveyed in 2005 90 % of the world’s glaciers that are shrinking 2000–2009 hottest decade on record 50 number of years in recent time very heavy rain has increased in frequency • Write the folllwing on the board: recycle, use public transport, fly less, become vegetarian, insulate your house, buy food grown locally. Check students understand each term. • Students work in groups to discuss which things they already do, which things they think they should do and which things they think are a waste of time. • Finally, ask students to vote who is the ‘greenest’ person in their group. 5 Critical thinking: Identifying sources. Sources are very important in formal writing, since they provide authority and strengthen your argument. • Check that students understand what is meant by source by identifying the first one together. • Students do this exercise in stages. First, they underline the sources and then answer the two questions. • Students compare answers in pairs before you take class feedback. READING AND VOCABULARY: the environment 1 Students work in groups of three or four and discuss the questions. • Set the activity. Encourage students to use clues in each word to guess meanings (e.g. the word 30 Environment 0 0 • Students compare answers in pairs, discussing why each form is used in each case. • Take class feedback for all the examples. • Refer students to the Language reference on page 128 if they need further help. (source: underlined; key phrases: in bold) According to the IPCC, climate change will put some 20–30 percent of species globally at an increasingly high risk of extinction, possibly by 2100. The U.S. Geological Survey has warned that two-thirds of the world’s polar bear populations could be lost by midcentury as sea ice continues to retreat. The U.S. Geological Survey reports that slight changes in the climate may result in sudden changes in ecosystems. A recent IPCC report predicts that sea levels could rise 25–38 centimetres by 2100 if current warming patterns continue. A 2005 survey of 442 glaciers from the World Glacier Monitoring Service found that 90 percent of the world’s glaciers are shrinking as the planet warms. The World Meteorological Organisation reported that 2000–2009 was the hottest decade on record. The recent IPCC report concludes that very heavy rain has increased in frequency during the last 50 years. According to the National Centre for Atmospheric Research, the percentage of the Earth’s surface suffering drought has more than doubled since the 1970s. present perfect simple: used because the action is completed; examples: has warned, has disappeared, has increased, has been, has more than doubled present perfect continuous: used because the action is ongoing – started in the past and is still continuing; examples: have been losing, has been melting 8 Make sure students are aware that both tenses are possible for two of the questions. They complete the task individually, then check in pairs. Students may use the wrong form of have as an auxiliary. They need to check whether the subject is singular or plural in this exercise. 1 has been disappearing 2 has shrunk/has been shrinking 3 has already vanished 4 have been working 5 has sent 6 has tried/has been trying 7 have questioned 8 has just published 6 Students work in pairs to discuss the questions. Take two or three sample answers for each question in class. Encourage students to justify their answers. SPEAKING 9 Put students in small groups for this activity. • Elicit the pronunciation for contracted have (’ve) and tell students to try to use this in their discussions. They can refer to dictionaries for unknown vocabulary. • Monitor to note common mistakes using the present perfect or continuous. • Finally, take class feedback and correct some of the mistakes you noted earlier. GRAMMAR: present perfect simple and continuous 7a First, ask students to read the sentences and emphasise that they should focus on the small differences between them. • Students answer the questions individually. • Put students in pairs to check/agree on answers. • Go through the answers carefully with the class. Students often find the distinction between these two tenses very difficult, so careful explanation may be needed. You might also explain that in reality, there is often not much distinction between the two. 1 a = present perfect continuous; b = present0 perfect simple 2 yes 3 yes 4 b 5 a HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the grammar, reading and vocabulary exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. 0 Students write a letter to their local newspaper describing the changes they have noticed in their local environments, saying either how concerned they are or if they think the changes aren’t a problem. They can use the ideas they discussed in Exercise 9. 7b Individually, students find as many examples of the two tenses as possible in two minutes. Students do Exercises G1–1, G1–2 and V3–7 on page 129 in the Language reference. 31 Environment 2.3 EXTREME ENVIRONMENT IN THIS LESSON SPEAKING AND LISTENING 0 0 1 Ensure that books are closed for this exercise. In feedback, get students to explain how they know that their suggestions/facts are true (i.e. what is the source). 2 Give students three minutes to guess the answers. They then compare answers with a partner. • Answers will be checked in the listening. 3 Ask students to read the questions. Play the recording and get the students to listen for the answers. Explain they will get a chance to listen again and check their answers to Exercise 2 later. Lesson topic and staging Students check their knowledge of volcanoes before listening to a related lecture. They then look at indirect questions used in the listening text and practise using the grammar themselves. Students read about Yellowstone Park in the USA and focus on adverbs contained in the text. Finally, students read/take notes on different texts about volcanoes and give a short presentation on the topic. Audio script 2.3 Professor, Students P: Finally, to check you’ve all been listening, I’m going to ask you a question. So, what is a volcano? Yes, the young man in the red shirt. S1: Erm, volcanoes are a natural way that the Earth has of cooling off … well, the Earth and other planets. P: Yes, that’s right. OK. Do you have any questions for me? Yes, the woman in the green jacket. S2: Professor, can I ask what the biggest volcano in the world is? P: Right, that’s easy. The biggest volcano on Earth is Mauna Loa in Hawaii and it’s about 8.5 kilometres high – that’s from the bottom of the ocean to its top. It’s interesting that most of the volcanoes on Earth are found around the rim of the Pacific Ocean. But there are volcanoes around the coastline of Antarctica and there are even volcanoes underwater. There are probably more volcanoes and eruptions than people think. Out of an estimated 1,500 active volcanoes around the world, 50 or so erupt every year. Another question … yes, you. S3: Umm, is it true that people can go inside volcanoes? P: That’s an interesting question. Obviously, you can’t go inside an erupting volcano. As I told you, extremely high pressures under the Earth cause volcanoes to erupt – the pressure forces very hot lava up out of the volcano. Lava flows can have temperatures up to 1,250 degrees centigrade. But actually, the answer to your question is yes. You can go inside volcanoes. Some people live inside volcanoes as some of them don’t erupt for a Meet the expert video Watch the video to hear from a volcanologist. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from listening and reading texts • revised/learnt about indirect questions and practised using these • revised and/or extended their range of adverbs • given a short presentation about volcanoes Timings If short of time, omit Exercise 6b. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 6b. WARM-UP This activity introduces extreme environments. • Write on the board: Group 1: volcanoes, sea/water, land, air, forest Group 2: lava, flood, hurricane, blaze, earthquake, tsunami, eruption, tornado. • Put students in pairs and tell them to match the words in Group 1 with the words in Group 2. Note that multiple answers may be possible. • In feedback, check answers and vocabulary. Ask the class if anyone has experienced any of these. volcanoes, lava, eruption sea/water, flood, hurricane, tsunami land, earthquake air, tornado, hurricane forest, blaze 32 Environment 0 0 long time. In the USA people live in three volcanoes, the most famous being the large volcano under Yellowstone National Park, which, incidentally, has been showing a lot of activity recently. Yes, the young man with the beard. S4: Could you tell me if Vesuvius is an active volcano? P: Well, an active volcano is one that has erupted in historical time. Vesuvius, which is east of Naples in Italy, famously destroyed Pompeii in AD 79 and it is the only volcano on the European mainland to have erupted within the last hundred years – I think it was 1944. So yes, it is an active volcano; and a lot of people live near it. In fact, one in ten of the world’s population live within volcanic danger zones. Another question ... yes? S5: I’d like to know why volcanoes stop 0 erupting. P: That’s a good question. There are three possible reasons. Maybe the heat runs out 2 It is true that people can go inside volcanoes? 3 Could you tell me if Vesuvius is an active volcano? 4 I’d like to know why volcanoes stop erupting. 5 Do you know whether the Chilean Copahue volcano is safe for the local people? 5b Students discuss this question in pairs before you elicit ideas from the class. Due to the relationship between the professor and the students. Direct questions are less formal and therefore show the professor is in a ‘powerful’ position. Indirect questions are more formal/polite/tentative and show the students are in a less powerful position. 0 5c Students work individually, using examples in 5a. You may need to explain grammar words. • Ask students to compare with a partner and use the Language reference on page 128 if they need extra help. • Check answers with the class and elicit the relevant examples from Exercise 5a. when the rocks are melted. Or the hot rocks, which, if you remember, we call magma, solidify on their way up. Or the magma can’t generate enough pressure to crack the rock above it. OK, last question … yes? S6: Do you know whether the Chilean Copahue volcano is safe for the local people? 1 T 2 T 3 T (except where the indirect question begins with Do you know 4 F (we use a question mark only when the introductory sentence is a question, e.g. Do you know …?) 6a Re-elicit the introductory phrases from 5a (Can I ask, Is it true, Do you know, Could you tell me I’d like to know) and go through the example with the class. • Students work individually and then compare answers with a partner. Encourage them to use the examples in Exercise 5a, the information in Exercise 5c and the Language reference if they need help. Try not to correct students yourself. • While they are working, write the direct questions on the board. When checking answers, write the indirect versions to show the changes. 1 the end of a lecture, when students ask the professor questions 2 professor–students, therefore quite formal 3 five 4 Students work with the same partner as in Exercise 2. They correct any of their answers based on the first listening. They then listen again and correct any as necessary. 1 T 2 T 3 F 4 T 5 F 6 T 7 T 8 F 9 T 10 T Example answers: 2 Can you tell me how many volcanoes erupt each year? 3 Could you tell me what causes a volcano to erupt? 4 Can you tell me which is the biggest volcano in the USA? 5 Do you know which volcano has been showing a lot of activity recently? 6 I’d like to know when Vesuvius destroyed Pompeii. 7 Could you tell me when Vesuvius last erupted? 8 Can you tell me whether a lot of people live near Vesuvius? GRAMMAR: indirect questions 5a Remind students about the relationship discussed in Exercise 3. • Before students read the audio script, ask them to discuss with a partner how they think the questions in the table were asked. • Give them four minutes to check the audio script and fill in the table before checking answers. 33 Environment 0 0 6bPut students in pairs to ask and answer the questions, referring to the audio script on page 169 if they don’t know the answer. • For further practice, set Exercises G2– 3 and G2–4 on page 129 in the Language reference. VOCABULARY: adverbs 9 Introduce this exercise by eliciting the function of adverbs (to modify the meaning of verbs and, occasionally, adjectives and other adverbs). • Give students three minutes to match the adverbs. Then allow them to use dictionaries if necessary (e.g. after 90 seconds). • Students compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. • For further practice, ask students to do Exercise V4– 8 on page 129 in the Language reference. 1 about 8.5 km 2 about 50 3 high pressures under the Earth 4 the one under Yellowstone National Park 6 AD 79 7 1944 8 yes READING 7 Focus students on the photo and title on page 21 Ask if any of them have been to Yellowstone Park and if they have heard of Bill Bryson or read any of his books (see background information below). • Allow two minutes for this activity. Students read the text quickly and highlight the five topics before working out the correct order. 1c deliberately – intentionally; mainly – mostly; normally – generally; perhaps – possibly; relatively – comparatively; slowly and carefully – thoughtfully SPEAKING 10a Put students in groups of three (similar ability if possible). Ensure they turn to the correct page and do not see the other texts. • Allow students two to three minutes to read the text and make notes. Tell them that these notes will be used to give a presentation. Monitor to help with language or content as needed. If you are concerned that your students might find the texts difficult, put together groups of students in As, Bs and Cs so that they can compare notes on the text before they go on to Exercise 10b. 10b Critical thinking: Presenting. Ensure that students read the instructions and that they are clear they must ask questions afterwards. • In turn, students give their short presentations and the other students ask questions. 2d 3a 4e 5b 8 Set the activity and check students understand cataclysm (a huge and terrible disaster). • Ask students to read the extracts again. Emphasise that they should answer in their own words. • Students compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. • Finally, ask students if they are interested in visiting the park and why/why not. Yellowstone Park is located mostly in Wyoming, USA and was the world’s first national park (1872). Bill Bryson is a best-selling writer of humorous travel and language books. In 2003 he published A Short History of Nearly Everything, which explains areas of science in everyday language. 1 It means Yellowstone Park is a beautiful 0 place but is also very dangerous because of the volcanic activity. 2 about 72 km across, i.e. 0 MEET THE EXPERT 1 In pairs, students briefly discuss the questions. • Take class feedback. 2 Individually, students read the topics and predict the order they might come in. • Students watch the video and check their answers with a partner. • Take class feedback. from one side to the other, and about 13 km thick 3 Because the explosion would be enormous but nobody can predict exactly how bad it would be. 4 No. Nobody was there the previous time it exploded, so they don’t know what the warning signs are. 5 Because there are already all the usual warning signs (earthquakes, etc.) but nothing has happened yet. 6 Because more than three million people visit it each year, the roads are narrow, which slows traffic down, and it can take half a day to drive across the park. e, b, d, a, c 34 Environment 0 0 I’ve worked on approximately fifteen of the world’s active volcanoes. I’ve worked in various different locations; in Central America, the Caribbean, uh, Papua, New Guinea. Meet the expert video Andrew McGonigle, volcanologist Uh, my name is Andrew McGonigle, I’m an academic scientist at the University of Sheffield and my specialism is in volcanism. I study volcanoes to try and understand how they work in order to help us predict eruptions. Most of my work there was focussed on Italy, in particular Etna and uh Stromboli. Both of these volcanoes have got fascinating eruptive styles. Etna has these uh large lava flow eruptions which happen once a year or once every few years or so, where Stromboli erupts every ten minutes or so creating these wonderful natural fireworks if you like, these, these jets of, of molten red rocks which are, which are shot up into the sky, a few hundred metres into the air. And these are particularly spectacular to view at night time. Volcanoes have a very great appeal to me as a scientist in the sense that they provide us an almost unique possibility to look down at, into processes occurring within the centre of the earth. They’re like a keyhole or a window if you like through which we can, we can understand these, these otherwise entirely hidden processes. Volcanoes affect us in so many ways. Uh an, an excellent example of this was the, the 2010 Spring eruption of the volcano in Iceland, which, of course, caused such big disruption to, to air travel, really all across the world, but especially between North America and Europe. It seemed as if almost everyone knew someone who’d had their travel plans disrupted as a consequence of that and I think for a lot of people that was a, a real shock to realise that even if we don’t live right next to a volcano, we can still be very affected by an eruption. Another important Italian volcano is, is Vesuvius which is potentially Europe’s most dangerous volcano. We’re aware of this from the archaeological record because of what happened in ad 79 during the very famous eruption during the Roman period, during which the towns of Pompeii and Herculaneum were destroyed. Those styles of eruption didn’t just happen there, they’ve happened many times subsequently and the people living within the Bay of Naples region uh of whom there are millions are potentially at risk for these kind of eruptions happening again in the future. There are a number of ways of, of studying volcanic gasses. Um the, the, the traditional approach has been for scientists to climb to the summit of volcanoes, descend into craters to active vents, then collect gas samples in, in glass bottles, take them back to the laboratory and analyse them to gain subsequent information. Italy is subject to a number of natural disasters; for instance, earthquakes and volcanoes. Therefore, the Italian government has set in place an agency which is responsible for responding to those, the Department for Civil Protection. Whilst this provides very detailed information the clear drawback is that it’s exceptionally dangerous and in fact a number of scientists have died uh collecting these, these forms of data. So my work and that of a number of my colleagues has been to try and pioneer remote methods of doing these measurements i.e. safe ways of, of, of doing this. In the case of Vesuvius where, where an eruption is due to take place the Department for Civil Protection is responsible for the evacuation plans, which I believe at present takes seventytwo hours, although there are constant efforts to, to improve upon those and to get that time down even further. One of these has involved um some work that I’ve been involved in using remotely controlled helicopters which carry gas sensors from a safe distance from the volcano. We then fly these into the crater. They collect gas samples. They do measurements and then they return back to us, all the while with the scientists remaining at safe distances from source. Environment 0 Within science, we can apply probabilities to various future events taking place, and that’s the information that we will then provide to uh civil protection agencies and policy making agencies as well. Therefore, there’s a real need for dialogue between the scientists who are telling us about what’s happening underground and 0 35 then the policy makers who need to make strategic decisions about remo-, about getting people out from the volcano. There have been some excellent examples of this dialogue going very well. For instance, uh, during the last big eruption, uh, in 1991 Mount Pinatubo eighty thousand people were evacuated successfully. Equally, in the past there have been examples where this dialogue hasn’t gone so well. So there’s a constant need to make 0 this, this dialogue where these two parties often 0 speak quite different languages to work very, 2.4 SCENARIO: SPARROW HILL WIND FARM IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging This lesson focuses on the language of agreeing/ disagreeing politely and asking polite questions. Students are introduced to the scenario of a company who wants to build a wind farm. They listen to a government official and a company representative talking about the farm, which leads to a focus on the Key language. Finally, in the Task, they take part in a meeting to discuss the proposal. very well. 3a In pairs, students complete as many of the gaps as they can. Do not take feedback at this stage. 3b Students watch again and check/complete. • Take class feedback. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from a reading and a listening text • learnt useful phrases for agreeing, disagreeing and asking questions politely • used this language in a ‘real-life’ situation to discuss a proposal to build a wind farm 1 predict 2 centre of 3 affect 4 detailed information 5 remotely controlled helicopters 6 erupting 7 hundred metres 8 dangerous volcano 9 72 hours 10 policy makers 4a The same pairs guess/look up the meaning of the words and match the pairs. 1c Timings If short of time, omit Exercise 4, but make sure you model pronunciation and monitor its use during Exercise 5. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 4. 2e 3a 4d 5b 4b In pairs, students discuss which job they think would be most interesting and explain why. WARM-UP HOMEWORK OPTIONS This activity introduces the topic of renewable resources. Students do the grammar, listening, reading and vocabulary exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. They can also do the MyEnglishLab video activities after this point. • Write on the board: fossil fuels (gas, oil, coal), wind energy, solar energy (sun), wave energy (the sea), nuclear energy. • Put students in pairs and give one resource to each pair. • Ask students to think of as many advantages of their resource as possible and one disadvantage for each of the other resources. • Put students in groups of three to six so that each student in a group represents a different resource. Ask them to argue why their resource is better than the others and to disagree with other students. • Monitor and note the language they use for disagreeing. Students do Exercises G2–3, G2–4 and V4–8 on page 129 in the Language reference. 36 Environment 0 0 • Ask students which resource had the most advantages in their group and write some of the phrases they used for disagreeing. Tell students that they will be looking at other phrases for disagreeing (as well as agreeing) in this lesson. Audio script 2.4 and answer key to Exercise 3b Switchboard, Deborah Rydell, John Reynolds S: DR: SITUATION S: 1 Focus students on the photo on pages 22–23 and elicit that this is a wind farm. Pre-teach turbine. • Ask students to name some other kinds of alternative power (e.g. wave, solar). Then elicit renewable sources from wave and solar. • Explain that students are going to discuss building a wind farm later in the lesson. • Ask students to read the questions before they read the text, using their dictionaries if necessary. • Students compare answers with a partner before you check with the class. • Finally, ask the class if wind farms are common in their country and/or what kind of renewable sources of power are used or could be used. 1 Sources of energy and advantages (+) and disadvantages (–) mentioned: fossil fuels (+ none mentioned, – being used up, emit carbon dioxide); nuclear power (+ none mentioned, – doubts about safety); solar 0 (+ renewable, – none given); wave (+ renewable, – none given); wind power DR: S: DR: JR: DR: JR: DR: JR: 0 DR: Good morning, Power Gas and Electricity, how can I help you? Good morning. Can I speak to John Reynolds, please? Certainly. Who’s calling, please? It’s Deborah Rydell, from the Department of Energy. Putting you through now. Hello, is that John? Speaking. Hi, John. It’s Deborah from the Energy Department. I wanted to have a chat with you about the wind farm proposal – you know, the one at Sparrow Hill. OK, Deborah. You’re still in favour of it, I hope. You’re not going to cancel it, are you? Well, it’s not really my decision, John. Personally, there’s no doubt in my mind that wind farms are the future, although some of my colleagues seem to think we should be doing more with nuclear power. It’s much more cost effective at the moment, they say. Well, that’s one way of looking at it, but we need to think long term. We just can’t go on in the same old way. You’re absolutely right, because oil and gas (+ renewable, – spoil the landscape, not reliable) 2 80 turbines, 60 metres tall, turbine of 35 m diameter, an area of several kilometres (Students may also say that the fact it will take five years to complete is evidence that it will be large. Accept if suggested, but don’t give this as an answer yourself.) will run out, eventually. Well, really, my reason for calling, John, is that I’d like to know when you think we should have the first public meeting about Sparrow Hill – you know, to stop any rumours. JR: Well, it’s a bit too early. I’m totally convinced that we should wait until we get further with the process, as there’s likely to be a lot of trouble about this. DR: You have a point, but don’t you think we should have a meeting and put our case early? I mean, I’m sure we’ll be able to get some supporters to attend. I was wondering if holding a public meeting sooner rather than later could really help. JR: Mmm, I see what you mean, but I’m just worried that it could get very noisy – you know a lot of people feel strongly about this sort of thing. Though, thinking about it, I’m interested in knowing what sort of local support you think we’re likely to get. It 2 Read the introduction and questions with the class. Tell students that Deborah is the government official and John is the power company representative. • Play the recording without pausing. Give students two minutes to compare answers with a partner before you check with the class. 1 John is initially against the idea, but changes his mind as it will show how people in the areas feel. Deborah supports the idea. 2 He thinks it’s too early and that it’ll cause trouble; it could get out of hand. 3 They decide to call a public meeting in July. 37 Environment 0 0 DR: JR: DR: JR: DR: JR: could also be a great chance to see how people who live in the area really feel. Yes, exactly. I just think if we want it to get public approval, we need to persuade people it’s right for the area from the start, and this would be a good opportunity. That’s very true, because without local support, we’re probably not going to get much further very quickly. OK, I’ll sort out a venue for some time in July and organise some publicity and security. I think that’s important in case things get out of hand. I’d go along with you there, because some of these environmental groups can get quite violent. But don’t worry, I’m sure it will be OK. I really believe all the really great ideas are unpopular at first. Yes, OK, John. Goodbye. Goodbye. • In their groups, students prepare what they want to say at the meeting and brainstorm any other ideas. Monitor to help with vocabulary and prompt with ideas if necessary. 5b Put students in five new groups so that there is one of each student (A–E) in each group. • Ask students to look again at the Key language in Exercise 3. Go through the Useful phrases box, checking pronunciation. • Give the groups 20–30 minutes to have their meeting, emphasising that they must ask questions, give opinions and persuade others in their group that their opinion is right. • Monitor and note mistakes. These will be corrected in Exercise 5c. 5c The groups have five minutes to summarise the results of their meeting and elect a spokesperson. • Give each group’s spokesperson two minutes to report to the rest of the class. • The class votes on whether they think the wind farm should be built or not. • Finally, correct some of the more common important mistakes you noted in Exercise 5c. 6 Put students in groups. Give them five minutes to discuss the question. Encourage them to ask questions and give reasons for their answers. • Ask two or three students to say what would happen in their own country. KEY LANGUAGE: agreeing and disagreeing politely, polite questions 3a Tell students to guess/work out the order from their knowledge of grammar if they are unclear. They will hear the recording again in Exercise 3b. • Students work individually and then compare with a partner. Monitor to make sure students have used contractions when possible. 3b Play the recording without pausing and then ask students to compare their answers. • When you check answers, write the sentences on the board so that students can see the order. • Finally, ask students to decide if the phrases are used for agreeing (sentences 2, 6, 7), disagreeing (1, 4) or asking polite questions (3, 5). • For further practice, ask students to do exercise KL–5 on page 129 in the Language reference. 4 Put students in pairs to practise while you monitor to correct pronunciation. TASK: attending a formal meeting 0 The kind of language and skills practised in this task are very useful preparation for university HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the Key language, listening, vocabulary and pronunciation exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Tell students that they are a journalist who attended the meeting in Exercise 5b. Ask them to write a short article on the different opinions at the meeting and what was decided. Students do exercise KL–5 on page 129 in the Language reference. 0 life, e.g. seminars and tutorials, where this kind of language is common. 5a Divide the class into five groups, As, Bs, Cs, Ds and Es. Tell the As to look at their role card on page 155, the Bs to look at page 157 and so on. 38 Environment 2.5 STUDY AND WRITING SKILLS 0 0 • Students read the introduction to this activity. Put students in pairs to discuss the questions before eliciting ideas from three or four students. To motivate students and show the relevance of this lesson, point out that students at university often have to design and use questionnaires as part of their research. IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging This lesson focuses on designing and writing a questionnaire. Students listen to a lecturer giving advice on designing a questionnaire before looking in detail at different question types. Next, students read about and listen to members of an environmental organisation who want to design a questionnaire. Finally, students design the questionnaire for the organisation. Answers depend on students’ own ideas and experiences. 2 Set the context and ask students to read the questions. Then play the recording without pausing. • Students compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. Their answers do not need to be too specific as they will listen again and answer more questions in Exercise 3. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information from reading and listening texts • learnt about techniques for designing questionnaires and the types of question to use • designed and written a questionnaire for use by an environmental organisation 1 ask the right questions to get the information you want, get enough data to analyse 2 open and closed questions 3 open questions Audio script 2.5 Lecturer, Student Timings If short of time, set Exercise 10d as homework. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 5b. L: WARM- UP S: • Tell students that they are going to ask each other one question. It must get the most interesting answers possible. • Give students two minutes to think of their question. Help with topic areas if necessary (e.g. life, favourite things, happiest memory). • Students ask their question to as many other students as possible. • When they have finished, ask three or four students to tell the class what they found out. • Finally, ask the class to vote on the most interesting/the best question. L: S: L: STUDY SKILLS: designing a questionnaire 1 With books closed, write questionnaire on the board. Ask students what it is and what it does. • Pre-teach data (the information you get) and analyse (study and think about the significance of data). S: L: It’s not easy to design a good questionnaire, Paula. I’m not surprised you’re having problems. How can I help? Well, a few tips would be useful. I mean, what are the key points? Erm, OK, when you design your questionnaire, remember two things. Firstly, you need to ask the right questions so you get the information you’re looking for. And secondly, you want to make sure you get enough data to analyse. You need as many questionnaires as possible to be completed and returned to you. OK? OK, so I have to choose good questions and get as many responses as possible. Exactly. Now would you like me to give you a few tips about the wording of questions? Of course, the type of question depends on what the aims of the questionnaire are, but there are certain rules, I’d say. Oh, yes? Mmm, first of all, use simple, short sentences. And avoid questions which are too long. Some people just won’t bother to 39 Environment 0 0 S: L: S: L: answer them if they’re long, and other people just won’t understand them. OK, short and snappy questions, I’ve got it. Another thing, Paula. Try to use open and closed questions in your questionnaire. Mix them if possible. Hold on, can you explain, erm, open and closed questions? Sure. Open questions, well, they allow people to answer as they wish, for example, if you ask people, ‘How do you feel about the quality of the teaching you received?’ , it’s an open question. You’ll probably get a variety of answers. But closed questions are questions to which the answers are given, so the person answering has a limited choice. For example, a question like, ‘How satisfied are you with your course? a) satisfied, b) not 0 satisfied, c) don’t know. Circle the appropriate answer.’ Well, that’s a closed and they find out they can’t analyse the data very easily. It’s too late then! 3 Individually, students try and complete the sentences based on the first listening. • Get them to listen again, pausing after each sentence so they can check/complete. • Take feedback in class. 1 to answer them 2 as they wish 3 a limited choice 4 open questions 5 piece of information 6 of the question 7 fairly simple questions 8 analyse the data 4a Question types. Set the activity. Give students three minutes to complete it. • Students compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. 0 1C 2G 3B 4F 5A 6E 7D S: L: S: L: S: L: S: L: question; the choices are given to you. OK? Right. I suppose you get more information with open questions. Yes, you do, but it takes a lot longer to analyse all the answers! Yeah, I can see that. Oh, a word of warning about open questions: ask for only one piece of information at a time. For example, if you ask, ‘What is your opinion of the course materials and teaching method?’, that’s not really a good question. It’s really two questions and it would be better to use two separate questions, not one, to get your information. I see, OK. Another thing about questions. All questions should be clear and well structured. In other words, respondents should be able to see the point of the question; they shouldn’t be thinking, ‘What on earth does that mean?’ Also, it’s good to start with fairly simple questions which people can answer easily. This encourages them to complete the questionnaire. Yes, I see! OK, I’ve got all that. One final piece of advice: before designing your questionnaire, you need to look ahead and think carefully about how you’re going to analyse the data. People often forget to do this when they design a questionnaire, 4b Elicit brief answers from the class as most points have already been covered in Exercise 3. Open questions Advantages: people can answer as they wish, get a variety of answers, get more information; Disadvantages: takes a long time to analyse data Closed questions Advantages: easier to analyse; Disadvantages: they limit the responses 5a Give students a few minutes to decide if they think the questions are good or poor. Some questions may have good and poor elements. • Students compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. (Note: The answers below are the ideal ones. However, you should accept reasonable answers and suggestions.) 1 good: it’s easy to tick and put respondents into an age category; poor: categories are uneven and respondents to this questionnaire are more likely to be over 20; suggestion: 20–30, 30–40, 40–50, 50–60, 60–70, over 70 2 good: (Students from some cultures may say this question is too obvious because the accepted answer in their culture is yes.) 3 Poor: there are three questions; first part is fine, but ‘is it new and fuel-efficient’ may lead to a lot of ‘don’t knows’ 4 poor: does not 40 Environment 0 0 provide useful information as everyone replaces light bulbs 5 a good question E: 5b Put students in small groups. Give them five minutes to discuss why they labelled some questions as ‘poor’ and to suggest alternatives. • Elicit ideas and one alternative for each question labelled as ‘poor’ in Exercise 5a. D: S: The following are better questions: 3 Do you have a gas boiler? Yes No Tick the appropriate box. If you have a gas boiler, is it: new? fuel efficient? Put a tick () for ‘Yes’ and a cross (×) for ‘No’. 4 How often do you replace your light bulbs? D: S: WRITING SKILLS: writing a questionnaire D: 8 Students note down as many issues as they can recall from the first listening. They listen again and note down any remaining issues. • In feedback, get them to compare their notes with the ideas written on the board in Exercise 6. 6 Set the context and read through the introduction with the class. Students note their ideas and then compare with a partner. • Elicit ideas to the board so that students can refer to them in Exercise 8. 7 Ask students to read the question. Then play the recording without pausing. • Students compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. nuclear power, climate change, air pollution, real food (i.e. not genetically engineered) 9 Ask students to read the questions. Then play the recording without pausing. • Check answers with the class or ask students to check the audio script on page 170. age, marital status, sex, educational qualifications, nationality, employment status Audio script 2.6 Donna, Eduardo, Sophie 0 Exactly. And I’d add a question about their nationality – that could be very useful for us to know. True, let’s get that as well. OK, the next thing is … what issues do we want to include? Sophie, I think you’ve got some ideas about that. Yeah, I’ve done a bit of research. The key issues are … let’s see … in no particular order: nuclear power, climate change, air pollution, real food; in other words, there’s a lot of concern about genetic engineering of food products – GMOs. Those are the four key issues. OK? It’s a good list. How about protecting rainforests? It’s an important issue, I agree, but I think four issues are enough. OK, we’ll go with those. Now, what other questions … 0 The following should be ticked: 1, 2, 4, 6 D: OK, let’s talk about the questions we’ll put in our questionnaire. Eduardo, you’ve done some work on this. What have you come up with? E: OK, well, I think we all agree that we need to get some basic data about the respondents in our sample. You know, we’ll need to know their age, sex, marital status, that sort of thing. And their educational qualifications, of course. D: Yes, and also get something about their current employment situation. Are they employed or still students? Audio script 2.7 Donna, Eduardo D: E: Now, what other questions shall we include? Any suggestions, Eduardo? Yes. We’ll need to know how important each issue is for our respondents; that’ll be the first question. So, I think we should ask them to rank the issues in order of importance, with one being the top issue. And then we should have a second question asking them to give reasons for their choice. Of course, that would be an open question and the answers might be more difficult to analyse. 41 Environment 0 0 D: Yes, but it’d be a useful question, so let’s include it. Anything else? E: We’ll need to find out how aware they are of all the issues and how worried they are about them. Those could be questions three and four. Probably, for question four, they could fill in a chart with headings like ‘Very worried’, ‘Fairly worried’, ‘Not worried at all’, and they put ticks in the appropriate boxes to show their opinion. D: Great idea. Just one final point: I’d like to have a question asking if they’re prepared to help us – you know, by working in the office, interviewing people, taking part in campaigns or raising money for us – that’s very important. Let’s put one in – a final question – to find out if they want to join us. Right, time to get started writing the questionnaire. 10a Put students in groups of four and set the activity. Make sure each student chooses a different issue. • Give students 15–20 minutes to write their questions and refer them to Exercises 3 and 4 to remind them of features of good questions. • Monitor to point out mistakes and help with vocabulary. 10b Give students a maximum of five minutes to correct each others’ mistakes. 10c Give students five minutes to add suggestions to each others’ questionnaires. 10d Students elect one member of their group to write the questionnaire. Other students give ideas and suggestions. • When they have finished, ask students to show their questionnaire to others in the class. • Finally, get students to vote on the best questionnaire, based on how good the questions are. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the writing skills and academic collocations exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. This is also a good time to do the MyEnglishLab video activities. Students use their questionnaires on groups of respondents they select themselves (e.g. family, friends, another class in the school). They then write a report for the class analysing the results. 0 0 42 Environment 3 Sport Unit Objectives Grammar: Vocabulary: Scenario: Study skills: Writing skills: quantifiers; definite and zero articles idioms; self-, abstract nouns using emphasis and comparison; giving a presentation understanding essay questions 0 a for and against essay 0 3.1 FAIR PLAY SPEAKING IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging Students brainstorm what they know about different sports. They read an article about football and extract vocabulary about different aspects of sports, focusing particularly on idioms (e.g. be on the ball). Finally, students practise this language to talk about their own experiences. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from a reading text • extended their range of vocabulary and idioms related to sport • practised this language in group discussions. 1a Read the instructions and list of prompts. Focus students on the photo on page 26 as an example of a sport (downhill skiing) in which people compete against the clock (question 8). • Put students in pairs and set the time limit. 1bStudents compare ideas with a different partner. • If students don’t know the name of the sport in English, tell them to draw a picture or say how and where the sport is played. • Elicit students’ ideas to the board so that the class can copy the vocabulary they want to keep. Students’ own answers. Timings If short of time, set Exercises 7a and 7b as homework. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 6. WARM-UP • Write on the board: prefers rugby to football (soccer), doesn’t like tennis, likes watching football but can’t play, understands the rules of baseball, used to play basketball at school. • Students have to find someone for whom the statements are true by asking questions. Encourage them to ask follow-up questions (e.g. Did you play in a team at school?). • In feedback, ask students to tell you any other information they found out. George Orwell quote: This quote suggests that when played at a high/professional level, sport becomes a very serious matter and people are only interested in winning. 2 Check students know complicated (a lot of rules, hard to understand) and take up (start doing). • Put students back in their pairs from Exercise 1a. Give them five minutes to discuss the questions. • Elicit one answer from six different pairs. For question 3, elicit/give cricket as this appears in the article in Exercise 3. Take this opportunity to revise which verb (play, do or go) collocates with each sport (e.g. play football, do judo, go swimming). Ask students to label each of the sports on the board with one of the verbs and then check answers with the class. Students’ own answers. READING 3 Ask students whether anyone knows the person in the picture on page 27 (Charles Miller) or what the beautiful game is. If not, see if they can guess. • Ask students to read the headings (a–h) and give them two minutes to read the article and match. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. 1f 2d 3c 43 New Language Leader Upper Intermediate Sport 0 4a 5h 6e 0 4 Give students five to eight minutes to read the article again and answer the questions. They can use their dictionaries if necessary. Ensure students understand the not given option as this is a common source of confusion. If appropriate for your class, remind students that this exercise is similar to the IELTS Reading task, where there are true/false/not given options. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. 1 F (He was amateur.) 2 T 3 NG 4 F (Argentina) 5 NG 6 NG (Although they’ve won more times than any other country.) 7 T (the chaleira) 8 F (The club already existed, but played mainly cricket.) Pelé was given the title Athlete of the Century by the International Olympic Committee and was awarded the title of Greatest Ever Player by the International Football Association (FIFA). 5 Give students a maximum of two minutes to underline all the relevant words they can find. • Put them in pairs to match the words with the categories (1–5), using dictionaries if necessary. 0 • Check answers with the class and check students’ 0 pronunciation of amateur. • Do question 1 as an example. Give students two minutes to complete the gaps and tell them to guess if they don’t know. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. • Finally, ask students if they know the meaning of any of the idioms, but don’t give the answers as these are checked in Exercise 7b. 1 ball 2 goalposts 6 goal 7 ball 3 eye 4 field 5 game 7b Students do this activity in pairs before you check answers with the class. • Tell students that these idioms are used in many situations, not just sport, and give examples to reinforce the meaning (e.g. in business, start the ball rolling means ‘start something/a process). • For further practice, ask students to do Exercise V1– 5 on page 131 in the Language reference. a5 b1 c7 d2 e3 f6 g4 SPEAKING 8 Put students in groups of three. Emphasise that they should practise some of the idioms from 1 spectator 5 amateur Exercise 7. • Students should take a moment to consider their experiences before sharing with their group. • In feedback, ask one member from each group to share one of the experiences with the class. 2 fan 3 coach 4 referee 6 Critical thinking: Justifying opinions. Giving reasons and justifying opinions is a good habit to establish, especially at the higher levels. This is a key skill in many academic and exam tasks. • In pairs, students discuss the questions. Try to ensure that at least one person in each pair knows about football. If this is not possible, do as group or class discussion. • Remind students that they should explain/justify their views for each question. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the vocabulary exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Students research a famous sportsperson and write an article similar to the one in this lesson. Students do Exercise V1–5 on page 131 in the Language reference. VOCABULARY: idioms 7a Ask or tell students what an idiom is (a phrase that has a meaning not necessarily given by the individual words in the phrase). • Check that students understand goalposts (draw this on the board), field (a flat area of grass), level (flat) and score (get a point; in football = kick the ball through the goalposts). 44 Sport 0 0 3.2 MARTIAL ARTS IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging Students listen to a karate teacher talking about his experiences and then read a leaflet for a karate club. Next, students focus on vocabulary contained in the leaflet: combinations with self- and abstract nouns. Finally, students study the grammar focus (quantifiers) and practise using these to discuss true statements about exercise in their country. Objectives Students’ own answers. 2 Introduce the context. Ask if any students do karate or would like to. Check they understand belts (show the black belts in the photos). • Play the recording once, then check the answer. He is a karate teacher and fifth level black belt. Audio script 3.1 Interviewer, Mr Cole I: C: By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from a listening and a reading text • extended their range of word combinations beginning with self- and abstract nouns • revised/extended their knowledge and use of different quantifiers (none, almost none, etc.) Timings If short of time, set Exercise 13 or 14 as homework. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 8. WARM-UP This topic introduces different martial arts (along with other sports/exercises). • Write on the board: Group 1: t’ai chi, karate, kick boxing, cricket, boules, curling, bullfighting, lacrosse Group 2 : Japan, Thailand, China, Scotland, Spain, France, India, Canada/the USA. • Students work in pairs and match the sport/ exercise with the country it’s most strongly associated with. Each country can only be used once. They can use their dictionaries if necessary. • In feedback, use karate as a lead in to Exercise 1. t’ai chi: China; karate: Japan; kick boxing: 0 Thailand; cricket: India; boules: France; curling: 0 Scotland; bullfighting: Spain; lacrosse: Canada/ I: C: How long have you been doing karate? OK. My time in karate is just over 32 years now. I started back in 1981 in my final year at university down in Bath and I’ve been training ever since on the basis of something like between two and five times a week. So, 32 years in karate. Like, we say it takes about five to six years to get to black belt – that’s what we say is the beginning of karate. So I achieved my black belt in 1987 and since then I’ve been working my way as a black belt through the various levels and I’m now at the fifth level of black belt. What gives you the most satisfaction in teaching karate? Well, I think I’m going to sum it up with one word. Impact; having an impact on people – our students – students who now these days range from four to … I was going to say 64, but we’ve had someone of 73 in one of our clubs. We can measure progress through different belts – something which was introduced in the West. These days people need to measure their achievement and that’s good. It’s a way to distinguish different levels. And when students achieve their new belt, I take tremendous joy in seeing their reaction – you get smiling faces, you get some children coming up and saying, ‘Wow, it’s the best day of my life!’ I mean, for the adults it may be simply an expression of relief – the fact that they’ve got through an exam 20 1 preliminary findings 2 carbon emissions 3 significant impact 4 distant future 5 traffic congestion 6 rush hour 7 technological advances 8 human error GRAMMAR: modal verbs: ability, possibility and obligation (future) 9 Elicit the meaning of ability, possibility and obligation. Then ask students to work with a partner and search both texts for examples. When they find them, they should underline them. • Go through the answers and notes below with the class and elicit the negative forms of each. • Students should refer to the Language reference on page 134 for more support. Ability: will be able to (A), won’t be able to (B) Possibility: could, might, may (A), could, may (B) Obligation: will need to, will have to (A), will have to (B) Be able to and have to are modal in meaning, but not in form, e.g. they have a past form (was able to) and are inflected in the third person (he has to), unlike pure modals, which do not (musted and he mights are wrong). Need can be used as a modal (e.g. he needn’t go) or as a main verb (e.g. he needs to go). 10 Before students do this activity, ask them to read the Language reference on page 134 for information on form. • Give pairs five to ten minutes to find and correct the grammar errors in six of the sentences. • Monitor to point out mistakes, but encourage students to refer to the Language reference and self-correct if necessary. • Check answers with the class. • Put students in pairs to discuss their sentences and ask each other follow-up questions (e.g. Why do you think that might happen?). • Monitor to note mistakes when using the different form of modals. • In feedback, ask students the most interesting/ surprising thing they heard. • Finally, correct some of the more common or important mistakes you noted earlier. • For further practice, ask students to do Exercise G1–1 on page 135 in the Language reference. SPEAKING 12 Put students in pairs and give them five minutes to discuss the statements and agree on how to complete them. • Put students in groups of four (i.e. two pairs in each group) and ask them to compare. • Tell students to give reasons for the modal they have used and to disagree with each other if necessary. • Finally, elicit one idea for each statement from the class and ask other students if they agree and why/why not. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the listening, reading, grammar and vocabulary exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Students write a letter to a local newspaper complaining about transport in their city and making suggestions/recommendations for improvements. They can use their ideas from the Warm-up and elsewhere in this lesson. Students do Exercises G1–1 and V3–7 on page 135 in the Language reference. 1 Security will must improve 2 correct 3 We might have to/will have to work 4 we will all have to be able to travel 5 many of us can will be able to travel 6 I’ll be able to I’ll have to drive 7 We will need to find 8 correct 11 Tell students to complete the sentences so that they are true for themselves. • Monitor to help with vocabulary or ask students to use their dictionaries. 79 Transport 0 0 Tell students to look for words with capital letters to help them find the answers more quickly. 5.3 GREAT RAILWAY JOURNEYS the Orient Express, the Trans-Siberian Express, the Quinghai–Tibet line IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging Students read an article about three famous railway journeys and focus on vocabulary from the text. Next, students look at past modal verbs in the text and then study the form and meaning of these. Finally, students use this grammar to describe a journey they made to another student in the class. 2 Read through the list (1–8) and check that students understand ruler (e.g. a king or queen) and luxurious (very comfortable and expensive). • Give students three minutes to find the items in the list and underline them in the text. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. Go through the notes in brackets in the answer key below. Meet the expert video 1 China, Russia, Japan, Mongolia, Italy, Austria, Switzerland, France 2 Agatha Christie (a British crime/thriller writer), Graham Greene (a British writer of fiction) 3 Tsar Alexander the Third (he ruled 1881–1909) 4 Lake Baikal 5 the Orient Express 6 the Trans-Siberian Express (9,198 km) 7 the Quinghai–Tibet line (5,072 m above sea level) 8 the Fenghuosha Tunnel (4,905 m above sea level) Watch a video about a travel writer talking about an Indian train journey. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from a reading text • revised/learnt about how modal verbs of ability, possibility and obligation are used in the past and practised using these • talked to another student about a journey they made in the past Timings If short of time, omit Exercise 6. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 6. 3 Give students five to eight minutes to read the text again and note their answers. • Tell students to use their dictionaries to help them answer question 4 if necessary. • Students compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. WARM-UP 1 to prevent it freezing 2 the views of the Himalaya mountains, the scenic Lake Baikal 3 only the wealthiest, rich and famous, writers, royalty 4 unmatched comfort, extravagantly elegant, opulence, restaurant and saloon cars with ladies’ drawing rooms, we didn’t need to lift a finger, food was out of this world This activity focuses on the advantages and disadvantages of travelling by train on holiday. • Focus students on the photos on pages 50–51. Ask if anyone has travelled by train to go on holiday. • Students work in pairs and list the advantages/ disadvantages of travelling by train rather than by plane. • Finally, elicit ideas from the class and ask students to vote on whether they prefer trains or planes when they travel on holiday. READING AND VOCABULARY: words from the text 1a Encourage students to use visual clues in the photos to make their predictions. Discuss in class. 1b Give students one minute to read the article and find the journeys mentioned. 4 Give students one minute to scan the text to find and underline the words in the box. • Give them three minutes to complete the gaps. • Encourage them to use the context of the article to help with meaning, and then use their dictionaries if necessary. Students compare answers in pairs. • In feedback, check students’ pronunciation of any difficult words (e.g. gruelling). • For further practice, ask students to do Exercise V4–8 on page 135 in the Language reference. 80 Transport 0 0 1 gruelling 2 impeccable 3 era 4 opulence 5 altitude 6 nomads 7 icon 8 nostalgia 5 Critical thinking: Identifying attitude. Ask students to read the first paragraph and identify any words/phrases which show the writer’s attitude. Go through a few examples with them and explain why they are positive. • Give students three minutes to look through the rest of the text and find more examples. • Get 5–10 examples in feedback. When students read academic texts, understanding the tone and attitude as well as the content is important. How people write is often as important as what they write, because of the importance of subtext. The writer loved all the journeys as indicated by: golden era, nostalgia, romance, beautiful views, absolutely breathtaking, live long in my memory, stylish and luxurious sleeping carriages, impeccable service and cuisine, scenic, my memories will always stay with me, unmatched comfort, railway heaven, stylish, finest window seats, icon of passenger rail, extravagantly elegant, opulence, food was out of this world Ability: wanted to go, as we did, we couldn’t get, we succeeded in, they didn’t speak, we managed to communicate Possibility: were able to eat, could afford Obligation: we had to get, had to be heated 7b Check that students understand the language used in the instructions. • Students individually check their answers from Exercise 7a and then compare with a partner. • Take class feedback. couldn’t, could Was able to and had to are modal in meaning, but not in form (i.e. they have a past form). Can is a pure modal, but is the only one which has its own past form (could). 7c Give students a few minutes to decide their answers and then ask them to compare with a partner, discussing reasons for each. • Refer students to Exercises 7a, 7b and the Language reference on page 134 if they need help. • Go through answers and the notes. Ensure that students clearly understand each of the points. Refer to the information in brackets in the answer key below. • Read through the Grammar tip with the class. 6 Put students in small groups. They discuss the question and give reasons for their answers. • Take feedback from three or four students, then ask the class to vote on the most popular choice. 1 was able to/could (note the form: could/ couldn’t + infinitive without to) 2 had to (note the form: had to + infinitive without to; had to be heated in the text is a passive structure, i.e. have to + infinitive be + past participle) 3 managed to 4 succeed in 5 succeed in (note the form: manage to + infinitive without to) GRAMMAR: ability, possibility and obligation (past) 7a Tell students to find all the ways of talking about ability, possibility and obligation in the past, not just the modal verbs. • Give students three minutes to find and underline the examples. • Ask students to compare with a partner and say if each one expresses ability, possibility or obligation. • Go through the answers and write each example on the board for analysis in Exercises 7b and 7c. Check that students understand managed to (it was difficult, but we succeeded). If possible, reproduce the article so that all students can see it (perhaps on an interactive whiteboard or an overhead projector). When you check answers, underline the examples in the text. 8 • • • Grammar tip: we can use couldn’t to talk about a single action that we did in the past (e.g. We couldn’t get tickets at first.). To orient students to the text, ask them to read it quickly and list the problems the author had in organising the journey. Ask students to compare with a partner and then elicit answers from the class (i.e. didn’t organise the train journey before they left London; didn’t get much access to the internet in China, so didn’t get much information). Students work individually to choose the most appropriate alternative forms in the text. Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. Refer to the notes in brackets in the answer key below. 81 Transport 0 0 • For further practice, ask students to do Exercises G2–2 and G2–3 on page 135 in the Language reference. 1 had to (This is a personally felt obligation.) 2 manage to 3 weren’t able to 4 managed to 5 managed to/were able to 6 were able to 7 didn’t need to 8 succeeded in 9 could/ were able to 10 couldn’t 11 had to (because there was no alternative) SPEAKING 9a Re-elicit the problems students found in the text in Exercise 8 as a lead-in to this activity. • Read through the instructions with the class and tell them to imagine a memorable journey if they have never experienced one themselves. • Give students a maximum of ten minutes to make notes. Monitor to help as necessary. 9bPut students in pairs to describe their journeys and ask each other questions to get as much information as possible. • Monitor to note mistakes with verbs to express possibility, ability and obligation. • Ask each pair who had the more memorable journey and why. • Finally, correct some of the more common or important mistakes you noted earlier. MEET THE EXPERT 1 Students discuss the questions in pairs. Take brief class feedback. 2a Introduce the video by showing the image at 0:29. Without looking in the coursebook, get them to predict what they think it will be about. • Students read the instructions and then tick the four things they think she will talk about. They should then compare in pairs and justify their decision in each case. 2bPlay the video. Students check their answers. • Check answers with the class. Elicit a few points about each of the four topics mentioned. a, c, d, f Meet the expert video Monisha Rajesh, travel writer My name is Monisha Rajesh and I’m a Londonbased journalist. I’m also a travel writer for newspapers in the UK and abroad and I’ve just written my first travel book, Around India in 80 trains. I decided to go around India by train because I was reading an article at work one day about how India’s domestic airlines could reach 80 different cities. And I was quite curious about this because I had lived in India very briefly, when I was nine, and I had really not seen any of the country as a tourist. I looked at the map and I could see that this network rippled out across the country into all the nooks and crannies into places that the airlines couldn’t reach. And so I decided that travelling by train would be much nicer because I could reach much further and I could also talk to people in a way that you can’t on planes. I decided to travel by 80 trains because I took inspiration from Jules Verne’s book Around the world in 80 days and decided to recreate the adventure for myself. I did some basic planning for this trip. Um, I met a friend of a friend, who’s a photographer, who was also planning to travel in Asia at the same time. So we decided to combine our trips. And we spent five weeks with a map of India spread out on a table and a handful of pins that we put into different spots in the country, depending on certain events rather than places. I think travelling by train in India is a very special experience because the Indian railways are like no other in the rest of the world. Uh, people will talk to you all the time, they always want to ask questions, they want to know where you live, what you do, how much you earn, what your parents do, why you’re aren’t married and you’re never alone, um, in a way that I think when you travel in England, uh, you always are. And the Indian railways are a microcosm of society because they really teach you how Indian so- society is structured. You can go from one end of the train, in first class, and see ambassadors and politicians and businessmen. And then you can walk 37 carriages down to the other end and be sitting on wooden slats with farmers and a class of 30 children all sharing fruit and chattering in the doorways. It’s very easy to travel by train in India because almost everybody speaks English; uh, in the south most people will talk to you in English straight away. The further north you go, the fewer people will speak in English, but everybody always 82 Transport 0 0 wants to practise with you. I made sure that I included a good variety of trains when I travelled around the country to make sure that people could see both extremes. So I travelled on luxury trains, including the Indian Maharaja – Deccan Odyssey and the Golden Chariot, which is a lesser known train in the south. And I also travelled on Mumbai commuter trains and travelled at rush hour, just to see what it was like. And I also found, um, a hospital train called the Lifeline Express, which has been running for just over 20 years and invites poor people on board to do surgery for afflictions from polio or for cataract surgery, ear surgery, and they’ve now started counselling people for epilepsy as well. And I think that was the most eye-opening train for me because it made me see that the Indian railways really is the lifeline of a nation, which is its nickname. And it also travels across one of the highest bridges in the world and it’s, ur, quite a stunning route. There are a lot of different routes and itineraries that you can choose in India, depending on how much time you have or who you’re travelling with. One particular route that I would recommend is along the Konkan railway, which is on the western coast of India, and it starts up in Mumbai and goes down to Goa. And it’s a particularly lovely route because it has the Arabian Sea on one side and the Western Ghat hillsides on the other. And you can also travel with the doors open and you can squeeze past coconut grooves and mango grooves, and sometimes you can actually reach out and grab leaves through the windows. I met an incredible variety of people during my four months; for example, I met three members of parliament, who were travelling in my compartment once from Delhi to Chennai, which was a 31-hour journey. So you do end up chatting a lot about everything that you’re doing. And they were very curious about my journey and wanted to know which bits of the country I had travelled to. And I said I wanted to go to Assam, uh, in the north east of the country, and it turned out that one of them was from Assam, and he promised to arrange a journey for me and to organise tours around the tea estates. And after they’d gone, a woman in the compartment next to me was laughing at me and said, ‘Oh, you will never hear from them again. And you’re foolish to think that they will help you.’ And I was quite disappointed by this. It turned out that they did help me and when I arrived in Assam, there was an armoured jeep waiting for me with police guards. And I was taken to a beautiful tea estate and given a tour around Assam for four days. 3 Students answer as many of the questions as they can based on their first viewing. • Play the video again. Students check their answers and then compare with a partner. • Take class feedback, referring to the specific part of the video script as necessary. 1b 2c 3a 4a 5c 6b 7c Show students some or all of the following images from the video. In pairs, they should discuss what aspect of her presentation they represent: • 1:19 (She travelled on trains by herself.) • 2:02 (Railways are a microcosm of society.) • 2:12 (how the rich travel by train) • 2:19 (how the poor travel by train) • 3:03 (Mumbai rush hour train) • 3:13 (hospital train) 4a Put students in pairs from the same country (where possible). Give them five minutes to create a tour, using the three prompts given. Wherever possible, it should be based on fact. 4bEnsure that when pairs make their presentations, they both have equal time speaking. Get students to mark each presentation out of ten. The pair with the highest mark ‘wins’. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the vocabulary, listening, grammar and pronunciation exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. They can also do the MyEnglishLab video activities after this point. Students use the journey they discussed in Exercise 9 to write an email to a friend describing the problems they had and what was good about the journey. They can use the text in Exercise 8 as a model. Students do Exercises G2–2, G2–3 and V4 – 8 on page 135 in the Language reference. 83 Transport 0 0 5.4 SCENARIO: BEAUCIEL IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging This lesson focuses on transport problems in urban areas. Students read and listen to the scenario about transport problems in the city of Beauciel. They listen to three consultants discussing the problems and then focus on the Key language. Finally, in the Task, they discuss ideas for solving the traffic problems. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information from reading and listening texts • learnt useful phrases for summarising in meetings • used this language in a ‘real-life’ situation to discuss solutions for a city’s transport problems • Students think about the problems there might be in this city. They compare ideas with a partner. • Do not give any specific feedback at this stage as this city is the focus of Exercise 3. 3 Set the context and tell students that the city in the listening is the one they read about in Exercise 2. • Students read the list of problems. Check understanding of traffic jams (main photo) and peak times (rush hour, the busiest times of the day). • Play the recording without pausing and get students to tick the problems mentioned. • Now ask students to write down as many of the percentages as they can remember. • Play the recording again so students can check/ complete their answers. They then compare answers with a partner. • Take feedback. Finally, ask students if the city’s problems are similar to the ones they discussed in Exercise 2 earlier. traffic jams: 80% open-air markets air pollution on-street parking: 45% too many cars: 75% not enough car parks: 70% too much noise: 60% unreliable bus services: 40% Timings If short of time, omit Exercise 4. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 6b. Quickly discuss with students different ways in which the statistics could be expressed (e.g. 45% = just less than half; 75% = three-quarters). WARM-UP This activity revises vocabulary for describing transport problems. Audio script 5.3 • Focus students on the photos on pages 52–53. In pairs, they identify as many problems as possible in one minute. (Note: Some problems cannot be physically seen, but can be guessed from the situation in the photos.) • Elicit ideas and write them on the board. And now some news for all you tourists who are planning to go to the beautiful city of Beauciel for a vacation. The results of a survey about the transport system in the city have just been published. They make interesting reading. Possible answers: traffic congestion, nowhere to park, exhaust fumes/pollution, noise pollution, dangerous: too many vehicles on the road, journey times for commuters increasing SITUATION 1 If you used the Warm-up activity, students can use some of the vocabulary in this discussion. If not, focus students on the photos and ask them to discuss the questions in Exercise 1 in pairs. • Elicit a few ideas from two or three pairs and check that students understand the vocabulary used. 2 Introduce the text. Tell students to read it quickly and look at the map on page 52. As many people know, Beauciel has serious transport problems. According to the survey, there are too many cars in the city, traffic jams at peak times, insufficient car parks, too much noise, especially from motorbikes, and slow, unreliable buses. Residents also mentioned on-street parking, which slows down traffic, especially the buses. For most people in the survey – that’s over 80 percent – traffic jams are the biggest problem. At peak times in the morning and evening, there are often serious traffic jams when people enter and leave the city. Over 75 percent of the residents consider there are too many cars in the city. Many residents – about 70 percent of those surveyed – feel the city needs more car parks. 84 Transport 0 0 There is only one car park near the city centre, and that is always full early in the morning. The other car parks, dotted around the city, are generally small and insufficient for the number of cars. Many residents – roughly 60 percent in the survey –, mentioned the unacceptable noise levels, not just from cars, but also from motorcycles. This is having a bad effect on people’s quality of life. Audio script 5.4 Florence, Daniel, Kirsten F: K: Just over 45 percent drew attention to the problem of on-street parking. There are too many private cars parked on the streets. This causes problems for people who have to park on the roads, such as ambulance drivers, taxis, school buses, road maintenance vehicles and so on. The unreliable bus services were criticised by 40 percent of the residents. Many complained also about the time it takes by bus to travel across the city from east to west. The journey, a distance of about five kilometres, usually takes more than an hour. The survey results have come at the right time. The city planners are now considering how to solve the problems and have set up a website where people can give their opinions and voice their complaints. That’s all from me. I’ll be back again tomorrow morning at 11 o’clock. F: K: F: D: K: 4 Students discuss the questions in small groups. Ensure that they write down some ideas for question 2 so they can use them in Exercise 7a. KEY LANGUAGE: the language of meetings – summarising 5 Check that students understand international consultants. Students read the questions. • Play the recording. Students answer individually and then check in pairs. • Play the recording again if necessary. 1 how to get from east to west in the city 2 new tram system, buses/more bus routes, no on-street parking, a ring road 3 improve the bus system, stop on-street parking, further discussion of the ring road D: F: D: F: K: F: OK, I’d like to move on. But first, let me recap, please. We’ve talked about having bicycle lanes. We think it’s a good idea and we’d like to discuss it at the next planning meeting. But Kirsten, you’re not convinced it’s worth doing, right? Well, I know it’s been tried in other cities and hasn’t really worked. So, just to confirm, you won’t support the proposal if it goes to a vote. Exactly. Right. Now what about our biggest problem? How to get from the harbour to the city centre. It took me almost an hour yesterday to get there. It’s not good enough – the journey’s only three kilometres and the bus was stopping every five metres. It’s so frustrating, especially when the weather’s hot. What do you think, Daniel? What’s the answer? Mmm, it’s a big problem getting from east to west, no doubt about that. In the long term, we’ll need to have a tram system or build a ring road. But either solution will cost a lot of money and there’ll be environmental problems. What do you think, Kirsten? You’re right, a ring road or tram system, they’re long-term solutions. Do we need to spend time discussing them? I think we should focus on a short-term solution. I’d like to have more exclusive bus routes and more buses, for that matter. And let’s get rid of on-street parking on the busy routes. Well, they’re interesting ideas. Right, Francoise? Yes, very interesting. A better bus system is definitely worth considering. But still, I’d like to discuss the ring road proposal at the next meeting. If we could build that ring road, a lot of cars would go round the city instead of through it. And that’d greatly reduce traffic congestion. OK? Well, OK. I suppose you’re right. OK, do we essentially have agreement, then? OK. Right, I’ll now sum up. We talked about bicycle lanes and agreed to discuss this proposal at our next meeting. But Kirsten is not in favour of them. We think a short-term solution could be to improve the bus system, 85 Transport 0 0 have more buses and stop on-street parking on some routes. And we’d also like to discuss a long term solution at the meeting: building a ring road which will take cars round the southern part of the city. Everyone happy with my summary? K: Yeah, fine. 6a Emphasise that students should be listening specifically to Francoise in this exercise. • Play the recording again and ask students to tick the phrases they hear. 6bGive students a maximum of two minutes to check their answers against the audio script. • In feedback, elicit from students the meaning/ usage/pronunciation of these phrases. all the expressions except 1 and 4 5.5 STUDY AND WRITING SKILLS IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging This lesson focuses on the skills of describing graphs, charts and information in a table. Students match charts, a graph and a table with their descriptions and discuss which is best for different information. They draw a table and a pie chart to describe information and statistics from a holiday brochure, before focusing on phrases for comparing figures. Next, students read a chart comparing statistics for passenger traffic at international airports. Finally, students summarise statistics contained in a table. Objectives TASK: evaluating proposals 7a Elicit the function of the planning department of a city council (an organisation which decides on what should be built in the urban area). • Keep pairs together from Exercise 4 and join with another pair. Give students two minutes to read the proposals and discuss ideas. Take class feedback about any additional points to include. 7bStudents discuss each proposal. Ensure that they are clear about the meaning of short, medium and long term. Tell them that the best choices may not necessarily be the ones that work now, but the ones that might work in the future. 7c It may be helpful to do to this as a class discussion. Whilst the text contains a number of suggestions for increasing funding for these proposals, you could also prompt students with some of your own. 7dPut two groups together for this exercise. Appoint a chairperson to ensure everybody participates and all points are covered. • Finally, identify which proposals are most popular in the whole class and why. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the Key language, vocabulary and listening exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Students do exercise KL–4 on page 135 in the Language reference. By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from reading texts and different graphs and charts • practised interpreting and representing information and statistics in graphs and charts • revised/extended phrases for comparing and contrasting information and statistics • written a summary of statistics found in a table Timings If short of time, set Exercise 7 as homework. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 3c. WARM-UP This activity introduces students to statistics for holiday destinations. • Tell students that they are going to find out about other students’ holiday destinations. • Elicit the following questions: Did you stay in your country for your holiday last year? Have you ever been abroad? • Divide the class in two: ask one half to ask the first question and the other half to ask the second. • Students move round the room asking their question to everyone in the class and noting the number of people who say yes. • Students compare their results with another student who asked the same question and decide how to report this to the class (e.g. a percentage, a fraction, using the words most, not many, nearly all). • Finally, elicit ‘reports’ from three or four students and ask others if their reports are the same. 86 Transport 0 0 STUDY SKILLS: using graphs, charts and tables • Students’ pie charts should look like the one below, but their tables may vary depending, for example, on whether or not they included the ranking. This section is useful for students preparing for the IELTS exam. In the first section of the writing task students may be asked to describe the key features of a graph. 1 Ask students which of the types of chart, graph and table they have used before. • Give them three minutes to read the descriptions and match them with the diagrams. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. 1 pie chart 2 bar chart 3 table 4 line graph 2 Give students two minutes to think about their choices. • Put students in pairs to explain their choices and disagree with each other if necessary. • Go through answers with the class. The answers below are ideal, but accept reasonable alternatives. Students should justify their answers. Destination Rank two years ago 1 bar chart 2 pie chart 3 line graph 4 table 3a If you have a strong class, students can design the table and fill in the statistics. • If your students need help, draw a table on the board with just the headings and ask students to fill in the destinations and statistics. • If you provide the table below 3c for students to use, tell them that n/a means not applicable and that you can’t give a rank because these figures are not for one country, but a collection of countries. • Allow fifteen minutes for this activity and monitor to check students are filling in the table correctly. • Students can use their dictionaries to check vocabulary if necessary. • Answers are checked after Exercise 3c. 3bRemind students of the pie chart in Exercise 1 and give them a maximum of five minutes to draw their own. • Monitor to check students are drawing a reasonably clear chart. • Answers are checked after Exercise 3c. 3c Give students five minutes to compare the table (Exercise 3a) and the pie chart (Exercise 3b) and suggest improvements to each other if necessary. • Draw the table and pie chart below on the board and ask students to compare them with their own. % two years ago Rank last year % last year Italy 1 18% 1 24% North America 4 11% 2 22% Spain 2 17% 3 20% North Africa 3 15% 4 12% France 6 5% 5 7% Denmark 8 and Sweden 2% 6 6% Germany 7 5% 7 4% The 5 Netherlands 9% 8 2% Other destinations 16% n/a 5% n/a One of the questions in the PTE-A speaking test is to describe an image (often a pie chart). If students are preparing for this test, you could give them one minute to study the chart and one minute to describe what it shows. Students should work in pairs and describe the changes in different language from the text (e.g. The proportion of people going to Italy has increased by six percent.) Students could even try and suggest (real or made-up) reasons for this. 87 Transport 0 0 WRITING SKILLS: describing information in a table 1 Hartsfield-Jackson Atlanta International airport is based in Atlanta, Georgia, not in Jackson. 2 Beijing Airport’s change in total passengers was slightly more, not less, than Hartsfield-Jackson Atlanta Airport. 3 Frankfurt Airport did not have a similar boost in passengers. Its increase was far less than Dubai Airport. 4 Atatürk Airport is in Istanbul, not Ismir. 5 Atatürk Airport handled slightly more, not slightly less, than 45 million passengers. 6 Shanghai Airport did not increase its ranking. 4a Give students two minutes to underline the phrases and then compare with a partner. • Check answers with the class. compares with, similarly, compared with, in comparison with, however, on the other hand, compared with, by contrast, whereas 4bComparison and contrast. Students do this activity individually, then compare with a partner. • Check answers with the class. Accept reasonable alternatives. 1 while/whereas 2 In comparison with/In contrast to 3 significantly more 4 Far more 5 However/By contrast/On the other hand 6 Far more/Significantly more 4c Encourage students to use words and phrases which they are not familiar with or did not use in the previous exercise. • Individually, students write the sentences. Ask them to show their sentences to a partner, who should check whether they have used the language correctly. • Monitor and act as referee if students are not sure whether the language is correct. • Take a few sample sentences in class feedback. 5 Students may be worried about reading tables and figures, so allow plenty of time for this activity and, if necessary, tell students to work in pairs. • Check answers with the class and elicit/show where in the table the information comes from. 1 Atatürk International 2 London Heathrow 3 London Heathrow 4 Frankfurt, Hong Kong International 5 London Heathrow 6 Dubai International Develop students’ critical thinking skills for the academic context by asking them to try and interpret some of the data. For example, ask: Why is Atlanta so popular? (It is a transport hub.) Why did Beijing increase so much? (Olympics in 2008). 6 Tell students to read the summary and stop after each sentence to check the table and compare information. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. 7 Give students five minutes to look at the table on page 166 and monitor to help clarify if necessary. • Give students 30–40 minutes to write their summaries. • Students use Exercises 3 and 6 as models for organisation, and some of the phrases in Exercise 4. • Monitor while students are writing to help with vocabulary and ideas if necessary. • When they have finished, ask them to compare summaries with another student and make suggestions for improvement. • Finally, take the summaries in for marking, paying particular attention to the organisation and the use of language for comparison and contrast from Exercise 4. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the writing skills and academic collocations exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. This is also a good time to do the MyEnglishLab video activities. Students conduct a survey on a topic of their choice, but it must have a contrast of time (two different years, days, months, etc.). They draw a table, pie chart or line graph to show the results and then write a summary of these. Alternatively, students give their table/pie chart/line graph to another student, who has to interpret it and write the summary. 88 Transport 0 0 6 Literature and Film Unit Objectives Grammar: Vocabulary: Scenario: Study skills: Writing skills: narrative tenses; used to, would, get used to genres; literature and film; adjectives; idiomatic expressions; collocations; words from the text persuading; making a persuasive presentation making an effective presentation an online review 6.1 READING OR WATCHING? VOCABULARY AND READING: genres IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging Students read an article about the relationship between literature and film and learn vocabulary connected with this topic. Next, students listen to a discussion about a well-known book (The Da Vinci Code) before participating in a speaking activity about books and films. Objectives 1 Check that students understand fiction (not real, about imaginary people/events) and non-fiction. • Set the activity. Students work individually, using their dictionaries if necessary. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. • Check students’ pronunciation of the stress on the following: novels, poetry, romcom, biography, autobiography, biopic. • For further practice, ask students to do Exercise V1–5 on page 137 in the Language reference. By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from a reading and listening text • expanded their range of vocabulary in the context of literature and film • discussed their opinions about books and films autobiography: books biography: books crime: books/films biopic: films costume drama: films romcom: films novel: books horror: books/films play: books science fiction (sci-fi): books/films psycho drama: films poetry: books short story: books thriller: books/films travel writing: books (film = road movie) Timings If short of time, omit Exercise 5. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 7. WARM-UP This activity introduces the topic of when and what people read. • Write on the board: a newspaper every day, a book on holiday, a book in the evening, an e-book. • Students move round the room asking questions. (Elicit: Do you read … ?). If someone answers ‘yes’, they should ask follow-up questions (e.g. Which paper do you prefer? What kind of book do you like?). • When most students have found someone who does the things on the board, stop the activity and conduct brief feedback. 2 Students discuss in pairs before sharing ideas with the class. 3 Give students five minutes to read the article. • Take brief feedback about some of the main points (e.g. Most film adaptations are considered worse than books. It is hard to turn some books into films.). • Students work with the same partner as Exercise 2 and discuss whether they made the same points. A useful exam strategy is to predict what an article is going to be about based on its title. Ask students to close their books and write from page to screen on the board. Students guess the content of the article. They then read and confirm. 4 Critical thinking: Inferring opinion. This task is good practice for students when reading academic texts. The ‘meaning’ of a text may not always be obvious and students will need to apply critical thinking skills to understand what point is being made. This skill is also required in the IELTS 89 New Language Leader Upper Intermediate Literature 0 0 • • • • Reading task with Yes/No/ Not given questions and for some of the multiple-choice questions in the PTE-A Reading section. Elicit the meaning of inferring opinion (making sensible predictions based on knowledge which you already have). Do question 1 as an example. Ask students to explain why the answer is yes. (e.g. The author says, ‘There are very many times I have been disappointed by a film of a book I love.’). Students work individually. They then compare with a partner and agree upon their answers. In feedback, ask students to provide evidence for their answers. 1 yes 2 no 3 no 8 no 9 yes 4 no 5 no 6 yes • Check answers, but do not focus on any difficult vocabulary because students will study this in Exercises 8b and 9. Michael liked it because it’s a page-turner, a good and fast moving story, easy to read. He also liked the film because of Tom Hanks. Jenny liked it because the plot was exciting, really riveting. Paul didn’t like it because he felt his intelligence was insulted, it was tedious, the ending was a real let-down. He also didn’t like the film because Tom Hanks did not look like the main character in the book. Erika didn’t like it because it was really dull and didn’t make her think, not a good story, hard-going at the beginning. She also found the film disappointing and worse than the book. 7 no 5 Put students in pairs to discuss. They should justify their answers in each case. • In feedback, choose five of the items and ask the class for their opinions and reasons. VOCABULARY: literature and film 6 Students work individually, using a dictionary if necessary. Ask them to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. • In feedback, check students’ pronunciation of any difficult words (e.g. biographer). • For further practice, ask students to do Exercise V2–6 on page 137 in the Language reference. 1 author 2 novelist 3 biography, autobiography 4 ghost writer 5 screenwriter 6 critic 7 plot 8 dialogue 9 remake 10 actors 7 Allow groups five minutes for this discussion. LISTENING AND SPEAKING 8a Write The Da Vinci Code on the board. Ask students if they have read the book or seen the film. (It is an international, best-selling thriller by Dan Brown.) • Set the activity. Check that students understand discussion group (people meet to discuss a book they have all read – a popular idea in the USA and Europe). • Warn students that they need to listen carefully to find out who is speaking. Sometimes the name is mentioned after a person has spoken. • Play the recording without pausing and then ask students to compare with a partner. Audio script 6.1 Jenny, Michael, Erika, Paul J: Now, if everyone’s got a coffee, I think we should begin. Has everyone read this month’s book and seen the film? E/P: Yes, sure. J: Well, Michael, I suppose as you chose this book for us to read, you should start us off. Why did you choose it? M: Yes, well … OK. I chose it because we have a book and a film which I think people will have strong opinions about. Also his latest book, Inferno, has just come out – again, seems to be dividing opinion. Critics are often not keen, but people buy his books. He is one of the world’s most read authors. I thought I would choose one of his earlier works and the one which perhaps made him so popular. Well, The Da Vinci Code, by Dan Brown. What can I say? I really thought it was brilliant! It’s a real page turner. I read the whole thing in a day. I thought the film was great too, but I suppose I just really like Tom Hanks. He’s a fantastic actor. P: Really? I thought it was dreadful! M: Oh come on, Paul! P: All that stuff about the Louvre being a museum, which is in Paris, which is in France. I felt insulted. And what was all that romantic stuff in the middle? No, I’m sorry, it’s not my kind of thing. And in the film Tom Hanks looks nothing like the main character 90 Literature 0 0 in the book, Robert Langdon, should. It’s ridiculous. Jenny, what did you think? J: OK, Paul, I agree that was a bit odd, but you must agree the plot was riveting – all those twists and turns? I couldn’t put it down. P: Really, Jenny, I’m surprised at you. It was really tedious. And the ending was a real letdown. After 500 pages nothing really happened. I found that Stephen King book we read last month much more tense and at least the characters were written with some imagination. E: I agree with you, Paul – I just couldn’t get into it. It was really dull and just not thoughtprovoking, which I was surprised about, considering the subject matter. And as for the film – oh dear, what a disappointment! It was just awful. In fact, I think the film is worse than the book, if that’s possible! M: Come on, Erika, it’s a thriller. It’s light and easy to read, just a good story. E: Well, not for me. It was very hard-going at the beginning and then I just gave up. There were just too many people in it for me. And all those really short chapters about the different people – I suppose that was to make it easier to follow, except that for me it didn’t work. I don’t know if it was the way it was written. J: Well, for me it certainly lived up to all the hype; I’d definitely read one of his others now. I agree with Michael. It was really gripping. I couldn’t wait to see what would happen next. P: Not me. I mean, I like a good mystery, but this was definitely overrated. E: Yes, just awful. Anyway, let’s agree to differ on this one, but it’s my turn to choose for next month and it’s going to be something a bit less lightweight. How about a classic, perhaps something by Charles Dickens – you know, with interesting characters? J: Great. A lot of his stories have been made into films as well. M: Yes, I’ve never read any of his, but I’m sure I seen some of the film versions. J: Sounds good. • Play the recording without pausing. Students compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. Replay the recording if necessary. awful, brilliant, dreadful, dull, riveting, tense, gripping, lightweight, overrated, tedious, thought-provoking 9 Give students a few minutes to complete the sentences before they check the audio script on page 174. • Check answers with the class. Ask if each one is positive or negative and elicit/read out the notes in brackets in the answer key below. 1 page-turner (positive – very exciting) 2 kind (negative – not what I normally like) 3 put (positive – very exciting, interesting) 4 letdown (negative – really disappointing) 5 into (negative – from the start I didn’t find the story interesting) 6 light, easy (positive in the context of this track, but light can be a negative comment, i.e. not serious) 7 hard going (negative – difficult to read because of the story or writing style) 8 lived, hype (positive – the advertising said it was good, and it was) 10 Put students in groups of three. They identify at least one book/film they liked and one they did not like. Give them fifteen minutes for the activity. • Encourage students to ask questions for further information. • Monitor to note mistakes with the vocabulary and phrases from this lesson. • In feedback, ask if students heard about any books/ films that they would like to read/see from other students. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the vocabulary exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Students do Exercises V1–5 and V2–6 on page 137 in the Language reference. 8b Ask students to check any unknown vocabulary from the box in their dictionaries. You may also need to clarify the meaning of some of the harder words. • Set the activity and warn students that the words in the text are not in the same order as the list. 91 Literature 0 0 6.2 IMPACT • Go through the questions with the class, by book/ film, rather than question. Some groups may find it easier to take notes by making a table with four columns (for the four questions) and four rows (for the four speakers). IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging Students listen to people talking about their favourite books, films or characters, including The Great Gatsby by F. Scott Fitzgerald. Students read an extract of the book and study referencing words. Next, they focus on narrative tenses and the form and meaning of the past perfect continuous. Finally, they discuss books and films they feel have had a significant impact. 1 1 One Flew over the Cuckoo’ s Nest 2 Jack Nicholson as McMurphy, Nurse Ratchet 3 yes, based on a book 4 prefers the film 2 1 Zatoichi 2 Takeshi Kitano as Zatoichi 3 doesn’t say 4 doesn’t say 3 1 Crouching Tiger Hidden Dragon 2 Michelle Yeoh and Zhang Ziyi 3 yes, based on a book 4 hasn’t read book, so can’t say 4 1 Sherlock Holmes 2 Holmes, played by Peter Cushing, Christopher Lee, Robert Downey; Dr Watson recently played by Lucy Liu 3 yes, based on books 4 prefers the books Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from listening and reading texts • extended their understanding of the use of narrative tenses and the past perfect continuous • discussed the impact of important books and films Timings If short of time, omit Exercise 8. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 8. Audio script 6.2 and answer key to Exercise 3 1 WARM-UP This activity introduces the topic of characters in books. • Write on the board: Sherlock Holmes, Harry Potter, James Bond (007). • Ask students to discuss in pairs what they know about each character. Elicit answers from the class. Example answers: Sherlock Holmes: a detective; his friend is Dr Watson; lives at 221B Baker Street, London Harry Potter: a boy wizard; goes to Hogwarts School James Bond: a British spy SPEAKING AND LISTENING 1 Elicit the meaning of impact in this context (a deep, long-lasting impression). Students explain why these films/books/characters have had an impact. 2 Emphasise that for this listening, students should focus on the who and the what (i.e. the facts). They will shortly listen again to focus on the why. • Play the recording and get students to take notes. • Students compare their answers and add information to their own notes as necessary. 2 Which film has had the biggest impact on me … Mm … I’d have to say Jack Nicholson’s performance in One Flew Over the Cuckoo’s Nest. Trying to choose just one of Nicholson’s great performances is difficult and he was amazing in The Shining. But he is heroic, funny and menacing as McMurphy, who ends up in a prison ward for the mentally ill and leads a fight against Nurse Ratchet. This film isn’t only great entertainment. It goes much deeper than this and gives us a wonderful insight into society. Everything about the film is brilliant: the plot, direction, filming, casting and, of course, the acting. Rarely can a film make you laugh and gasp with horror and shock at the same time. Rarely can a film leave you so entertained yet thinking about its disturbing scenes. The book by Ken Kesey is brilliant, but I believe the film is better than the book. I really enjoyed the Japanese film Zatoichi, which starts as a straightforward samurai movie, turns into a comedy and ends as a dance scene. I love it mainly because the lead actor and director is Takeshi Kitano, who some may know as Beat Takeshi. Kitano is famous as an actor, director, comedian, kid’s 92 Literature 0 0 3 4 TV favourite, novelist, poet, cartoonist and painter, and he seems to have made a film that combines a number of his talents. Kitano plays the blind masseur Zatoichi, who turns out to be incredibly skilled with a sword. He wanders into a town harassed by a criminal gang and helps two geishas take revenge on the men who murdered their parents. I loved Kitano’s performance as the chuckling, shuffling, friendly masseur who turns into a revenging warrior when required. He makes an intensely likeable main character while speaking very few words throughout the film. In terms of visual impact, I think I’d have to say Crouching Tiger Hidden Dragon with excellent performances from Michelle Yeoh and Zhang Ziyi, two of Asia’s greatest actresses. This movie has breathtaking fight scenes and contains beautiful landscapes. The cinematography is outstanding and I think it won an Oscar for art direction. I also loved the beautiful musical score and especially the use of the cello. The film was based on a novel by novelist Wang Dulu, but I can’t say which I preferred as I haven’t read the book. The film was a Chinese, Hong Kong, Taiwanese, American co-production directed by Ang Lee. The dialogue is in Mandarin, with subtitles, and in my opinion, that version is much better than the version with English voiceovers. I’ve enjoyed many of the Sherlock Holmes films and Holmes is the most portrayed movie character, with more than 70 actors playing the part in over 200 films. I enjoyed watching Peter Cushing and Christopher Lee portraying Holmes and also recent versions with the brilliant Robert Downey Jr. I also like the modern series set in New York, which stars Lucy Liu as Dr Watson. But to be honest, I prefer the books, which made a huge impression on me when I first read them, and the reason’s simple. Sherlock Holmes himself is a fascinating person – someone we can all admire. He’s got a brilliant intellect and incredible analytical powers. He’s also got amazing powers of observation – just by looking at people, he can deduce all kinds of things about them and their lives. He’s supremely talented as a detective and can solve the most difficult cases. But he has human failings as well. He has character flaws – like, he can be very arrogant, especially in his relations with his sidekick, Dr Watson. Watson accompanies him on most cases and he isn’t stupid, but Holmes is so brilliant! And he’s a very courageous person, especially when dealing with some very dangerous men. He’s knowledgeable and he’s talented musically. He often plays the violin when he’s in an unhappy mood. He’s very believable as the main character in the stories. When I was young, my uncle used to read extracts from the stories to me and he could quote pages of the stories by heart. I love Sherlock Holmes and I’ve re-read the stories many times. 3 Play the recording again. Students compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. 4 Ask if anyone has read or seen The Great Gatsby or what they know about it. • Ask students to read the questions, then play the recording. • Students check with a partner before you check answers with the class. 1 The book is extremely well written. The language is evocative. The main characters, especially Jay Gatsby, are fascinating. 2 Possibly he realises that Nick may be able to help him meet Daisy again. 3 the reasons for its great impact: fascinating plot and characters; asks interesting questions; portrays brilliantly and accurately the lives of wealthy people in the 1920s Audio script 6.3 One book that has made a huge impression on me is The Great Gatsby, by the American writer F. Scott Fitzgerald. It’s always been my favourite novel. I’ve re-read it many times and each time I find new meaning in it. There have been two impressive films based on the novel: one with Robert Redford and Mia Farrow, and a more recent one with Leonardo di Caprio and Carey Mulligan. The book is about a wealthy man, Jay Gatsby, who tries to win back the love of Daisy, a beautiful woman he first met when he was young and penniless. Instead of marrying Gatsby, Daisy marries a rich man, Tom Buchanan, from her own social class and years later, Gatsby, who’s now 93 Literature 0 0 very wealthy, wants to revive their romance. The narrator of the story, Nick Carraway moves to Long Island where his cousin Daisy lives. He rents a small house close to the magnificent mansion of Jay Gatsby. Gatsby holds lavish parties every Saturday. Hundreds of people come to them and most of them are not invited and have never met their host. Nick is surprised to receive a written invitation to one of the parties, even though he’s never met Gatsby. In a key scene, Nick wanders around the party and meets a man who turns out to be Gatsby. Later on, Gatsby uses his friendship with Nick to meet Daisy again, the woman he loved and lost. The story doesn’t have a happy ending for Gatsby. He manages to have a romantic relationship with Daisy. However, she chooses to remain with her husband rather than start a new life with Gatsby. I like this book for several reasons. First, it’s extremely well-written. Fitzgerald is so skilful at describing the characters and their emotions. And his language is very evocative. You really get the feel of how upper class people lived in the 1920s in America. He sees this as a period of declining social and moral values. People are greedy and pursue pleasure and money at all costs. The novel holds a mirror up to this corrupt society. I find the main characters, especially Jay Gatsby, absolutely fascinating. Gatsby has a romantic view of life. He believes that you can repeat the past and achieve happiness. He is a mysterious person. There are all kinds of rumours about his past. As the story unfolds, you are not sure about his character. He is undoubtedly charismatic with a charming smile, but you wonder if he is not what he seems. For example, he did not inherit his fortune, as he says, but made money from selling alcohol, which was illegal at the time. Your feelings about him change as you learn more about his past. The characters in the book are all richly drawn and that is one of the book’s greatest strengths. I have a favourite bit of dialogue about Gatsby, which reveals his character. Nick says to him, ‘You can’t repeat the past.’ Gatsby replies, ‘Of course you can. Of course you can.’ The Great Gatsby was published in 1926, just a few years after the Great War. The novel had a great impact. This was not just because of the novel’s fascinating plot, but because it poses interesting questions like, ‘Can you get back the past? Is there such a thing as true love?’ It was also, I think, because in the novel, Fitzgerald depicted brilliantly and accurately the lives and behaviour of wealthy people in America. 5 Students should try and match the words based on their first listening and their own knowledge. • Play the recording again. Students check existing answers and look for ones they do not know. • In feedback, ask students to explain the meaning / usage of each phrase. 1h 2b 3e 4f 5c 6a 7d 8g READING 6 Remind students that this is an example of fiction, so the way the text is written is different to most of the other texts they have read so far on this course. • Students read the questions and then the text. • Tell students to be concise in their answers. • Take feedback. 1 the narrator (Nick Carraway) 2 Jordan Baker (the narrator’s friend), Jay Gatsby (the host) 3 at a party (at Gatsby’s house) 4 elegant, young (30–32 year-old) man with a charming smile 5 Gatsby leaves to take a call. 7 Critical thinking: Referencing. Ask what kind of words are highlighted (pronouns). • Ask students to make predictions about pronouns without looking at the extract (e.g. ‘She’ must refer to a female. ‘We’ to the narrator plus another/others.). • Students answer the questions individually and then check in pairs. Take class feedback. 1 Jordan Baker and the narrator 2 the hydroplane 3 Jordan Baker 4 Gatsby’s 5 his smile 6 Gatsby 7 Gatsby 8 Jordan Baker and the narrator (Nick Carraway) 8 Due to the complexity of this question, it would probably be best to discuss in a class situation. GRAMMAR: narrative tenses 9a Ask students if they know the meaning of narrative and/or can name any narrative tenses. • Students work in pairs before you check answers with the class. You may need to revise the form/ function of some of these tenses, depending on your class. 94 Literature 0 0 11c Students should work in pairs to answer these questions. Ensure that you give clear feedback when going through the answers. Get students to explain why the false answers are incorrect. 1 were sitting = past continuous 2 looked, smiled = past simple 3 introduced = past simple; had got = past perfect; was picking = past continuous 4 hurried = past simple; was calling = past continuous 9b Students work with the same partner as in Exercise 9a. They should match these descriptions with both the tense and the examples in 9a. • Tell students that it may help them to draw timelines to work out the answers here. • Go through the answers. Elicit/Teach all the information in brackets in the answer key below. a past simple; sentence 2 b past continuous; sentence 1 c past continuous (first action), past simple (action interrupting the first action); sentence 4 (Note: In some sentences, the first action can continue simultaneously with the second, e.g. We were sitting in the park when we saw the boy.) d past perfect; sentence 3 (The impression came before the introduction). 10 Give students five minutes to do this activity individually and then compare with a partner. • Tell students to look at Exercise 9 and the Language reference on page 136 if they need help. • Check answers with the class and if there is disagreement, ask why students chose a form. 1 was playing, ran 2 was trying, had seen 3 were ticking, could not Ask students if they have read any of the novels quoted in this exercise or another novel by this writer. If not, would they like to, based on the extract given here? 11a Direct students to the example in the text (had been hovering). Students work individually and then compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. 1 F (past simple/continuous used more often) 2 T 3 T 4 F (past perfect) 12 Give students five minutes to do this activity individually and then compare with a partner. • Tell students to look at Exercises 9 and 11 and the Language reference on page 136 if they need help. • Check answers with the class and if there is disagreement, ask why students chose a form. • For further practice, ask students to do Exercises G1–1 and G1–2 on page 137 in the Language reference. 1 was sitting 2 was shaking 3 had been waiting 4 heard 5 came 6 told 7 had happened 8 had borrowed 9 had crashed 10 had been driving 11 rang 12 was SPEAKING 13 Put students in groups of four or five for this activity. First, direct them towards the five adverbs listed in the coursebook and check that they understand what each means. • Then direct them towards the example and read it aloud. You may want to give another one or two examples if you think your class need them. • Students discuss the questions for between five and ten minutes. Monitor the discussions and prompt/direct students as necessary. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the vocabulary, reading and grammar exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Students do Exercises V3,4–7, G1–1 and G1–2 on page 137 in the Language reference. before 11b Students use the example in Exercise 11a to help them complete the gaps. • Elicit the form from the class, write it on the board and highlight the possible contractions of had (I’d, you’d, he’d/she’d, we’d, they’d). had + been + -ing form of the verb 95 Literature 0 0 6.3 READING HABITS IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging Students begin by reflecting on how and when they read, focusing on a questionnaire. Next, they read about reading habits around the world. After some vocabulary work, they listen to people talking about their reading habits. Students focus on the meaning and form of used to, would and get used to before discussing things they used to do as children. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from listening and reading texts • learnt more about used to, would and get used to • practised this language in a discussion READING 3 Allow students five minutes to read the text. Emphasise that they are reading for the main idea, and to answer the question. Students might find it useful to underline the most important information in each summary. • Students compare answers and identify the textual evidence supporting their view. summary 3 4 Elicit from the class the best way to approach this activity (i.e. to scan the text for the country names, underline them and work out the answer). • Students should complete activity individually, and then check in pairs. • Take class feedback. Ensure they identify specific evidence in the text to support their answers. 1 Japanese girls 2 Japanese boys 4 Indonesian girls Timings If short of time, omit Exercise 6. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 7b. WARM-UP This activity introduces the topic of the importance of reading in everyday life. • Give students one minute to think about everything they have read in the last 24 hours (e.g. instructions, recipes, timetables). Students share this information with a partner and compare notes. • Elicit answers from the class and write them on the board. Discuss with students why reading is important in all aspects of life. SPEAKING 1a Students rank the statements about reading. Emphasise that they should be honest rather than giving what they think is the right answer. • They can rank 1–9 or if there are some which are not appropriate, just rank as many as are relevant. 1bStudents compare their answers in pairs. In feedback, ask three or four pairs if their answers were similar or different to each other. 2 Students stay in the same pairs to ask the questions. Encourage questions like Is it the same for you? to avoid repetition. 3 Thai boys 5 Critical thinking: Identifying facts and opinions. The ability to distinguish fact (information which is unarguably true) and opinion (a viewpoint, which may or may not be true) is a key skill at higher levels. This is especially true in academic life, where making this distinction is critical, and in exams. You may want to point out that IELTS and the PTE-A Reading may ask about the purpose of a text and what the writer’s view is. • Give students one minute to find one opinion and one fact. Ask one student for feedback and get the others to confirm whether they are correct. When you are certain students can identify the difference, give them three minutes to find three more facts and three more opinions. • Students check in pairs. Partners should check each other’s ‘facts’ and ‘opinions’ and discuss whether they agree or disagree with them. You should monitor and be referee. • Take three further examples of each in feedback from the class. Example opinions: 1 Policy makers in countries where there this gap is particularly pronounced should … reading proficiency levels. 2 Policy makers should take into account boys’ preference for reading different types of material. 3 There could be far more potential for strengthening boys’ reading skills by encouraging other types of reading in addition to literature. 96 Literature 0 0 Example facts: 1 Boys have different reading habits than girls. 2 In every country except Korea, girls reported reading for enjoyment more than boys. 3 In 14 countries, only a minority of boys said that they read for enjoyment. 4 In Japan … only 54 percent of boys and 58 percent of girls … enjoy reading. 5 90 percent of Thai girls read for enjoyment. 1 speaker 3 2 speakers 4 and 5 3 speaker 1 4 speakers 4 and 5 5 speakers 1 and 3 6 speaker 2 Audio scripts 6.4 and 6.5 1 6 Where possible, create small groups with students from different countries. • Students discuss the questions for three or four minutes. Take feedback from a few groups. Emphasise that the second part of the question is important in an academic context. Explain that when trying to understand why something happens, it is important to really establish that one thing happens because of something else – not just that it happens after it in time. VOCABULARY: words from the text Matching words and phrases is a common question in IELTS reading tests. For students preparing for IELTS, you might make this exercise more authentic/tricky by asking them to close their books and looking at the highlighted words. They should try and write a definition of these terms. They then do the exercise as in the coursebook. 7a Give students five minutes to match the words and definitions. You might allow them to use a dictionary in the last two minutes. • Students compare answers with a partner, using a dictionary if necessary. Check answers in class. 2 3 1 proportion 2 preference 3 associated 4 virtually 5 gender gap 6 typically 7 outperform 8 relatively 9 pronounced 7bStudents complete the activity individually and then check with a partner. Take class feedback. • In feedback, pay close attention to pronunciation and stress, since the words are multi-syllabic. 1 outperform 2 proportion 3 pronounced 4 associated 5 relatively 6 preference 7 virtually 8 gender gap 9 typically LISTENING 4 8 Tell students that some questions might have more than one answer. • Play the recording. Students answer individually and then check in pairs. Take class feedback. When I was in elementary school, I was a devoted reader and a good student. I used to read in bed for an hour every night before I fell asleep. And at school I would go to the library every afternoon. I loved reading. Then my dad lost his job and we kept moving schools. As soon as I got used to the new school and new friends I would have to leave. And finally I ended up in a school where reading was not cool, certainly not for boys. My grades got worse and I would only read one or two books a year. When I left school, I joined a band and started composing songs. I started reading again because reading helped me understand the world and understand myself, and helped me find ideas for my songs. I used to read more than one book at a time and sometimes I’d have three or four on the go. But in recent years, I’ve mainly stuck to one book at a time, although if I’m reading a hardcover, I’ll sometimes have a paperback on the side to bring on the train or to read in the bath. And that’s my favourite place for reading – the bath – and if it’s a really good book, I’ll keep reading till the water goes cold. Life would be a much less interesting place if I didn’t read. As a child I loved to read and I would read in bed almost every night. But now I seem to have lost my love of reading. I used to love it. And I mean love it. I was a bookworm. I used to read, like, a whole novel in one day or less than a day. I loved imagining myself in the book. But now I’ve lost interest in them – even my favourite books that I would read over and over. To be honest, I think it’s down to the internet. I seem to have lost my attention span and focus. I used to read entire books in one sitting, now I put them down to check my phone, forget about them, only read the beginning and then lose interest. I didn’t use to read a lot. It once took me a year to read Martin Johnson, the ex-England Rugby Captain’s autobiography. I used to read a page a night and I would get bored really quickly. I hated reading at school 97 Literature 0 0 5 because I’m dyslexic. However, I’m reading a lot more now. Recently, I’ve been reading the Lee Childs novels and I read two chapters a night and actually, I’m really proud of myself. Before I became a librarian, I used to read pretty exclusively within the fantasy/sci-fi genres. Even now those are my go-to book choices. However, I try to continuously remind myself to read across as many genres as possible because advising readers is a big part of my job. And actually I really enjoyed reading George Eliot’s Middlemarch. It’s not the sort of book I would normally read, but it had everything – great characters, great stories and great descriptions of the scenery and countryside. It was warm and funny and gripping. I’m reading more now than I did when I was younger … and I’m reading different genres as well. 9 Students read the text and complete anything they remember from the first listening. • Play the recording again. Students complete as much as they can by themselves and then check answers with the same partner as in Exercise 8. • Go through the text in class. 1 was 2 used to read 3 fell 4 would go 5 loved 6 lost 7 got use to 8 ended 9 got 10 would 11 joined 12 started 13 helped GRAMMAR: used to, would, get used to 10a Tell students to find and read all the examples in the text before they choose True or False. • Check that students understand state, habit and accustomed to. • If students find this activity very difficult, ask them to read the Language reference on page 136. • Ask them to compare with a partner before you check answers and elicit examples from the class. • In feedback, emphasise that we can’t use used to for single actions/events in the past; we have to use the past simple (e.g. I used to go to the cinema last week is wrong). 1F 2T 3F 4T • In feedback, write the examples on the board and underline the relevant parts to highlight form. Negative: We use auxiliary didn’t + used to + infinitive (e.g. read). Questions: We use auxiliary did + used to + infinitive (e.g. read). In pairs, students ask two or three of the questions. This is good preparation for Exercise 15. 11 Students work in pairs and refer to Exercise 10 and the Language reference if they need help. • Monitor to point out mistakes if necessary. • Check answers with the class. Ensure students explain why answers are wrong. 1 would used 2 was 3 is 4 at the moment 5 didn’t used to wouldn’t 6 used to got used to 7 would used to 8 Did you used to Would you Ask students to look again at question 1 and ask them whether it is a fact or opinion (fact). Get them to practise their critical thinking skills by discussing with them why women had to write anonymously at that time. 12 Set this as a challenge. Students read the text as fast as possible. As soon as they think they know the problem, they put their hand up. After 30 seconds, ask the student who put their hand up first to say what the problem is. If they are wrong, ask the second person, and so on, until you get the correct answer. • Ask the class to identify a solution. There is no variety. Only used to is used. Students rewrite this text so that it is more interesting, by using different forms. 13 Students should make brief notes about what/ how they used to read. Give them seven minutes to write a short text. • Students compare answers in pairs. Each partner should give feedback to the other about whether they have used the different verb forms well. 5T 10b Tell students to look at the examples carefully before answering the question. • Ask them to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. 98 Literature 0 0 PRONUNCIATION Exercises like this are good practice for the PTE-A Speaking section. In the exam, students must listen to and repeat a sentence exactly as they hear it, using correct pronunciation. 14 Play the recording. Students compare with a partner before you elicit answers from the class. • Play the recording again. Pause after each sentence to allow students to repeat. Correct pronunciation. • Finally, point out that the pronunciation of used to and use to is exactly the same in English, i.e. the /d/ sound disappears. In the second sentence the /d/ sound is pronounced, which is why it is incorrect. 6.4 SCENARIO: THE NEW FILM PROJECT IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging Students read the scenario about making a pitch for a new film to a production company. They listen to two people discuss their idea for a film and then focus on the Key language. In the Task, students work in pairs to make a presentation to other members of the class about a film project. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from listening and reading texts • learnt useful phrases related to the language of persuasion. • used this language in a ‘real life’ situation to give a presentation about a film they would like to make The first sentence is correct. Audio script 6.6 I used to read in bed for an hour every night before I fell asleep. 15 Put students in small groups and give them ten minutes to discuss their ideas. Monitor to note mistakes when using the target language. • When finished, get a few ideas from the class. • Finally, correct some of the more common or important mistakes you noted earlier. Timings Possible lesson break: after Exercise 3b. WARM-UP This activity introduces the idea of a film pitch (a short summary of the main points of a film). HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the vocabulary, reading, listening and grammar exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Student do Exercise G2–3 on page 137 in the Language reference. • Ask students to think about a film they like. • Students have two minutes to make notes. They then give a short (30–60-second) summary of the plot to a partner. Their partner can ask questions if they wish. SITUATION 1 This exercise revises the topic of genre, which was introduced in lesson 6.1. • Students read the email and questions individually. They then answer the questions in pairs. • Take feedback from three or four pairs. Try and elicit several common film genres and write them on the board (e.g. horror, comedy, thriller, action). KEY LANGUAGE: persuading 2 Elicit the meaning of persuading. Since this is a central concept for the task, it is important that students are clear what it means (convincing somebody that you are correct about something so that they accept your argument). 99 Literature 0 0 • Students read the questions. • Play the recording. Students answer individually and then check with a partner. • Take brief class feedback. 1 thriller and horror 2 two women returning from college 3 the 20–40-year-old group Audio script 6.7 Jerry, Francesca J: F: J: F: J: F: J: I’ve got a great idea for a film, Francesca. I’m sure it’ll be a winner. Really? OK, try it out on me. Imagine I’m the management listening to your pitch. If it’s really good, we can work on it and enter the competition. OK, I’m confident you’ll like my idea. I hope so. OK, I’ll start. Good morning, everyone, I’m sure you’ll find our concept exciting and original. I’ll start with the storyline. Two women are returning from college to their parents’ houses. On the way, they find the road’s closed, with a notice saying ‘Do not enter’. A local man explains that there was an awful murder last night at the house on the hill. The women are in a hurry. They ignore the notice and go down the road. They’re never seen again. I think you’ll agree, it’s a really interesting and creative idea. Of course, we’ll have to work out the details. It’s just a storyline at the moment. But it’s got a lot of potential and it could be a real winner. A woman disappears and no one knows what’s happened to her. It’s really … intriguing. Turning now to the actors. We’d like to get stars, if possible – young actors who’ve already proved themselves. We’re thinking of Naomi Watts and Jennifer Lawrence – the one who was in Hunger Games. They’re both really attractive and good actors. They’d be perfect. The budget, I think, would allow us to use well-known actors. They’re bound to appeal to the audience who’d go to the film. OK, so, who is our target audience? Who do we have in mind? I’d say the 20- to 40-year-old group. They’re the ones that go regularly to the cinema. They’ll love our concept. It’s got such a wide appeal: two female characters, mystery and F: J: F: J: F: danger. Its biggest selling point would be that it’s a thriller and also a horror film. OK, to summarise, our concept has a fascinating storyline. We think it’s got tremendous potential. The audience will want to know what’s happened to the two women. Have they disappeared for ever? That’s the mystery the film will solve. There’ll be all kinds of twists and turns in the plot and a lot of human interest. We really believe in our concept and hope we’ve managed to convince you, too. What do you think, Francesca? Do you like the idea? I absolutely love it! It’s a fantastic plot. Well done! Great, I thought you’d like it. I do. You’ve convinced me, totally. Nice presentation, too. Let’s start working on it because the management will ask a lot of questions and expect more details. I’d say we’ve got a winner, Jerry, with this concept. OK, let’s meet tomorrow after work in the canteen. OK with you? Fine. See you roundabout six. 3a Students tick as many of the statements as they can remember from the first listening. • Play the recording again. Students complete the exercise individually. • In feedback, ask which statements were not mentioned, to speed up the process. + Ask students to identify which of the language in the questions is less formal (question 1: it’ll be a winner; question 3: really interesting; question 6: they’ll love; question 9: great). tick: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 8; cross: 7, 9 3b Students turn to page 175 and look for statements which are similar to 7 and 9 in Exercise 3a. • Take class feedback. Explain that being able to say what you want in more than one way can be useful in terms of increasing the variety of what you say, and to restate your position. 7 It’s got such a wide appeal. 9 We really believe in our concept and hope we’ve managed to convince you, too. 100 Literature 0 0 6.5 STUDY AND WRITING SKILLS TASK: making a persuasive presentation 4a Set the activity. In pairs, students brainstorm their ideas and develop a rough outline of the story. Give them ten minutes for this. 4bGive students a minute to read the notes and the useful phrases. Check in class that everything is understood. If not, clarify as needed. • In pairs, students check they’ve discussed all the key information. They must also work out how to divide the five-minute presentation equally. Some groups may benefit by an additional five minutes to do a ‘dummy run’ rehearsal. 5a Explain the marking system to be used. Ask students to describe the kind of things they would expect to see in a ‘brilliant’ presentation. • Students give their presentation to the class. Monitor time and do not allow students to go (too far) over the five-minute limit. • Get students to ask questions. You may need to do this at first to encourage the others. If your class is reluctant to ask questions, nominate people before each presentation. 5b Add up the scores and declare the winner. It would probably be best to do this in secret and not reveal everybody’s final scores, so as to avoid demotivating weaker groups. • Give general feedback about the presentations. HOMEWORK OPTIONS IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging This lesson focuses on making effective presentations and writing an online review. Students listen to five people talking about effective presentations and look at rhetorical techniques which help improve the quality of a presentation. They watch a video which illustrates some of these techniques and practise using them. Next, students consider key features of an online review, focusing in particular on adjectives and adverbs. Finally, students write their own review of a film they have seen. Study skills video Watch the video to see a talk about the film The Girl with the Dragon Tattoo. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from listening and reading texts • developed their understanding of rhetorical techniques and practised how they can improve presentations • extended their range of adverbs and adjectives • written an online review of a recent film Timings Students do the Key language, listening, vocabulary and academic collocations exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Students do Exercise KL–4 on page 137 in the Language reference. If short of time, omit Exercise 7. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 7. WARM-UP To introduce the theme of the first half of the lesson, students should reflect on the presentation they gave at the end of lesson 6.4. In pairs or small groups, students discuss how they think they did in their film presentation and how other people said they did. STUDY SKILLS: making an effective presentation Extended speaking, whether in the form of a presentation or discussion, is a common means of assessing a student’s English speaking ability (e.g. IELTS Speaking task 3). 101 Literature 0 0 1 Check students understand memorable (something you can remember for a long time because it was so good). Students then read the statements. • Play the recording. Students answer individually and then check in pairs. Take class feedback. 1d 2c 3e 4a 5b Audio script 6.8 1 I went to a lecture on English Literature. To make her key point, the lecturer quoted two lines from the American poet Robert Frost: ‘Home is where you go to and they can’t turn you away.’ She repeated the two lines several times during her talk to make her points. I heard that presentation 25 years ago and I still remember the quote. Her presentation was truly outstanding. 2 The lecturer was talking about trends in the current economic climate. Her presentation could have been boring, but the slides she used to illustrate her points were striking and incredibly imaginative. So everyone listened to her very intently. 3 There was another presenter at the conference on the current economic climate. He started by telling us an anecdote – something about a train coming through a tunnel and almost crashing when it came out the other side. He took about two minutes to come to the punchline. He took so long to tell the story that the audience were amused and listened carefully to the rest of his talk. 4 The presenter had worked for years for the BBC. His talk was on how to give an effective presentation. He spoke in a low but powerful voice which carried to the back of the room without the need of a loudspeaker. He had such a magnificent voice that his presentation was memorable. 5 It was the best presentation I’ve ever heard. The speaker used all kinds of rhetorical devices – you know, techniques to get across his ideas in a memorable way, like tripling – that’s using words in threes – contrasting ideas, repetition, alliteration, quotes from literature. It was an amazing demonstration of how to make a presentation effective. 2 Students swap partners and discuss the questions. Emphasise that they must give reasons as to why it was impressive. When done, ask three or four students to share their experiences. 3a Rhetorical techniques. Students read the explanation of this term. Ask them whether they can think of an example. Prompt them with what they just heard in the listening (e.g. a quotation). Explain that the use of rhetorical techniques is useful for improving the quality and effectiveness of a presentation. However, if they are used too much, the effect may be lost. Presentations are a common feature of higher education. Students may need to do them at the beginning of seminars, in class or for assessment. 3b Students should work in pairs for this exercise. Monitor closely and help where needed. • Tell students not to get stuck on one question if they are not sure. They should do the easier ones first and then move on to the more difficult ones. 1 c 2 d 3 e 4 g, k 5 i 10 j 11 a 6b 7e 8h 9f In pairs, groups or with the whole class, create additional examples of each rhetorical technique. Elicit/Check dragon (a large, mythical, scary creature, like a dinosaur) and tattoo (body art). Students read the description and then discuss the questions in pairs. Take brief class feedback. Students read the questions. Play the video. Students complete individually and then check in pairs. Take class feedback. 4 • 5 • • 1 They are trying to find out what happened to Vanger’s niece, Harriet, who disappeared 40 years ago. 2 Lisbeth. There are so many contrasts in her character. She is a fascinating person. 3 outstanding actors in the two main roles; the film is based on a superb book Study skills video Hi, everyone. The film you’re going to see tonight is The Girl with the Dragon Tattoo. It’s based on the first of three Swedish novels written by Stieg Larsson and it features two main characters, an investigative journalist, Mikael Blomkvist, and a young female researcher, Lisbeth Salander. The books were a huge success internationally. Their sales to date have been well over $100 million. The film has been equally successful. One critic, comparing it to the book wrote, ‘This mystery is 102 Literature 0 0 just as devastating, suspenseful and satisfying on screen.’ And another one wrote, ‘This dynamite thriller shivers with suspense. In a word, wow!’ OK, I’ll start by outlining the plot of the film. It’s very complicated and I hope my summary will make it easier for you to understand the twists and turns in the story. After that, I’ll talk about the two main characters. And finally, I’ll suggest a couple of reasons why the film has been so popular and highly praised. Right, let’s start with the plot. The film’s about an investigation by a journalist, Mikael Blomkvist. He’s hired by a millionaire, Henrik Vanger, to find out what happened to Vanger’s niece, Harriet, who disappeared 40 years ago. Henrik suspects that someone in the family, the powerful Vanger family, murdered Harriet. by two extraordinarily talented actors, Daniel Craig and Rooney Mara – they’re perfect for their roles. And the second reason is that the film’s based on a superb novel that millions of people have enjoyed. OK, I hope you’ve found my presentation useful and informative. Let’s watch the film. 6a Working in the same pairs as Exercise 5, ask students to discuss what techniques they can remember and note them down. • Play the video again and get students to note down any additional techniques they notice. • Take feedback and write correct rhetorical techniques on the board for use in Exercise 7. Tripling: a computer hacker, very anti-social, looks like a punk; a serious person, with a journalist’s curiosity and a strong social conscience; She has a tattoo, nose ring and many earrings. Alliteration: twists and turns; strong, singleminded and stubborn Quotation: ‘This mystery is just as devastating, suspenseful and satisfying on screen’; ‘This dynamite thriller shivers with suspense. In a word, wow!’ Simile: looks like a punk; looks like a frightened animal; her skin is pale like porcelain china. Imagery: This dynamite thriller shivers with suspense. Repetition: Henrik suspects that someone in the family, the powerful Venger family, murdered Harriet. Contrast: a single event/a series of terrible murders; often a victim, she always takes revenge on her enemies Rhetorical questions: Who wouldn’t find her fascinating? Why has the film been so successful? In his investigation, Mikael gets help from a young female researcher, Lisbeth Salander. She’s a computer hacker, very anti-social and looks like a punk. They soon realise that Harriet’s disappearance isn’t a single event, but rather linked to a series of terrible murders in the area. They begin to discover a dark and appalling family history and when they do this, they put themselves in great danger. So, I’ve given you an idea of what the film’s about. Moving on now to the two main characters, Mikael Blomkvist and Lisbeth Salander. They’re an interesting contrast. On the one hand, there’s Mikael, the journalist, played by Daniel Craig, who’s better known for playing James Bond in the Bond films. Mikael’s a serious person, with a journalist’s curiosity and a strong social conscience. He’s 20 years older than Lisbeth. On the other hand, there’s Lisbeth Salander, by far the most interesting character in the film. Who wouldn’t find her fascinating? A small woman, at times she looks like a frightened animal. But at other times she’s strong, single-minded and stubborn. She’s a very troubled person because she had a difficult childhood. Physically, she’s very attractive in an unusual way. She has shiny, spiky, black hair, yet her skin is pale like porcelain china. She has a tattoo, nose ring and many earrings. Often a victim, she always takes her revenge on her enemies. So, Why has the film been so successful? Probably for two reasons. The main characters are played 6b If students found the first exercise difficult, tell them which techniques can be found. They should then try and find at least one example of each. • In pairs, students check the audio script, either confirming what they have already found or finding additional answers. • Take class feedback. Write up any remaining techniques on the board. 7 Students will need some time to prepare this, as they need to create five minutes of material as well as including rhetorical techniques. 103 Literature 0 0 • Monitor closely during this exercise, since students may need help in identifying how to use rhetorical techniques. • When they are ready, students make their presentation in groups of three or four. You might ask them to assess these presentations using the same criteria as on page 63. Some groups may find this exercise easier if they only have to do a three-minute presentation, so they can focus more on the rhetorical techniques. • Check answers with the class and get two or three reasonable suggestions for each adjective. Suggested answers: interesting → gripping, fascinating, absorbing, compelling funny → humorous, amusing, hilarious exciting → thrilling, dramatic, exhilarating, nail biting stupid → crazy, absurd, laughable, ridiculous nice → pleasant, lovely, beautiful good → excellent, brilliant, outstanding, terrific boring → dull, tedious, monotonous, repetitive bad → terrible, appalling, awful, dreadful WRITING SKILLS: an online review 8 Elicit the meaning of online review (an opinion of a film put on a website). Students then discuss the questions in pairs. Take brief feedback for each. 9 Students discuss the questions with a partner. All the items are possible in an online review, except what happens at the end. 10 Tell students that the film review is for Skyfall, the 2012 James Bond film. Ask if anyone has seen this film and if they have an opinion about it. • Give students two minutes to skim-read the text to answer the question. Then put students in pairs to discuss. Encourage them to underline/highlight specific language which shows the author’s view. • Take class feedback. 13a Adverbs. Elicit why adverbs are important and what their purpose is (they add considerable meaning to language, helping it to be more specific/focused). • Explain to students that they should find matching pairs of adverbs. You should say that they do not have exactly the same meaning, but can often be used in a similar way. • Check answers with the class. Check pronunciation of the final -ly sound. Do not focus on meaning as this is the focus of Exercise 13b. completely – totally, definitely – certainly, really – truly, particularly – especially, generally – usually positive, but with some negative points 11 Students read the information in the coursebook. Check their understanding of cast (people who act in a film) and setting (the location of a film). • Ask students to predict where some of the aspects might be found (e.g. that the recommendation comes at the end, in para D). • Individually, students match the aspects with the paragraphs. They then check in pairs. • Take class feedback. Ask students to provide evidence that supports their answer in each case. 1 A, C 2 A 3 A 4 C 5 A, B 6 A, C, D 7 B, C 8 D 13b Students quickly match the adverbs with their meanings. Check answers with the class. In pairs, students create their own sentences using the target language. 1 totally, completely 2 definitely, certainly 3 generally, usually 4 particularly, especially 5 really, truly 14 If there is time, students write their review in class. They will need at least 30 minutes to do this. HOMEWORK OPTIONS 12 Adjectives. Check that students understand the additional information in the instructions. • If necessary, explain what a thesaurus is (a book which groups words that have similar meanings). Allow them to use their mobile devices if desired. • Ask students to try and think of at least one synonym for each adjective. When they have done this, they compare their answers in pairs. Students do the study skills, reading, reading and listening and writing skills exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Students do Exercise 14. 104 Literature 0 0 7 Architecture Unit Objectives Grammar: Vocabulary: Scenario: Study skills: Writing skills: the passive describing buildings; idioms; prefixes talking about requirements; deciding on facilities in a hotel identifying fact and opinion an opinion-led essay 7.1 ICONIC BUILDINGS IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging This lesson looks at architecture and people’s favourite buildings. Students read about three famous buildings and focus on vocabulary connected with architecture and construction. Finally, they discuss iconic buildings and write a paragraph describing one. Meet the expert video Watch a video of an architectural journalist talking about innovative designs. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have • extracted specific information and language items from reading texts • extended their vocabulary related to architecture and construction, and practised using this • participated in a discussion to express their opinions about an iconic building and written a paragraph about it Timings If short of time, set Exercise 10 as homework. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 5b or 7. • Elicit answers from the class. • Finally, ask students if they have visited, like/dislike each building. Le Corbusier quote: This quote suggests that the main purpose of a house is ‘function. The idea of ‘aesthetics’ is therefore less important. You might discuss with students whether they share this view or hold the opposite. VOCABULARY: describing buildings 1 To give students some ideas for this activity, you could focus them on the photos on pages 66–67 or refer them to the Warm-up activity. • Students discuss the question in pairs before you elicit a few ideas from the class. 2a Tell students to do as many adjectives as possible before using a dictionary. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. • In feedback, elicit that classical is a European style from the Roman/Greek period (ca. AD 1000– 500 BCE), but some modern buildings use this style. • Tell students that the neutral adjectives can be either positive or negative, depending on the opinion of the speaker/writer. Positive: elegant, graceful, impressive, magnificent, stylish, imposing, innovative Negative: derelict, dilapidated, run-down, ugly Neutral: ancient, classical, contemporary, ornate, traditional WARM-UP This activity introduces the topic of iconic buildings. • Write the following buildings on the board, but not the dates in brackets: the Colosseum (ca. AD 80), the Eiffel Tower (1889), Tower Bridge, London (1894), the Sydney Opera House (1973), the Empire State Building (1931), the Taj Mahal (1648), the Great Wall of China (building began 500 BCE). • Check that students know each building. It may help to elicit/tell students which cities they are in, take in photos/use the photos on pages 66–67. • In pairs, students order the buildings from the earliest construction date to the latest. Ask students whether they know any more words which could be placed in these categories. Allow them to look some up in a thesaurus or online. 2bWarn students that more than one adjective goes in some categories and a couple of adjectives can go in more than one category. • Students work individually and then compare answers with a partner. 105 New Language Leader Upper Intermediate Architecture 0 0 • Check answers with the class and write the words on the board in preparation for Exercise 3. 1 dilapidated, derelict, run-down 2 traditional, ancient, classical 3 ugly 4 innovative 5 elegant, stylish, graceful 6 ornate 7 contemporary 8 imposing, impressive, magnificent • In feedback, elicit the stressed syllable on each word and ask students to mark this in their books. The main stress is marked in the answers below. 1 g damage 2 e rebuild 3 c construct 4 h demolish 5 b maintain 6 a restore 7 d commission 8 f design PRONUNCIATION 3 Word stress. Elicit the importance of word stress in English (to be clear and to make your spoken English follow the ‘rhythms’ of English). • Focus students on the first adjective you wrote on the board in Exercise 2b, elicit the main stress and mark it on the word (see answer key below). • In pairs, students mark stress on the other words. They can say the word to each other if necessary. • Check answers with the class. • Ask students to work individually to group the words according to their syllable stress. • Students compare answers with a partner. Play the recording, pausing after each word for students to check. • Play the recording again, pausing after each word for students to repeat, and correct if necessary. First-syllable stress: ancient, classical, derelict, elegant, graceful, innovative, stylish, ugly Second-syllable stress: contemporary, dilapidated, imposing, impressive, magnificent, ornate, run-down, traditional 4 Give students one minute to look at the photos and decide their opinions. • Put students in pairs to describe the buildings and discuss which they like. Students describe one of the buildings. Their partner must guess which is described. Give students a few minutes to think of a building they know (it doesn’t need to be famous). In small groups, students describe their buildings and ask each other questions for more information if necessary. Alternatively, you could provide some photos of buildings for use in discussion. 5a Tell students to match as many words as possible before using their dictionaries to check meaning. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. 5bTo help students get started, elicit the first stage (commission) and then give them two minutes to order the other words. • The order is not obvious, so put students in pairs to compare their lists and discuss the options. • Elicit answers and write them on the board. Ask students if they agree with the order as you write each item. Accept any reasonable answers. • Finally, give students the suggested order below. Monitor for use of the passive structure while students are discussing the order of the verbs. This will help assess their ability before the grammar focus in the next lesson. • For further practice, ask students to do Exercises V1–5 and V2–6 on page 135 in the Language reference. Suggested answers: 1 commission 2 design 3 construct 4 maintain 5 damage 6 restore 7 demolish 8 rebuild READING 6a To lead in, (re)elicit the name of each building and where it is (Colosseum: Rome, Italy; Taj Mahal: Agra, India; Eiffel Tower: Paris, France). • Explain that students will read about each building later. This is a prediction activity. • Set the activity and give students one minute to guess the answers. • Ask students to compare with a partner. • Elicit a few guesses from the class. Making predictions about what you are going to read is a good technique to use in exam tasks, such as the IELTS or PTE-A Reading. This will help to provide clues to the content and structure of the text, e.g. using the title of a text to predict content or using topic sentences to get the gist of a text. 6b Give students five minutes to read the texts and check their answers. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. • In feedback, check that students understand gladiators (Roman fighters for entertainment). 106 Architecture 0 0 • Finally, ask students if they have visited/would like to visit any of the buildings and why/why not. 1 F (opened in AD80) 2 T (gladiator and animal fights) 3 T 4 F (recently renovated and partly restored) 5 F (built in memory of an Emperor’s wife) 6 F (less than 500 years ago) 7 T (from environmental pollution) 8 F (there was a lot of opposition from the public when it was built) 9 T (until about 1930) 10 T (built as a temporary structure) Make Exercises 6a and 6b more communicative by dividing the class in three and getting each group to focus on only one text. In 6b, students read their text to check their guesses and swap information with students who read the other texts. In Exercise 7, either ask students to find the words in their text only and then swap information or ask everyone to read all three texts. 7 Students do this activity individually and then compare answers with a partner. This kind of matching task is commonly found in IELTS Reading and Listening exams. • Go through the answers and check pronunciation of any difficult words (e.g. amphitheatre). 1 amphitheatre 2 survived 3 renovate (Note: renovate: in good condition; restore: to original condition) 4 tomb 5 dome 6 exterior 7 interior 8 landmark 9 temporary 10 eyesore • Take class feedback from three or four students, or from one student from every country (if your class is multinational). 10 Give students fifteen minutes to write their paragraph using the notes they made earlier. • Monitor to help with vocabulary if necessary. • Take the work in for marking, paying particular attention to the use of vocabulary from this lesson. • Alternatively, post the paragraphs round the room and ask students to read them all. Then ask them which buildings they already know and which they would like to visit. MEET THE EXPERT 1 Students discuss the questions in pairs. Encourage them to give reasons for all the points. 1 a Belfast (Northern Ireland) b Sheffield (England) c Sao Paulo (Brazil) 2 a music, theatre, dance and art; b housing; c culture and leisure 3–4 Students’ own answers 2 Follow on from Exercise 1 by asking the class what they discussed about the Sesc Pompeia building. Encourage students to comment on the opinions of other students, but do not clarify or correct yet. • Students read the sentences in the book. • Play the video. Individually, students tick the sentences they hear. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. a, c, d, f SPEAKING AND WRITING 8 Students should take a few minutes to think about which building they would like to describe. This exercise may work best if they have some time to research the building online. • Students talk for around 30 seconds on each topic with a partner. The research stage means you will need to give students lots of time in the lesson. Alternatively, they could research and make notes in their own time and write the paragraph in class. 9 Critical thinking: Interpreting ideas. In this activity students reflect on what they have read and listened to about buildings and apply it to their own context. • Students discuss the questions, ideally with someone from a different country. • You should monitor discussions, as the concepts under discussion are quite complex. Meet the expert video Laura Mark, architectural journalist I’m Laura Mark. I’m a technical reporter for The Architects’ Journal, which is a weekly magazine for architects. I studied architecture before I joined The Architects’ Journal and I also worked in practice for six years before then. My three favourite buildings are the The Mac, in Belfast, which is a cultural art centre, Parkhill in Sheffield, which is a social housing scheme, and the Sesc Pompeia in Sao Paolo Brazil, which is a community centre. The Sesc Pompeia is a social scheme, a community centre, built in the slum area of Sao Paolo for the people who live there. It was built between the years of 1977 and 1986. And it 107 Architecture 0 0 housed many different uses, including, um, an exhibition centre, uh, community use and sports hall, sports centres, churches and a kind of a restaurant space as well. It was built by an organisation that wanted to bring education, culture and sports to the local people. They built several centres like this across Brazil. The Sesc Pompeia was designed by Lina Bo Bardi and its quite unusual because at the time, women architects didn’t really build that much in Brazil and this is quite a large of example of a project by a woman architect. And, um, what makes it even more unusual was that she was designing, using an existing factory building – which was, had been on the site for a long time and had already been, um, kind of used by a local community. They already were kind of using the building and playing in it, and so she had to work with them to create a space which they wanted. And I think a big key to that was that she moved onto the site whilst the building was in progress. And she had her office there, she worked with the local people, she worked with the crafts people working on a project and kind of really got in there and got building, I think. The existing factory was built out of red brick and concrete. The concrete used was, uh, quite unusual at the time; it was one of the early examples of it being used in Brazil at that scale. And what Lina Bo Bardi did was she uncovered these materials. She took away the plaster that had been covering them up for so many years and revealed them. So the materials had, like, a raw aesthetic and were kind of on view just as they were. And then next to this existing factory she built two concrete towers, very tall, 70 metres high. And then, within these towers, she punched windows through and these were then, the openings of these windows were then painted bright red, which is a kind of stark contrast to the, uh, raw concrete of the building. lacking in many of today’s buildings; they don’t quite manage to get that right, but she did. Um, and I think what, another thing, another aspect which is really important is that she reused this existing building and it already had a community about it. And she didn’t just go in there and get rid of it. And I think a lot of architects could learn from that today. The building was really popular when it first opened; people loved it. And it still remains that way to this day, it still has the community uses that were originally there. And Lina Bo Bardi even us-, still used the building right up until her death in 1992. 3a Individually, students complete as much as they can based on the first viewing. 3bReplay the video. Students check their answers, and confirm with a partner. Take class feedback. 1 slum 2 sport 3 several 4 wanted 5 70 metres 6 stark contrast 7 visually appealing 8 use 4 Students work in groups of three or four and discuss the questions for five to ten minutes. Take feedback from three groups for each question. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the writing skills and vocabulary exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. They can also do the MyEnglishLab video activities after this point. Students think about a building they visited on holiday in the past and write an email to a friend telling them why they liked/didn’t like the building. Students do exercises V1 5 and V2 6 on page 139 in the Language reference. I really like the Sesc Pompeia because it’s, it’s striking, it’s visually appealing, but at the same time it’s got this community feel about it. And when you look at the building, the concrete and the kind of materials could, could be really harsh. But, actually, it’s quite maternal, it’s loving and it’s got this fun feeling about it, which is kind of 108 Architecture 0 0 7.2 SOLVING PROBLEMS IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging Students read a text about four innovative solutions to housing problems. They study passive structures in the article and focus on meaning and form. Next, students listen to an architect talking about solutions to housing problems. Finally, they discuss housing problems specifically related to young people having to live at home for longer. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from a reading and a listening text • developed evaluating skills • revised/extended their understanding of the use of the present simple, future simple and present continuous passive • discussed housing problems faced by young people still living with their parents • Emphasise that the key word for discussion is interesting (they do not necessarily have to like it). • Students discuss with a partner which building is most interesting. They must give reasons. • Go through the photos one by one and ask who thinks each building is the most interesting. 2b Give students two minutes to skim-read the article. They should be looking for key words to help match the photos with parts 1–4. • Take class feedback. Explain as necessary. A2 B1 C4 D3 3 Students complete as much of the table as possible based on their first reading. Give them a further five minutes to re-read and complete as much as they can. Explain that there may not be answers for every question. • Students check in pairs. Take class feedback. Building A: Yasuhiro Yamashita; Tokyo; n/a; 146 m2; clever use of space made use of every centimetre Building B: dRMM; UK; glass; n/a; glass cover transforms the building giving extra space Building C: Etgar Keret; Poland; iron; 91 cm across; Poland’s narrowest house Building D: Gary Chang; Hong Kong; polished chrome; 32 m2; each space can change into 24 configurations Timings If short of time, omit Exercise 5 or set it as homework. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 7. + In pairs/small groups, students discuss which of WARM-UP This activity introduces the topic of living spaces. 4 • Give students three minutes to note down all the places they have lived in their lives. They should make brief notes about each. • In groups of three, students discuss the places – their size, location, features, etc. They should focus on both the positive and negative aspects. • Take class feedback from three or four students. • SPEAKING AND READING 1 Students may not have a lot of background knowledge about this topic, so may need some support/guidance. • If possible, ask students to work with a partner from a different country (where appropriate). • Take feedback from three of four students, or from a student of every nationality (if appropriate). 2a Students look at the photos. Explain that they are all strange or unusual buildings. 5 • • the buildings they would most like to live in. Critical thinking: Evaluating. In this exercise, students work with other students to evaluate information and decide which is more important. Put students in groups to discuss the questions. Ask one or two groups to share their ideas. Evaluating is an important skill when writing academic essays, since students must read and assess the importance of information. Evaluating the quality and usefulness of texts is one of the reading skills tested in the PTE-A. Individually, students match the words with their meanings. Students compare answers in pairs. They should try replacing the words in the text with the definitions, to check whether their answers still make sense (e.g. for question 1: This excellent and unusual building …). Check answers with the class. 1 remarkable 2 ingenious 3 numerous 4 cramped 5 configuration 6 miniscule 109 Architecture 0 0 GRAMMAR: the passive (1) LISTENING 6a Introduce the idea of the passive by asking students what the normal word order in English is (subject, verb, object). Elicit/Teach the structure of the passive: object, verb, (subject). • Check that students understand agent (subject, doer of the verb). • Ask students to read the passive sentences and match them with the descriptions. • Take class feedback and check understanding. 8a Set the context and play the recording. • Tell students not to worry if they cannot write the complete questions at this stage; a close approximation is sufficient. • Also tell students not to worry about the answers the speaker gives at this stage. They will listen again for these. • Students check answers with a partner and work together to get the language right. • Check answers with the class and write them on the board. a experts think it will soon be recognised as a landmark in its own right; is wedged b At present, several sliding houses are being manufactured by dRMM. 1 What do architects find interesting when designing buildings? 2 What type of architecture has particularly impressed you in terms of solving problems? 3 What’s your next project? 6b Discuss the question with the class. As revision, ask what the purpose of each of the tenses is and why they are being used in this situation. Audio script 7.2 Marta, Students present simple: is wedged present continuous: are being manufactured future simple: will soon be recognised S1: For weaker groups, write up the three verb forms on the board so that students can analyse them and not be confused by irrelevant detail. 6c In pairs, students work out the constructions of the passive forms. • Take class feedback. Write the forms on the board. • Direct students to the Language reference if needed (page 138). present simple: am/is/are + past participle present continuous: am/is/are being + past participle future simple: will be + past participle 7 Students do this activity individually and then compare with a partner. • Tell students to look at Exercise 6 and the Language reference on page 138 if they need help. • Monitor to point out mistakes, but encourage students to self-correct if possible. • Check answers with the class and if necessary, elicit the reasons for each one. 1 are being manufactured 2 will be built 3 is made 4 are being built/will be built 5 will be converted 6 is being carried out 7 will not/ won’t be finished What do architects find interesting when designing buildings? M: A good question. I’d say the most interesting thing relates to our role as an architect. In most cases, what are architects trying to do? Well, we’re trying to design an ideal place to meet human needs. That’s really our main motivation. It’s our ‘duty’ if you like, to create a place that integrates interior design with the needs of the people who’ll be using the building. It’s, how can I say, a relationship in which the individual and the place are integrated. They depend on each other. S2: What type of architecture has particularly impressed you in terms of solving problems? M: That’s an interesting question. I’ve lived in and visited a lot of hot climates and I really like the way that Islamic architecture deals with the problem of extreme heat. Houses are often built around a central open courtyard which ventilates them. And they often have a central basin or fountain, which provides a cooling effect and the soothing sound of falling water. When you visit the old mosques and palaces, which did not have electricity, you notice that the temperature is often just right. I sometimes use some of the central features of Arab architecture, which include patios, open courtyards and water features, 110 Architecture 0 0 when designing hotels. Those features are really useful in regulating heat and cooling buildings during long, hot summer days. S3: What’s your next project? M: Well, it seems that affordable housing is the new buzzword and we’ve just won a contract to deliver 300 housing units on sites in and around Copenhagen. These will be very reasonably priced and a large proportion will be reserved for essential workers such as nurses, police officers and teachers. Most affordable housing looks very boring, but our project offers a huge variation of housing sizes and configurations. The project is based on a prefab basis module of wood which surrounds a central core for a wet room or shower and technical installations and a staircase. Then the modules can be put together horizontally and vertically, like building blocks. We’re really looking forward to getting started. 8b Check students are clear that they are identifying the answers to the questions from Exercise 8a. • Students work with the same partner. They discuss whether they can remember what the answers to the questions were. • Play the recording again. Students check/note down their answers. 8c In the same pairs, students compare notes. Take class feedback. For weaker groups, you might let students check the audio script on page 176 to ensure they have the correct language. SPEAKING 9 Ask students to read the statements and then give them five minutes to make some notes with examples to support their opinions. If students do not have much knowledge of this topic, you might let them search online at first. • Students work in groups of three or four and discuss these questions for between ten and fifteen minutes. • In feedback, ask one or two groups to share their ideas with the rest of the class. In many speaking exams, such as IELTS, students have to discuss this kind of issue, i.e. those with personal relevance and interest to young people. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the grammar and vocabulary exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Students write up a report about their discussions in Exercise 9. 1 trying to design an ideal place to meet human needs 2 Islamic architecture which deals with the problem of extreme heat built around a central courtyard which ventilates the rooms on the outside 3 affordable housing in Copenhagen 111 Architecture 0 0 7.3 BUILDING BRIDGES IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging This lesson looks at bridges around the world. Students read an article about important bridges and then discuss how these compare. Students then focus on idioms related to bridges and the use of prefixes with words in the text. Next, students look at passive structures in the text and focus on the meaning of these before practising them. Finally, students discuss two bridges, using information provided, and write a paragraph to describe one of them. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from a reading text • revised and/or extended their range of idioms and prefixes • revised/learnt about the past simple and present perfect passive • discussed two different bridges and written about one of them. Timings If short of time, set Exercise 5 as homework. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 6b. WARM-UP This activity introduces the topic of bridges and why people like/dislike them. • Focus students on the photos on pages 70–71 and ask if they like the designs of these bridges. • Ask students to think of a bridge they like or dislike and think about why. • Put students in pairs to talk about their bridges, giving information such as where it is, what river it crosses, how old it is, what it looks like, what it’s used for, as well as why they like/dislike it. Students should ask each other questions for further information. • Finally, ask a few students to tell the class about their bridges and why they like/dislike them. READING 1 Focus students on the photos and ask them if they know anything about these bridges. They may already have touched on this in the warm-up. • Ask students to briefly discuss the second question in pairs. Elicit a few ideas from the class. 2 Read through the instructions with the class. Give students three minutes to read the introduction (the text in the right-hand column on page 70) and tick the reasons. • Students compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. 2, 4, 5 3 Read through the questions with the class and check they understand resist (prevent the effects of something), dimensions (length, width, etc.). • Give students five minutes to read the rest of the article and answer the questions. • Monitor to help with vocabulary (words students must know to answer the questions, e.g. harp) or ask students to use their dictionaries. • Students compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. 1 Charles Bridge 2 Akashi Kaikyo Bridge 3 Golden Gate Bridge 4 Alamillo Bridge 4 Critical thinking: Comparing features. Students must use the knowledge learnt in the lesson so far to critically evaluate the different bridges. They must identify the specific features which are similar or different. • Give students two minutes to read the information on the bridges again. • Put students in pairs to discuss the similarities and differences. • Ask two or three students to tell the class what similarities and differences they talked about with their partner. You could take this opportunity to monitor for students’ use of comparative structures and phrases. In feedback, elicit corrections to some of the mistakes you noted and/or give students alternative ways of expressing themselves. The ability to compare and contrast is a key skill in many exams, when both writing and speaking (e.g. IELTS Writing task 2). VOCABULARY: idioms, prefixes 5 Elicit/Teach idiom (a group of words whose meaning is difficult to predict from its contents). • When students read the first paragraph of the article, ask them to underline all the idioms they can find. Tell them the idioms all contain bridge. 112 Architecture 0 0 • Check that students have found four idioms and elicit them from the class. • Tell students to use the idioms to complete sentences 1–4. Remind them that they may need to change the form. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. • In pairs, students try to express the idioms in other words. They can read the article for clues. • Elicit ideas from the class (see below). • For further practice, ask students to do Exercise V3–7 on page 139 in the Language reference. 1 burn my bridges 2 cross that bridge when we come to it 3 all water under the bridge 4 build (some) bridges Idioms in other words: 1 lose something I’ve got when I may still need it 2 deal with that when it happens 3 it’s already happened, let’s forget about it 4 make friends and form relationships GRAMMAR: the passive (2) 7a Give students three minutes to underline examples. • Ask students to compare answers with a partner. In feedback, check that they have underlined all the correct examples. • Give students a few minutes to find any unknown vocabulary from the examples. Then put them in pairs to discuss the form. • In feedback, write examples of the past simple and present perfect passive on the board and highlight the relevant parts to show the form. • Finally, remind students of the contractions of have (’ve) and has (’s) and then elicit/explain that adverbs generally come after the auxiliary (was, were, have or has), e.g. has never been. (Note: tragically is after been in the text because there are two adverbs in this sentence (occasionally is the other). It is a choice of style and makes the sentence easier to read.) Past simple passive: Examples: was destroyed, was built, (was) named (Note: The auxiliary was is not used here, but the form is still passive.), was opened Form: was/were + past participle Present perfect passive: Examples: has since been rebuilt, has … been tragically misplaced, has never been shattered, has been built Form: have/has + been + past participle 6a Do the first part of this activity with the whole class. Write each word on the board and underline the prefix. • Give students one minute to match the prefixes with the meanings. Check answers in class. 1 re- 2 in-, un- 3 mis- 4 over6bStudents do this activity individually and then compare with a partner. • In feedback, elicit/give the stress on the original words (e.g. important) and then on the word with the prefix (e.g. unimportant). • For further practice, ask students to do exercise V4–8 on page 139 in the Language reference. 1 unimportant 2 misunderstand 3 overcrowded 4 insignificant 5 redefine 6 insensitive Show students that prefixes are contained in the information about a word in a good dictionary. Understanding prefixes can be a big help when faced with unfamiliar vocabulary in reading and listening exams. Knowing what prefixes refer to can help students guess the approximate meaning. If possible, reproduce the article so that all students can see it (perhaps on an interactive whiteboard or an overhead projector). When you check that students have underlined the correct examples, to highlight the form and for feedback in Exercise 6b, highlight the relevant parts of the text. 7bAsk students if they found any other passive forms in the text and elicit examples (including those in this exercise if possible). • Give students 30 seconds to match the sentences with the forms and elicit answers from the class. • Then elicit the form of each from the class and write it on the board (see answer key below). • For further information, ask students to read G2 in the Language reference on page 138. 1b 2a Form 1: was/were + being + past participle Form 2: to be + past participle 113 Architecture 0 0 8 Explain that the report is about complaints made by local residents during the building of a hotel. • Orient students to the text by asking them to brainstorm what the complaints might be and then quickly read the text to check. (The complaints in the text are noise and pollution). • Give students five minutes to do the activity. • Ask them to compare with a partner and use Exercise 7 and the Language reference for help. • Check answers with the class and ask students to give reasons. • For further practice, ask students to do Exercises G1,2–1 and G1,2–2 on page 139 in the Language reference. 1 have been received 2 was completing completed 3 was constructing being constructed 4 were delivering being delivered 5 were digging being dug 6 were making being made/made 7 was doing done 8 have been were closed 9 have been received 10 has now been built 11 is to be done 12 to be publish published 9a First, elicit/tell students that the subject in a passive sentence comes at the end of the sentence. • Students do this activity in pairs before you check answers with the class. • In feedback, ask students to underline the long subject expression (the strange-shaped building in the City of London) in sentence 2 and the known information (it was designed) in sentence 1. • For further information, ask students to read G3 on page 138 of the Language Reference. 1b 2a The Gherkin (or 30 St Mary Axe or the Swiss Re Tower) is a building in London, completed in 2004. It has a strange shape (curved sides and pointed at the top) and is sometimes lit in green at night. People think it looks like a small cucumber (a gherkin). 9bGive students a few minutes to do this activity individually, then ask them to compare answers with a partner. • Check answers with the class and elicit the long subject expression or the known information in each highlighted passive. • Give students a few minutes to find difficult words from the sentences in their dictionaries. • For further practice, ask students to do Exercise G3–3 on page 139 in the Language reference. The bridge is supported by a pylon and cables which form the graceful shape of a harp: a this bridge has been built to: b The bridge was opened on 21 May: b It was opened to traffic: b SPEAKING AND WRITING 10 Ask students to look at the photo of their bridge. • Tell them that the information below the photo is about their bridge or about another student’s bridge. • Give them a few minutes to tick the pieces of information they think are about their bridge, using their dictionaries if necessary. • Then put students in pairs to tell each other the information they didn’t tick in the previous stage. • Students must not look at each other’s photos, but can ask questions. They should take notes while they are talking. • When students have all the information about their bridge, give them 20 minutes to write their paragraphs, using the notes they made in the previous stage and the information they ticked earlier. • Monitor to help with vocabulary and point out mistakes with the passive structures, if necessary. • Finally, take the paragraphs in for marking, paying particular attention to the use of passive structures. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the listening, vocabulary, reading and grammar exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Students write an account of a situation in their past using at least two of the idioms in Exercise 5. Students do exercises G1,2–1, G1,2–2, G3–3, V3–7 and V4–8 on page 139 in the Language reference. 114 Architecture 0 0 7.4 SCENARIO: ON THE HORIZON IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging This lesson focuses on the language of requirements. Students discuss facilities they expect to find at a good hotel. They are introduced to the scenario by reading an invitation to tender for a contract to design a luxury hotel. Next, students listen to architects talking about designing part of the hotel and focus on the Key language. Finally, in the Task, students discuss and finalise the facilities for the ground floor of the hotel. • Put students in small groups to do the activity. Get ideas from a few groups. 2 Focus students on the title of the text and check they understand Invitation to Tender (a company invites others to try to win a contract by putting together a proposal, including costs, etc.). • Ensure that students understand the meaning of facilities in this context (rooms/equipment/services provided by the hotel). • Give students one minute to quickly scan the text for the names of facilities. You might tell them that there are four mentioned. Check answers with the class. conference room, meeting rooms, seminar room, restaurant Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from a reading and listening text • learnt phrases for talking about requirements • used this language in a ‘real-life’ situation to discuss and finalise facilities at a luxury hotel • participated in extended speaking practice Timings If short of time, omit Exercise 5c. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 5c. WARM-UP This activity introduces the topic of required facilities at luxury hotels. • Ask students if they often stay/have ever stayed in hotels and if they like them. • Put students in pairs and ask them to describe the best hotel they have stayed at or know of. • Elicit different facilities to the board and include the following: cable/satellite TV in all rooms, swimming pool, restaurant, shops, hairdresser, gym. • In pairs, students rank the facilities on the board from absolutely essential to not important. • Elicit lists from a few pairs, with reasons, and ask the class if they agree and why/why not. SITUATION 1 If you used the Warm-up activity, students can re-use some of the vocabulary here, but they will need to add ideas for the conference centre. • If you didn’t use the Warm-up, ask students if they have stayed at/know of a top hotel and what facilities it had/has. 3a Ask students to read the questions and check that they understand reputation (people’s opinion of you). Tell them that HHCC is the name of the company giving the invitation. • Give students four minutes to read the text and answer the questions. • Students compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. • In feedback, check that students understand the difference between conferences (large meetings to discuss topics of interest, e.g. academic) and congresses (similar to conferences, but to make important decisions on particular issues, e.g. a United Nations Congress). 1 famous for providing luxury accommodation and outstanding service 2 It will be L-shaped. 3 to be used for conferences and congresses by groups from all over the world 4 The contract will be given to the architectural firm which produces the best plan. 3bGive students two minutes to discuss this question in pairs and then elicit ideas from the class. KEY LANGUAGE: talking about requirements 4 With strong classes, put students in pairs to start with and ask them to discuss what they think would make a good ground floor of a hotel. • Focus students on the photos and the floor plan and ask them what the two people in the smaller photo on page 72 are doing (discussing plans). 115 Architecture 0 0 • Read through the introduction and questions with the class and check that they understand health-conscious (when you care about your health). • Tell students that question 1 needs specific suggestions and explain that the architects want to put in a tender to HHCC. • Play the recording without pausing and ask students to compare answers with a partner. • Check answers with the class and check that they understand games room (somewhere to play table tennis, snooker etc.). R: C: 1 a sports facility, an area where people can relax, an aerobics and dance studio, a stand with free newspapers 2 to get ideas from other members of the team G: Audio script 7.3 and answer key to Exercise 5a Carlos, Gabriela, Richard C: G: C: R: C: G: C: G: Let’s talk about our plans for the ground floor. Gabriela, what ideas do you have? Well, I need a little more time to think about it, but seeing that space won’t be a problem, in my opinion, it’s vital we have some sort of sports facility on the ground floor. Also, we’ll need an area where people can relax. How about you, Richard? What do you think? I agree with Gabriel. She’s right. It’s absolutely essential to offer a facility for people who want to forget work for a while, just, you know, chill out, and the ground floor’s the best place to provide it. But I’m not sure what sort of facility it should be. So, Gabriela, any ideas? Mmm, well, people are very health-conscious these days, they do want to relax, they’re often very stressed. So we’ve got to offer them something, that’s for sure. Off the top of my head, I suggest we have a games room on the ground floor – you know, table tennis, snooker, that sort of thing. It’d be very popular with some of our guests. Mmm, I don’t know, Gabriela. We certainly need some kind of area where people can take it easy, let their hair down a bit. But I’m not sure a games room is the answer. I mean, is it really the right choice for a business hotel? OK, maybe not a games room, but we should offer them something to help them relax – maybe a sauna, a jacuzzi, a sun deck. Don’t you agree, Richard? Yeah, a sauna, why not? And, erm, I’ve just thought of something. It might be a good idea to have an aerobics and dance studio. Of course, we’d have to find out first if our guests really wanted that kind of facility. We could also consider having a stand with free newspapers for guests – that’d be popular. Mmm, I like that idea, Richard – aerobics and dancing. It’d probably appeal to all age groups. And it’d be good to offer guests free newspapers. Nice idea. But we need to think this through. There are plenty of options to meet the needs of groups who want to keep fit and others who’ll want to wind down. Let’s talk about it tomorrow and get ideas from the rest of the team. Right, they’ll have plenty of ideas. Let’s see what they come up with. 5a Students read the statements. Check that they understand the difference between essential, desirable and possible. • In pairs, students discuss which phrases they think they have already heard and tick them. • Play the recording again. Individually, students tick the phrases they hear. Check briefly in class. The following phrases are used (and underlined in the audio script): 2, 3, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10 5b Having already listened twice, students should be able to complete quite a lot of information. • Emphasise that students should try and write the additional information as close as possible to the original, but they should not worry if it is not 100 percent accurate. • Students check their sentences individually against the audio script on page 176. Give them time to make any corrections. 5c Give students a couple of minutes to look again at the phrases in Exercise 5a. Encourage them to ask you if they need help pronouncing any words. • Put students in pairs to predict where the main stress will be in each phrase. • Play the recording, pausing after each phrase and ask students where the main stress is. Highlight the intonation of each phrase, if necessary modelling it yourself. • Play the recording again, pausing after each phrase for students to repeat. Correct if necessary. • Students practise in pairs. They correct each other as necessary. Monitor and act as a referee. 116 Architecture 0 0 TASK: deciding on facilities in a hotel 6a Read through the introduction with the class. • Divide students into three groups of equal size. If you do not have the right number of students to form equal groups, make sure A and B are equal and put any extra students into Group C. • Students read their instructions and ask you if they need clarification. • Give students 10–15 minutes to discuss facilities and plans. Give the class regular time checks so that all the groups finish at about the same time. • Monitor to note mistakes using the Key language. • When students have finished, correct a selection of the mistakes you noted earlier. 6b Groups A and B present their plans. Group C should make notes and ask questions at the end of each presentation. • Monitor to note improvements in students’ use of the Key language. 6c When they have finished, ask Group C who should get the contract and why. • Ask the losing group (A or B) what changes they could have made to help them win the contract. • Finally, tell students how their use of the target language improved in this activity. 7.5 STUDY AND WRITING SKILLS IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging Students discuss a question for an opinion-led essay. They work with a text to divide statements into facts and opinions and then analyse language to identify the writer’s opinion. In the writing section, students look at strategies for avoiding repetition in essays. Finally, they write an opinion-led essay. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from a reading text • developed the ability to differentiate between facts and opinions • extended their range of language used to avoid repetition when writing and practised using this • written an opinion-led essay Timings If short of time, set Exercise 10 for homework. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 6. WARM-UP HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the listening, dictation, reading, grammar and Key language exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. From Exercise 6: Group C writes an email to the winning architects saying why they won. The winning group writes an email to HHCC accepting the contract and outlining their proposal again. The losing group writes an email to HHCC saying how they could change their proposal. Students should write their emails individually at home. Remind them about the language in this type of email (formal). Students do exercise KL–4 on page 139 in the Language reference. This activity (re)introduces the topic of facts and opinions. • Read these statements to the class and ask them to identify whether they are facts (F) or opinions (O): 1 Brazil will win the next football world cup. 2 London is the capital of the UK. 3 Water boils at 100 degrees Centigrade. 4 Travelling by train is the best form of travel. 5 Bill Clinton has been president of the USA. 6 Bill Clinton was a good president of the USA. • Ask students to explain their answer in each case. 1O 2F 3F 4O 5F 6O STUDY SKILLS: identifying fact and opinion 1a With books closed, write high-rise apartment block on the board. Ask the class to brainstorm ideas connected to this. Students then open their books and check their predictions against the definition. 117 Architecture 0 0 • Ask students to look at the essay title on page 74. Put them in groups of three or four and give them five minutes to discuss the question. Emphasise that at this stage they should give their own opinion, not read the author’s. • Ask one or two groups to share their ideas. 1b Give students three minutes to quickly skim-read the essay. They should underline key parts which indicate the author’s opinion. • In the same groups, students firstly agree on what the author’s argument is and then discuss whether they agree or disagree with it. 2 Explain that this essay is an example of an opinion-led essay. • Students read the three descriptions and circle a, b or c accordingly. • In the same groups, students compare answers. Take feedback. • Emphasise that students should look at the sentences in their specific context in the essay. • Take class feedback. Students should justify their decisions. Groups look again at the opinions (1, 7, 8) and say whether they agree or disagree with them. 1O 2F 3F 4F 5F 6F 7O 8O 6 Ask students to find and underline the phrases. They need to use the context to understand exactly how they are used. • Check that students understand infer (work out from the context) and intention (a plan in your mind to do something). • This is a slightly tricky exercise, so ensure you discuss the example in class. • Students complete individually, then check in pairs. Take class feedback. c 2 The writer will challenge the claim. 3 The writer believes there is some truth in the statement, but will present an opposing view. 4 The writer will present a much stronger argument than the previous one. 5 The writer will present us with a very persuasive opinion. 6 The writer wants to persuade us their view is right and should not be questioned. 3 Note that students may have already highlighted some of these points from Exercise 1b. • Elicit the meaning of counter-argument (argument which reflects the opposite view to the writer). • Ask students to read the five statements and then read the essay in more detail to find out which paragraph they are in. • In feedback, ask students to identify some of the specific language which illustrates their point. a 2 b 4 c 5 d 1, 5 e 3 4 Fact and opinion. First, elicit definitions of each of the words in the box. You might do this with books closed and write the words on the board. • Following this, students complete the gaps with an appropriate word. Ask them to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. • Finally, get students to close their books. To check their understanding, ask them what a fact is and what an opinion is. Clarify as necessary. A famous British newspaper called The Guardian has the slogan Facts are sacred. Comment is free. Ask students what they think this means and if they agree with the idea behind it. 1 scientific 2 belief 3 subjective 4 emotions 5 proved 6 evaluation 5 In groups of three or four, students look at the questions and discuss whether they are facts or opinions. Allow five minutes for this exercise. WRITING SKILLS: an opinion-led essay This whole section is very relevant to students doing IELTS and PTE-A exams. In the IELTS exam, students may have to write an opinion-led essay in Task 2. Likewise, Write essay is one of the components of the PTE-A Writing test. 7a Avoiding repetition – nouns. Focus students on the examples in the list, to remind them what a pronoun is. • Students work in pairs to come up with as many pronouns as they can. • Take class feedback and write up all correct pronoun suggestions on the board. Put a table on the board which has four columns (Subject, Object, Possessive, Reflexive) and seven rows. Complete the column for subject pronouns (I, you, he, she, it, we, they). Ask students to fill in the rest. 118 Architecture 0 0 S: We’ve got to be careful how we deal with this. We want to support him, but we need to look at the implications of doing it. If we support him too strongly, the press may get hold of the story. They’ll start digging around and perhaps suggest we do this sort of thing all the time, I mean, not informing patients, using them as guinea pigs. H: Yeah, it could be really bad for our reputation. What do you think we should do, then? S: Well, I don’t know. I suppose we could offer the patient some sort of financial compensation and persuade her not to make a fuss. But it’s a risky option. One consequence could be she’ll start negotiating with us. Asking for more cash. We don’t want to get into that scenario, do we? H: No, we certainly don’t. How about if we meet her, say we’re really sorry and explain that the doctor was trying to give her the very best treatment available? We could say it’s a wonderful drug and it’s had great results in 0 clinical trials. The doctor was very busy at the 0 time and he simply forgot to tell her that 3a Individually, students predict the order based on the first listening. Get them to think about how the sentences might connect with each other (e.g. e cannot be first because of the word but). • Play the recording again. Students check/complete their answers and then compare with a partner before you check with the class. c, a, d, e, h, I, g, b, f 3b Put students in pairs. Ask them to read the scenario in the book and elicit/teach dose (amount of medicine to be taken). With weaker groups, brainstorm two or three possible actions so that they have a starting point. • Students discuss what actions are possible. Ask them to come up with a consensus decision. Encourage students to continue practising the language used in previous exercises. • Take class feedback from three or four pairs. TASK: making difficult decisions 4a Divide students in groups of three or four. Together, they decide which of the situations on page 165 they are going to work on. Alternatively, tell students which problem to work on. • Students read their problem and make notes about the content. Emphasise that these should be notes, not word-for-word transcriptions. 4b Allow around four minutes per problem – one minute for the summary and three minutes for discussion. Ensure that students understand the meaning of implication (a conclusion which can be drawn) and that they discuss the implications. • Go through each of the problems and take brief feedback from two or three groups about the action they would take in each case. 4c These evaluation questions are important as they allow students to reflect on the process they have just gone through. Take class feedback on each question. the drug was still being trialled. It might work, but it has a serious disadvantage. H: Oh, what’s that? S: Well, will she believe it’s a wonder drug? It seems she had some bad side effects when she took it. She often felt dizzy and her blood pressure went up. According to her, she didn’t feel at all well. H: Mmm, that could be a big problem for us. It would have a huge impact on our profits if that information was made public. It would also result in other patients coming forward with complaints. S: Yes, it would be very damaging. But let’s face it: all drugs have side effects; she’s just been unlucky. I think we need to go softly with this one. We should talk to her, be very honest. And remind her that she has a wonderful doctor to treat her. I think she’s been with him for some years. H: True, but she’s not very happy with him at the moment. S: It’s understandable, I suppose. S: HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the vocabulary, pronunciation, Key language and academic collocations exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Students do exercise KL– 4 on page 133 in the Language reference. 69 Medicine 0 0 4.5 STUDY AND WRITING SKILLS IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging This lesson focuses on evaluating resources on the internet and writing short reports. Students listen to a lecture on evaluating internet resources and use suggestions they have considered to evaluate three websites themselves. Next, students read and analyse a website report on homeopathy. Finally, they write a report of their own. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from listening and reading texts • extended their range of techniques for evaluating internet resources • learnt (more) about the organisation and language used in report writing • written a short report for a website Timings If short of time, set Exercise 8 or 13 as homework. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 8. WARM-UP This activity introduces the topic of evaluating internet resources. • Give students three minutes to think about their favourite website and make notes on why they like it. • Put students in pairs to compare ideas. • Encourage students to ask each other questions to get as much information as possible. • If any students have chosen the same website, ask them to compare why they like it and see how0 0 many of their reasons are the same. • Finally, ask students if they are interested in 2 In class, ask students to predict some of the ways in which Jeffrey Davies might use the internet. Write these on the board. • Play the recording. In feedback, ask students to identify the three reasons he uses the internet for work. Ask them to say whether these reasons were predicted or not. research, networking, keeping up-to-date Audio script 4.7 My name is Jeffrey Davies and I’m a business consultant. My job is to advise individuals and companies on ways in which they can improve their performance in terms of work processes, team building and better customer and client service. I use the internet all the time – for research, for contact-building and networking and generally for keeping up-to-date with trends and issues in areas of business that are relevant to my work. In terms of research, I read a lot of studies and articles written by academics and researchers on topics that are linked to what I do – workplace efficiency, staff training and development and so on. There is a huge amount of material out there, of course, and the hard part is finding out what I need to learn about and not spending time reading through what I already know. I follow a number of management professionals online – their blogs and articles – and I often look up the reading which they recommend. I also often use an RSS news feed. This lets me know if there are any new and relevant blogs, articles and other publications that’ll be useful to me. As far as networking goes, services like LinkedIn and more specialised professional sites are very useful for making new contacts, letting people know what I do and sharing information with other professionals. In some cases, it leads to new working relationships – working with other STUDY SKILLS: evaluating resources on the internet consultants in order to share our experience and offer an expanded service to potential clients. You can learn a great deal from fellow professionals in this way. 1 Ensure that groups focus on one question (rather than getting stuck) by giving one minute per question. After each minute say, ‘Move on.’ • Take brief class feedback – get two or three comments per question. It’s so important to keep up-to-date with trends and issues in business and the internet offers so much with its truly global reach. The problem, always, is the sheer amount of information and the lack of time to wade through it. So people looking at any of the websites they heard about. 70 Medicine 0 0 who can design really good information selection systems – which filter out key content and let you access it quickly and easily – are going to make a lot of money in future, I’m sure! If you think your class will find this difficult, allow them to refer to an atlas/world map. 3a Students read the sentences and quickly recall any information they can remember. • Students may find it easier to make notes if they draw a five-column table in their books, headed 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, and make notes accordingly. If students find this difficult, play the recording again. You can also prompt with the sample notes. Sample notes: 1 He follows a lot of management professionals online and looks up the reading the recommend. 2 He uses an RSS news feed to learn about new blogs, articles and other publications. 3 He uses LinkedIn and more specialised professional sites. He shares information with other professionals and sometimes works with them. 4 It is difficult to keep up-to-date because there is so much information and he lacks the time to read it all. 5 People will make money by designing good information selection systems. 3b Students work in pairs to discuss each point (1–5) in turn. They should clarify what Jeffrey Davies says in each case, before discussing whether his use is similar or different to their own. • In feedback, ask the class to identify three similarities and three differences between themselves and Davies. 3c Briefly discuss this question with the whole class. 4 With books closed, elicit any techniques students have for evaluating the websites they look at. Try and elicit the term domain suffix and explain. • Students open their books. Give them two minutes to complete the gaps individually. • Take class feedback. 1 .com, .co 2 .org 3 .net 4 .edu, .ac 5 .gov Students can discuss websites they know with these suffixes. 5 Before introducing this activity, ask students to close their books (so no team can get a head start). Paraphrase/Read out the instructions. Then tell students that they can only make one guess per suffix, and that they will get one point per correct answer. • Teams should have no more than four people. .ru Russia .de Germany .tr Turkey .us United States .cz Czech Republic .fr France .ch Switzerland .cn China .dk Denmark .uz Uzbekistan .in India .jp Japan .ar Argentina .br Brazil .ua United Arab Emirates .sg Singapore .th Thailand .vn Vietnam .hu Hungary 6a Ask students to read the sentences and mark them with a tick, cross or question mark according to how useful they think they are. • Students compare their ideas in groups of three and identify the six most useful suggestions. 6b Join the original groups together to make groups of six. Appoint one student as chair in each group to ensure decisions are reached in a timely fashion. • Each group chair reports back to the class. • Discuss the merits of each strategy with the class. When students have decided which suggestions they agree with, ask them to rank them from 1 (= most useful) to 6 (= least useful). 7 Play the recording and get students to note down the six key points made. • In the same groups as in Exercise 6a, students agree upon the six points the lecturer makes. • Check in class that students have correctly identified the six points before the groups compare these answers with their own. 1 Consider who has made the website 2 Find out why the website was created and what its purpose is. 3 Decide whether the website is providing facts or giving the author’s opinion. 4 Check the age of the website – how old it is and if it has been well maintained. 5 Check the information you find and try to locate other sources of the information. 6 See if the website provides links to other relevant information and check that the links work. Audio script 4.8 Remember, anyone can create a website, so there’s a lot of information out there and it’s not easy to know if your source of information is reliable and appropriate for your research. But I can give you some tips to help you. First, consider who has made the website. Is the author a recognised authority on the subject? Can 71 Medicine 0 0 you trust the person behind the website? So, look for clues which point to the credibility of the writer or the organisation who created the website. Secondly, you need to know why the website was created and what its purpose is. For example, if you want to find factual information about a new drug, you’ll want to know if the webpage is produced by the company making the drug or by an independent research group. The information from the independent research group may be more trustworthy. Thirdly, you need to consider whether the website is 0 providing facts or if it is clearly giving the author’s 0 opinion. If it’s providing facts, ask yourself what evidence the author gives to back • Tell students to use the suggestions from Exercises 1, 2 and 3 to help them evaluate the sites and to make notes. • When students have chosen, ask them to compare their findings with two or three others in the class. • Finally, ask the class which websites seem to be the best for researching hypnotherapy. (Note: students can use this information for the second homework option at the end of this lesson.) WRITING SKILLS: a short report 9 Focus students on the report and the photo on page 45 and ask what they think the report is about. Students don’t need to be specific. • Ask them to read the introduction to this activity and check that they understand alternative therapies (alternative medicine and treatments, not common/standard medicine). • Individually, students read the report and answer the questions. Allow a maximum of five minutes. • Students compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. up his or her facts. My next tip is about the age of the website. You’ll want to know how old the website is and if it’s been well maintained. It’s important that the information you obtain is up-to-date. You don’t want to use outof-date information in your research. 1 F 2 F 3 NG My fifth tip concerns the need to check the information you find. Does the writer indicate where their information comes from? Can you check the information from other sources, for example, from an encyclopaedia, an authoritative report or article or from some published statistics? 4T 5 F 6 NG 7F 10 Give students four minutes to read the report and identify each section. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. • To follow up, ask students if they would be interested in trying homeopathy. Finally, see if the website provides links to other relevant information. And if it does, check that all the links work. You may also want to check if the website has a real postal address and telephone number so that you can respond to the author or organisation. d, c, b, e, a 11Critical thinking: Making recommendations. Elicit from students what is meant by an impersonal style (a style which is not subjective, which introduces information in a neutral way). Ask the class to quickly to identify the phrase which introduces the recommendations. You know, evaluating website information is all about critical thinking. You need to be constantly asking yourself questions while you read a webpage so that you can decide if you want to use the information in your research. It is recommended that patients … 8 Write hypnotherapy on the board and ask students to check the meaning in their dictionaries. • Ask students if they know anyone who has tried hypnotherapy, what for and why. • Students read the instructions for this activity. • If you have computers and an internet connection in the school, ask students to use this to find their three websites – or to use their personal electronic device. If not, ask students to use the connection they have at home or in an internet café. 12 Read through the instructions and alternative grammatical structures with the class. • Elicit that the passive uses be + past participle and that if to is used, it is followed by the infinitive. • Elicit which alternative grammatical structures are strong or weak (strong: must + verb, It is vital that; weak: It is advisable to, should/might/could + active/ passive verb, It is a good idea to). 72 Medicine 0 0 • Read through the example with the class and elicit that must understand has been used because the recommendation is strong and must + verb is a strong alternative grammatical structure. • Give students ten minutes to rewrite the other recommendations from the report, making any necessary adjustments to the original sentence. • Monitor to check that students are using a weak/ strong alternative structure to rewrite a weak/ strong recommendation and make sure that the grammatical form is used correctly. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. • In feedback, write the answers on the board so all students can see the structure. Answers depend on the grammatical structure students use to rewrite the recommendations. 13 Read through the instructions with the class and ask them if they have tried herbal remedies (you may already have discussed hypnotherapy in Exercise 8) . • Elicit any facts students know about herbal remedies/hypnotherapy and ask them to read the notes on page 166 to compare their ideas. • Tell students to choose either 1 or 2. • Remind students of the organisation of the report in Exercise 10 and the structures used for weak/ strong recommendations. 0 • Give students 20–30 minutes to write their reports. 0 • Monitor to prompt with ideas and correct grammatical structures if necessary. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the writing skills, reading and listening exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. This is also a good time to do the MyEnglishLab video activities. Students write a short report on two of the websites they looked at in Exercise 8, evaluating how useful these are. 14 When students have finished, ask them to swap reports with a partner and give them five minutes to note any suggestions for improvements (e.g. grammar, vocabulary, organisation). • Students explain the suggestions to their partner before giving the report back for any necessary changes. • When students have finished, take the reports in for marking, paying particular attention to the organisation and use of structures for weak/ strong recommendations. Alternatively, post the reports around the room so that all students can read them and decide which is the most useful, most complete report. 73 Medicine 0 0 5 Transport Unit Objectives Grammar: Vocabulary: Scenario: Study skills: Writing skills: modal verbs and ways of expressing ability, possibility and obligation (future and past) transport; safety features; collocations; words from the text the language of meetings – summarising; evaluating proposals using graphs, charts and tables describing information in a table 5.1 GETTING FROM A TO B LISTENING AND VOCABULARY: transport 1 Focus students on the photo of the plane on page 46 and ask them if, and how often, they fly. • Give students two minutes to discuss in pairs. 2a Give students three minutes to write as many words on the word web as possible. • Draw the word web on the board and elicit ideas. 2bDivide the class into as many groups as the types of transport you identify and get each group to discuss the advantages/disadvantages of that type of transport. • Get one spokesperson from each group to report back to the rest of the class. 3 Set the activity. Remind students to take notes. • Play the recording. Students compare notes with a partner and answer the questions. Take feedback. IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging Students listen to people talking about the different transport they use and learn vocabulary connected with transport. Next, they read an article about road accidents and focus on safety-related vocabulary. Finally, students discuss how to make roads safer before writing a report with recommendations. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from a listening and a reading text • extended their range of vocabulary in the context of transport and road safety • discussed their opinions on road safety • written a set of recommendations for a report on improving road safety 1 air (dislikes) 2 rail (likes) 3 road (mixed feelings – likes and dislikes) 4 sea (likes) Audio script 5.1 Timings 1 If short of time, set Exercise 12 as homework. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 5. WARM-UP • Write the word transport and the following on the board: nairt, cra, alnep, pish, ceylbci, ahcco, ramt. • Tell students that the items are all forms of transport with the letters mixed up. They have two minutes to put the letters in the correct order. train, car, plane, ship, bicycle, coach, tram 0 0 I’m afraid I’ve had a lot of bad experiences and this was more of the same. It’s not that it’s inefficient, it’s just for me; there is too much waiting around. The last time was a nightmare. Admittedly, it did involve a stopover and a missed connection, but even so, it seemed like everything went wrong. I’m just glad I didn’t use one of the budget carriers – it could have been even worse. The weather started it all. A fogbound runway meant nothing was leaving, and it’s true you couldn’t see a thing. When we were finally cleared for departure, it took almost fifteen minutes to walk to the gate! I had priority boarding and I’d booked an aisle seat, so that was OK, but there was a lot of turbulence shortly after take-off, which scared a lot of people. Then the transit lounge was closed due to a security alert and when I finally arrived New Language Leader Upper Intermediate Transport 2 at my destination, guess what. Lost baggage! My luggage had gone to Hong Kong instead of Jakarta! It’s a great way to travel, really. You can work 0 0 easily on board and the fares are reasonable if you can book early enough. I know a lot of 74 docked about twelve hours late and I was glad to get back on dry land. As voyages go, it was one of the worst! 4a Give students five minutes to match the words 3 4 with the correct method of transport. 4bPlay the recording again. Students check their answers and then compare with a partner. They can use a dictionary if necessary. • In feedback, ask students for the meaning of each problem and check pronunciation. • For further practice, ask students to do Exercise V1–4 on page 135 in the Language reference. people complain and for some people it has a bad image. You know, they are always going on about the delays because of signalling problems and engineering work, but I guess I’ve been lucky. Having said that, the last journey I made was almost a disaster as there was a last minute platform alteration, so I had to run like crazy, but luckily, I made it. It seemed to be something to do with the change to the winter timetable and some late running due to the weather. It is supposed to be a high-speed line, but it wasn’t that day, I’m afraid. It hasn’t put me off though. Given the choice, it’s how I like to travel. The main problem is it is very unpredictable as a way to travel – sometimes it’s fantastic, fast and door-to-door, but other times it can be awful, although getting out of the city is better since they introduced the congestion charge. It just depends. Last week I had a terrible journey. There was a long tailback due to a big accident. They talked about it on the news – a multivehicle pile-up, so that really delayed things. Because of the lane closures, it caused a bottleneck, so the traffic was very slow. You know, crawling along – slower than walking – and very stop-start. After about 45 minutes we started to move properly again, but then there was another problem. Someone had a breakdown. It looked like a puncture and was blocking the carriageway, and right near a junction as well! I don’t know – some days nothing goes my way, but as I say, at other times it’s just the best way to travel! It’s not something I have used often, but a few times, and generally, I like it. It can be very relaxing and comfortable. The last time was a bit different though. Well, there had been engine trouble on the previous crossing, so everything was delayed. The captain was very apologetic and we did get an upgrade to a first class cabin. Of course, by this time it was low tide and we had to wait again – delayed sailing, they call it. Once we finally left the harbour, there was more rough weather, because of the time of year. Most of the passengers and crew were ill. It wasn’t pleasant, I can tell you. We fogbound runway: air lane closure: road low tide: sea platform alteration: rail engineering work: rail (but can be used for road as well) lost baggage: air delayed sailing: sea rough weather: sea signalling problems: rail long tailback: road turbulence: air congestion charge: road 5 Elicit the meaning of the criteria. Allow students two minutes to think and make notes. • Students compare their answer in pairs. • Get feedback from two or three students. READING 6 Students discuss the questions in small groups. Take brief class feedback. 7a Set the activity. Check they understand crash (vehicles hitting each other or an object). • Individually, students choose the three causes they think are most important. • Students compare ideas in pairs and agree on the three most important causes. Students’ own answers. Encourage students to give reasons for each answer (e.g. for 1: Younger drivers may cause more crashes because they are inexperienced and are more likely to suffer from peer pressure.). 7b Students have two minutes to read the article. Tell them not to worry about vocabulary at this stage. • Check answers with the class. The writer feels the most important cause is the psychology of drivers. (paragraph 4). 75 Transport 0 0 8 Students read the methods listed and try to remember if any were mentioned in the text. • Then give them five minutes to re-read the article and tick the methods mentioned. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. • In feedback, check that students understand traffic signals (draw on board), speed cameras (cameras that take your picture if you’re driving too fast), anti-lock brakes (when using brakes, the wheel slows down gradually, not suddenly). Do not write these items on the board because this will help students too much in Exercise 10a below. The following methods are mentioned (examples in brackets): 1 (The Locomotive and Highways Act of 1865 introduced the idea of speed limits – paragraph 2) 2 (traffic signals, speed cameras – paragraph 2) 4 (seat belts, traction control, anti-lock brakes, air bags – paragraph 3) 0 0 5 (fines for breaking motoring laws – paragraph 2) 7 (compulsory driver testing • Students can use their dictionaries to check meaning if necessary. • Check answers with the class and (re-)elicit the meaning of each item. • For further practice, ask students to do Exercise V2–6 on page 135 in the Language reference. 1 speed limits 2 one-way streets 3 traffic signals 4 speed cameras 5 seat belts 6 traction control 7 anti-lock brakes 8 airbags 10b Students discuss the questions in pairs. Take brief class feedback on the main points raised. SPEAKING AND WRITING 11a Divide the class into As, Bs and Cs. Ask students to read the information given on the relevant page. • Tell students to summarise the main points in their information and help each other with vocabulary if necessary. 11b Put students in groups of three with an A, a B and a C student in each group. • Give students fifteen minutes to swap their and licensing – paragraph 2) 9 Critical thinking: Analysing arguments. Students think about the questions by themselves before comparing with a partner. • Discuss the answers in class. Ensure students refer specifically to the text to support what they say. This is a particularly useful skill in academic reading, where it is necessary to ‘go under the surface’ to understand what the author is saying. Some of the main points: Travelling by road is dangerous. Fatalities on the road in the UK are decreasing. Many driving controls have been increasingly introduced. Cars have become safer. Drivers feel safer in their cars. It is surprising that the number of crashes is not decreasing. Since drivers feel safer, they drive more aggressively. To make driving safer, cars should be more dangerous. Give students fifteen minutes to swap their information and decide the most effective method. 11c Ask a student in each group to report their decision and the reasons for it. Write the decisions on the board. Do not encourage other groups to disagree or argue at this stage. 11d If you have a very large class, divide students into two groups. • Ask the class to discuss the decisions on the board, decide which recommendations they should make and how strong these should be. 12 Remind students of the structures for writing recommendations in lesson 4.5. • Give students fifteen minutes to write their recommendations. • Monitor to help with ideas and language if asked. • Ask students to compare recommendations with a partner and correct each other’s work if necessary. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the vocabulary exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. VOCABULARY: safety features 10a Students should not look back at the article again. • Give students one minute to complete as many of the safety features as they can remember. • Ask students to compare with a partner and then read the article again to check their answers. Students write a short newspaper article reporting the recommendations they decided on in Exercise 12. Students do Exercises V1–5 and V2–6 on page 135 in the Language reference. 76 Transport 0 0 5.2 TRANSPORT IN THE FUTURE LISTENING 1a Elicit ideas in class about what students think the news report will be about. 1b Play the recording. Afterwards, discuss with the class whether their predictions were correct. Do not discuss or take other feedback at this stage. IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging This lesson looks at how transport might change in the future. Students listen to a news report about space tourism. After that, they read the introduction to an article on changes in transport, then read two more extracts and swap information. Next, students develop their understanding of future modal verbs, focusing on meaning and form. Finally, students predict how transport might change in the future. space tourism: space train and space elevator Audio script 5.2 Space tourism using ordinary rocket ships has been talked about for a number of years. We’ve all heard about Virgin’s plans to send rich people into space. But recently a range of new technologies to help people into space has been suggested. In today’s technology report, we’re going to look at two of them. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from listening and reading texts • extended their range of collocations • revised/learnt how modal verbs of ability, possibility and obligation are used in the future, and practised using these • discussed their predictions on changes to transport in the future The first is the space train or Orbital Maglev. A train carriage would be levitated by magnets and would be contained inside a vacuum tube. The final 20 km of the 1,609 km-long track would point upwards, launching the carriage into space. The space train is the idea of Dr George Maise and Dr James Powell, who is one of the inventors of the superconducting Maglev. It is hoped that this system could significantly reduce the cost of putting space tourists and commercial cargo into space. Timings If short of time, set Exercise 8c or 10 as homework. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 7. WARM-UP This activity gets students talking about different types of energy, an issue that will be very relevant over the next 50 years, especially with regard to transport. • Elicit the names of as many different forms of0 energy as possible and write them on the board (e.g. coal, oil, gas, ethanol, solar, wind, tidal, 0 Let’s move on to another idea to get people into space. Let’s look at the space elevator, which was first talked about over 100 years ago. The idea is to use a cable tied to a base station to send elevators climbing into space at a fraction of the cost of rocket-based launch systems. A thin cable made from light material would stretch from a base station near the Equator to a point 95,560 km hydroelectric). • In pairs, students discuss the advantages and disadvantages of each type of energy. You could do one as an example (e.g. Coal is affordable, abundant and profitable, but it is also finite (= won’t last forever) and causes global warming.). • Take class feedback on the other sources of energy. into space. The Earth’s rotation and a weight on the upper end of the cable would keep the line tight and elevators travelling as fast as trains would be sent up into space. Tokyo-based construction company Obayashi Corporation is hoping to have a space elevator capable of carrying 30 passengers a time working by 2050. 2 Students answer as many of the questions as they can based on their first listening. • Play the recording again. Students then check/ complete their answers. 77 Transport 0 0 • Students check their answers with a partner. Allow dictionaries for words they do not know. • Take feedback, focusing on both content and vocabulary (e.g. conventional, vacuum). 1F 2T 3T 4 NG 5T 6 F 7 NG 3 Put students in pairs for this activity and emphasise they must give reasons for their ideas. • Elicit possible developments and reasons for these from the class and write them on the board. READING 4 Focus students on the picture on pages 48–49. Ask them if they can guess what it might be. • Give students one minute to read the introduction and remind them that their ideas from Exercise 3 are on the board. • Elicit reasons from the class and write them on the board for students to refer to in Exercise 5. • Students compare with their ideas from Exercise 3. • Check that students understand pander to (provide someone with anything they want) and thrillseeking (looking for excitement). 5 Divide the class into As and Bs. Tell them to read their text only. • Remind students that the six reasons are on the board and give them one minute to read the text and answer the question. • Tell students not to worry about vocabulary at this stage. • Elicit answers from the class. 7 Critical skills: Evaluating projects. Here, students practise thinking for themselves, assessing the strengths and weaknesses of the information. • Allow about ten minutes (two minutes per question) for this exercise. Take brief class feedback on each question. VOCABULARY: collocations 1 significant contribution 2 traffic congestion 3 preliminary findings 4 automated system 5 carbon emissions 6 rush hour 7 technological advances 8 distant future 9 significant impact 10 human error A reduce traffic congestion, depend less on fossil fuels B reduce traffic accidents, save on wasted commute time 6a Students may find note-taking easier if they create a table with three columns. They then take notes under the relevant headings. Explain that they will use the notes to tell their partner about their text. If you think your class would benefit, put students who have read the same text in pairs and get them to check their understanding of their text. 0 Text A: 1 a giant bus which runs on wheeled legs that cars can drive underneath 2 China 3 reduces traffic congestion; reduces fuel use; carries 300 passengers; reduces traffic jams Text B: 1 driverless cars 2 USA 3 no drinking; no distractions; better reflexes and awareness of other vehicles; reduces traffic accidents and commute time; reduces human error 8a Explain that all the collocations were given in texts A and B in Exercise 5. • Without looking, students try and remember the collocations and make a note in their books. Do not take feedback at this stage. 8bGive students two minutes to individually check their answers. In feedback, elicit the meaning of each collocation. we will need to depend less on fossil fuels (e.g. oil); society is getting faster; some people want more excitement; need to reduce traffic congestion; need to reduce traffic accidents; need to save on wasted commute time Transport 6bEmphasise that students should be brief (only 30 seconds) and must only look at their notes. • In feedback, ask the half of the class who did not read the text to tell you the key facts. Then do the same for the other half of the class. Get students to repeat their presentation. Task repetition is a way of ensuring improvement. 0 8c Individually, students complete the gaps. Tell them that two collocations will not be used. • Students compare in pairs before you check answers with the class. For weaker classes, tell students to focus on the grammatical clues which are in the text to help them (e.g. question 3: must be a singular countable noun because of a). • For further practice, ask students to do Exercise V3–7 on page 135 in the Language reference. 78 1 preliminary findings 2 carbon emissions 3 significant impact 4 distant future 5 traffic congestion 6 rush hour 7 technological advances 8 human error GRAMMAR: modal verbs: ability, possibility and obligation (future) 9 Elicit the meaning of ability, possibility and obligation. Then ask students to work with a 0 partner and search both texts for examples. When 0 they find them, they should underline them. • Put students in pairs to discuss their sentences and ask each other follow-up questions (e.g. Why do you think that might happen?). • Monitor to note mistakes when using the different form of modals. • In feedback, ask students the most interesting/ surprising thing they heard. • Finally, correct some of the more common or important mistakes you noted earlier. • For further practice, ask students to do Exercise G1–1 on page 135 in the Language reference. SPEAKING • Go through the answers and notes below with the class and elicit the negative forms of each. • Students should refer to the Language reference on page 134 for more support. Ability: will be able to (A), won’t be able to (B) Possibility: could, might, may (A), could, may (B) Obligation: will need to, will have to (A), will have to (B) Be able to and have to are modal in meaning, but not in form, e.g. they have a past form (was able to) and are inflected in the third person (he has to), unlike pure modals, which do not (musted and he mights are wrong). Need can be used as a modal (e.g. he needn’t go) or as a main verb (e.g. he needs to go). 10 Before students do this activity, ask them to read the Language reference on page 134 for information on form. • Give pairs five to ten minutes to find and correct the grammar errors in six of the sentences. • Monitor to point out mistakes, but encourage students to refer to the Language reference and self-correct if necessary. • Check answers with the class. 12 Put students in pairs and give them five minutes to discuss the statements and agree on how to complete them. • Put students in groups of four (i.e. two pairs in each group) and ask them to compare. • Tell students to give reasons for the modal they have used and to disagree with each other if necessary. • Finally, elicit one idea for each statement from the class and ask other students if they agree and why/why not. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the listening, reading, grammar and vocabulary exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Students write a letter to a local newspaper complaining about transport in their city and making suggestions/recommendations for improvements. They can use their ideas from the Warm-up and elsewhere in this lesson. Students do Exercises G1–1 and V3–7 on page 135 in the Language reference. 1 Security will must improve 2 correct 3 We might have to/will have to work 4 we will all have to be able to travel 5 many of us can will be able to travel 6 I’ll be able to I’ll have to drive 7 We will need to find 8 correct 11 Tell students to complete the sentences so that they are true for themselves. • Monitor to help with vocabulary or ask students to use their dictionaries. 79 Transport 0 0 5.3 GREAT RAILWAY JOURNEYS IN THIS LESSON Tell students to look for words with capital letters to help them find the answers more quickly. the Orient Express, the Trans-Siberian Express, the Quinghai–Tibet line 2 Read through the list (1–8) and check that students understand ruler (e.g. a king or queen) and luxurious (very comfortable and expensive). • Give students three minutes to find the items in the list and underline them in the text. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. Go through the notes in brackets in the answer key below. Lesson topic and staging Students read an article about three famous railway journeys and focus on vocabulary from the text. Next, students look at past modal verbs in the text and then study the form and meaning of these. Finally, students use this grammar to describe a journey they made to another student in the class. Meet the expert video 1 China, Russia, Japan, Mongolia, Italy, Austria, Switzerland, France 2 Agatha Christie (a British crime/thriller writer), Graham Greene (a British writer of fiction) 3 Tsar Alexander the Third (he ruled 1881–1909) 4 Lake Baikal 5 the Orient Express 6 the Trans-Siberian Express (9,198 km) 7 the Quinghai–Tibet line (5,072 m above sea level) 8 the Fenghuosha Tunnel (4,905 m above sea level) Watch a video about a travel writer talking about an Indian train journey. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from a reading text • revised/learnt about how modal verbs of ability, possibility and obligation are used in the past and practised using these • talked to another student about a journey they made in the past Timings If short of time, omit Exercise 6. 0 0 3 Give students five to eight minutes to read the text again and note their answers. • Tell students to use their dictionaries to help them answer question 4 if necessary. • Students compare with a partner before you check 9.2 PHOTOGRAPHY IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging Students read an article about photography and discuss whether they think it’s art. They study adverbadjective collocations in the text and practise using these. Next, students focus on gradable/ungradable adjectives and adverbs used with them. Finally, students discuss photos they have taken. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information from a reading text and focused on identifying arguments • extended their knowledge of common adverbadjective collocations • revised/extended their understanding of gradable/ungradable adjectives and the adverbs that collocate with these • described photos they have taken 3 Critical thinking: Identifying arguments. Since the purpose of many texts is to persuade the reader of a particular position and arguments are the way in which you persuade people, it is important to be able to identify these arguments. This skill is needed in many exams (e.g. in IELTS Writing Task 2, where students are often asked to write an agree/disagree essay). If you have students preparing for IELTS, you could set them question 3 of Exercise 4 as an essay question. • Give students two minutes to find and underline the parts of the text that support this idea. • Elicit answers from the class and then give students three minutes to check vocabulary in the parts of the text they have underlined. Students need to understand moving (affecting you emotionally) for Exercise 5. the photographer is creative; the camera can’t decide between an ordinary, functional, regular photo and a really excellent, cleverly composed photo (but the photographer can); it is the photographer who picks out the essential qualities of the subject at a particular moment; photos taken for other purposes, e.g. news photography, can be iconic works of art; [the photo described at the end of the article] is deeply moving (and this is an aspect of art). Timings If short of time, omit Exercise 6 or 10. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 6. WARM-UP This task introduces the topic of appreciating photos. • Bring a set of photos to the lesson (from the internet, projected on an interactive whiteboard or from photos you have at home). • Ask students to look at the photos and decide why they like/dislike them. • Put students in small groups and ask them to tell the others, in turn, why they like/dislike a particular photo. Students must not point at or hold the photo they are talking about. • The other students in the group guess which photo is being talked about and then agree/disagree with the first student’s opinion. 4 • • READING 1 If you did not use the Warm-up, focus students on the photos on page 88 and ask if they like them. • Students discuss the questions in small groups. • Get a few ideas from two or three groups 2 Give students two minutes to read the text. • Ask them to briefly compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. • • If possible, reproduce the text so that the whole class can see it (perhaps on an interactive whiteboard or an overhead projector). As you check answers to this and subsequent exercises, highlight the relevant information and language items in the text. In pairs or small groups, students discuss whether they agree or disagree with the arguments given. Tell students to do questions 1 and 2 first, underlining the relevant parts of the text. Warn students that answers to these questions may overlap. Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers to these two questions with the class. (Note: Because answers to questions 1 and 2 overlap, they are shown together below.) Put students in pairs or small groups to discuss question 3. They must justify their opinion. Elicit some ideas from the class. c 139 Art 0 0 1 /2 More can be captured in a photograph than intended by the photographer (unlike a painting). The photograph has not passed through the brain of the photographer (unlike painting and painters). The painter decides what and how to paint, and how to make it interesting. Photo-taking can be an automatic process. 3 Students’ own answers. VOCABULARY: adverb-adjective collocations 5 Elicit/Tell the class what a collocation is: words that commonly go together e.g. deeply (not heavily) sad). Show that deeply is the adverb in this example. • Give students one minute to find the words and adverbs and underline them in the text. • Elicit answers and explain that these are common collocations, but students may see other adverbs used with these adjectives. • Finally, explain that there are no definite rules for which adverb commonly collocates with an adjective. Therefore, it is important to learn them. entirely unexpected, completely different, completely wrong, deeply moving good – excellent, important – essential, unusual – unique Remind students that synonyms are words which often have a similar (not the same) meaning. To demonstrate this, put them in pairs and get them to discuss how these words differ. Take feedback. 7b Give students two minutes to do this activity individually. Ask them to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. • In feedback, check students’ pronunciation of furious, exhausted, fascinating and tiny. • Read through the information below the box with the class and check that students understand the end of the scale (the coldest it is possible to be). angry – furious, bad – terrible, big – enormous, cold – freezing, hungry – starving, interesting – fascinating, small – tiny, tired – exhausted, upset – devastated 8 Students do this activity individually and then compare with a partner. • Write the table on the board, then elicit answers and write them in the table. 6 First, elicit/tell students that all the adverbs have the same meaning (completely). • Give students three minutes for the activity and tell them to guess the answers if necessary. • Students can use their dictionaries to check the meaning of the adjectives. • Elicit answers to the board so that students can copy the correct collocations. • For further practice, ask students to do exercise V2–6 on page 143 in the Language reference. 1 highly praised 2 highly qualified 3 totally unbelievable 4 painfully shy 5 heavily criticized 6 totally unjustified GRAMMAR: gradable and ungradable adjectives 7a Read the instructions and adjectives with the class and tell students that unusual here means not the usual/normal kind, not strange in a negative way. • Give students 30 seconds to match the adjectives and compare answers with a partner. • Check answers with the class and explain that the adjectives in pairs have similar meanings. Gradable Ungradable unusual good tired hungry cold upset bad big important small interesting unique excellent exhausted starving freezing devastated terrible enormous essential tiny fascinating 9a Give students two minutes to find the examples and underline the correct option. • Read through the Grammar Tip with the class. Warn students that putting an adverb before ungradable adjectives is sometimes unnecessary and can lead to redundant language (e.g. completely destroyed or totally unique). the essential, really excellent, a good, extremely important, absolutely unique, very unusual 1 gradable 2 ungradable 140 Art 0 0 Tell students that absolutely (and other adverbs that go with ungradable adjectives) emphasise the adjective, but cannot change the degree because the adjective is already the most it can be. • For further information, ask students to read G1 in the Language reference on page 142. 9b Students do this exercise individually and then compare answers with a partner. • Check answers with the class. 1 pretty, a little, slightly 2 completely, totally • Finally, ask students to tell you the most interesting (or funniest/strangest) photo they heard about. Many people can access photos on the internet. You could ask students to sit at a computer and show other students the photos or print them out at home and show them in the next lesson. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the reading, vocabulary, listening and grammar exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Students write a description of one of the photos they chose in Exercise 12. In the next lesson, post these round the room and ask students to read them all and decide which photo they think they like best. 10 Students do this exercise individually and then compare answers with a partner. • Check answers with the class. 1 a very really excellent photograph (absolutely here does not sound right) 2 correct 3 I was very absolutely/really devastated 4 were extremely absolutely/really terrible 5 correct Students do exercises G1–1 and V2–6 on page 143 in the Language reference. 11 Tell students to underline the adverb-adjective combinations and then check they are correct. • Put students in pairs to answer the questions and give reasons for their answers. • Elicit answers and reasons from the class. • For further practice, ask students to do Exercise G1– 1 on page 143 in the Language reference. very excellent (Very collocates with gradable adjectives; excellent is ungradable.); very cheap (correct); very enormous (Very collocates with gradable adjectives; enormous is ungradable.); absolutely hungry (Absolutely collocates with ungradable adjectives; hungry is gradable.); extremely fascinating (Extremely collocates with gradable adjectives; fascinating is ungradable.); absolutely interesting (Absolutely collocates with ungradable adjectives; interesting is gradable.); really wonderful (Correct: wonderful is an ungradable adjective.) SPEAKING 12 Give students one minute to reflect on the question and think of a relevant photo. • Put students in small groups to describe the photos and ask each other questions. • Students can ask about the photo itself (e.g. Why do you think the photographer chose that angle?) or about the situation (Where were you when you took it? Was it a nice day?). 141 Art 0 0 9.3 CONTEMPORARY SCULPTORS IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging This lesson looks at different contemporary sculptors. Students read texts on three sculptors, study adjectives in the text and focus on adjective order. Next, students focus on the position of adverbs in a sentence, using the texts as a source before practising themselves. Finally, students discuss whether they think public art is a waste of money. Meet the expert video Watch a video about a contemporary sculptor talking about her work and influences. READING 1 Since sculpture is an area which students may not be familiar with, you may need to guide students in this discussion. To help, you could show them some pictures of famous sculptures. • Students discuss in pairs. Take class feedback. To make Exercises 2 and 3 more communicative, you could put students in groups of three and ask each student to read a different text. After each exercise, they swap the information they found. You should, however, ask students to look at all three texts from Exercise 3 onwards. 2 Focus students on the names at the top of each profile and ask if they’ve heard of these people. • Give students three minutes to read the texts and answer the question. Take class feedback. Anish Kapoor: sculpture and architecture; Antony Gormley: sculpture; Yoko Ono: sculpture, installation art, film, poetry, music Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from reading texts • revised and/or extended their range of vocabulary using the reading text as a source • revised/learnt about the order of adjectives and the positioning of adverbs in sentences • discussed their opinions on public works of art, focusing on the skill of developing arguments 3 Ask students to read the sentences. Tell them that criticism in question 5 means negative comments. • Give students eight minutes for this activity. • Ask them to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. 1 Antony Gormley 2 Yoko Ono 3 Yoko Ono 4 Anish Kapoor 5 Yoko Ono 6 Antony Gormley 7 Anish Kapoor (Note: Yoko Ono often mixes art with poetry and music, but the text does not specifically say she is currently doing this.) Timings If short of time, cut the number of items students do in Exercises 5 and 7, as this is not a complicated language area for students to grasp. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 6. WARM-UP This activity reintroduces some vocabulary related to people in the broader area of art. • Write the following on the board: renaipt, grphrhopotae, clportsu, epto, nstiooract, ftiiafgr rittsa. • Tell students that these are all artists in a broad sense (i.e. not only painters). • In pairs, students rearrange the letters to make words. The first pair to finish wins. painter, photographer, sculptor, poet, cartoonist, graffiti artist Students practise summary writing (a further practice of what they did in lesson 8.5). In groups of three, each student chooses a different sculptor and writes a 50–75-word summary of the sculptor’s background and artistic work. 4 Give students a minute to look at each photo and then put them in pairs to discuss the questions. VOCABULARY: order of adjectives 5a First, ask students to identify the adjectives in each highlighted phrase. • Tell students that some of the words can also be nouns in other contexts (e.g. metal, steel), but they are used as adjectives here. • Tell students that some categories may not have any adjectives in them. • Give students three minutes to put the adjectives in groups, using their dictionaries if necessary. 142 Art 0 0 • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. In feedback, get them to explain the meaning of each adjective. age: none material: steel, metal, clay colour/pattern: brown opinion: none nationality: none size: small, huge, enormous shape: fully-extended other qualities: famous, rich, aristocratic GRAMMAR: position of adverbs 7a Tell students to find all the examples before they add them to the lists. • They can use their dictionaries if necessary. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. 1 in 1972; until 1974 2 in Hampstead, England; to New York 3 creatively; dramatically 4 frequently; often 5 probably; certainly 6 mainly; strongly, primarily 5b Ask students to add the adjectives to the headings in Exercise 5a and check answers with the class. age: antique material: silk, bronze colour/pattern: colourful, dark opinion: beautiful nationality: Japanese size: huge shape: none other: well-known • Move on to the second part of the exercise. Set the activity and give students five minutes to decide on the order by using the examples as reference. • Students compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. • To reinforce the answers, write one of the example sentences on the board and demonstrate the order. 7bStudents work with a partner and look at the examples in the text and answer questions 1–4. • When they have finished, ask them to check by reading G2 in the Language reference on page 142. • Elicit answers and examples from the class. • Finally, read through the Grammar tip with the class and elicit/explain that if the adverbial is at the beginning of a sentence, it is normally followed immediately by a comma. 1 at the end 2 in the middle 3 before the verb (and after the subject), but after the verb be and auxiliaries (e.g. I have often seen that artist.) 4 If the sentence uses been as part of a perfect structure, the adverb comes after the auxiliary have/has/had, but before been. The order is: opinion, size, most other qualities, age, colour/pattern, nationality, material, function/class. 6 • • • • Students sometimes think they will get extra marks in speaking and writing exams if they use more adjectives. Whilst this is an important area, it is worth stressing that nouns with three or more adjectives before them are very rare in English. Put students in pairs so they can discuss answers as they do them, rather than compare at the end. Students can use their dictionaries if necessary. Monitor to point out mistakes with word order and refer students to the table on page 166. Finally, elicit answers to the board so that all students can clearly see the order. Students come up with their own examples. Try to get them to describe three nouns: one with two adjectives, one with three and one with four. Then share and discuss in class. For further practice, ask students to do exercise V3–7 on page 143 in the Language reference. 8 First, ask students to read sentences 1–6 and discuss with a partner how many of these artists and art types they know. • They can use their dictionaries if necessary. • Elicit answers and then refer to the tip below. • Set the activity and give students five minutes to order the adverbs. • Ask students to compare with a partner and refer them to Exercise 7, the Grammar tip and G2 on page 142 in the Language reference if they need help. • Check answers with the class. In feedback, elicit or refer to the notes in brackets in the answer key below for questions 4 and 6. You could suggest that students use the internet to find out more about the artists and types of art in Exercise 8. 1 fabulous, large, bronze 2 large, rectangular, coloured 3 wonderful, antique, Javanese 4 fantastic, shiny, stainless-steel 5 hard, coloured, heat-resistant 6 dreary, modern, urban 7 square, Japanese, origami 143 Art 0 0 1 Rahmi Pehlivanli, the famous Turkish painter, often painted portraits. 2 Many artists have been strongly influenced by Picasso. 3 Leonardo da Vinci sketched technical designs very skilfully. 4 The French post-impressionist Paul Gauguin died alone in Tahiti. (Note: We can’t put in Tahiti at the beginning of this sentence because we don’t want to emphasise the place more than the action died.) 5 Katushika Hokusai is probably the most famous Japanese artist ever. 6 Nowadays, the batik effect is produced by machines rather than being hand made. (Note: nowadays can go at the end of the sentence, but it is usually more natural to use it at the beginning.) SPEAKING 9a Critical thinking: Developing arguments. As students develop their critical thinking skills, it is important that they consider both arguments in favour and counter-arguments. By doing this, they can clearly identify their own position. This is also a useful skill for exams and in everyday life. • In pairs, students identify three supporting and three counter-arguments. If your class finds it difficult to come up with arguments either way, identify an example for each of them (e.g. in favour: Many people do not like them. against: They can bring colour and interest to a dull environment). 9b Mix pairs so that students are working with a new partner. Students share ideas. They should identify what they think of each argument and what their overall position is. Students write an opinion-led essay about the statement in the coursebook. MEET THE EXPERT 1 Students have already discussed some of these issues before, so this exercise should not take too long. Elicit the meaning of jingles (short bits of music played on radio/TV before adverts). • Students take three minutes to discuss the questions in pairs. Take brief class feedback. 2 Students match the words with the meanings using their existing knowledge or language clues, then check answers with a partner. They can use their dictionaries if necessary. • In feedback, check pronunciation. 1 marble 2 sketch 3 maquette 4 clay 5 plasticine 6 carve 3a In pairs, students predict the order in which the stages come. Only allow 90 seconds for this. • Play the video. Students check their predictions. • Elicit answers from the pairs. Confirm the order. b, f, d, a, c, e Meet the expert video Yulia Podolska, sculptor My name is Yulia Podolska and I’m a sculptor. I have a studio at Rye, which is a little town on the south coast of England. I grew up in Ukraine and, uh, I had a plan to, I wanted to be a doctor, a surgeon. So I went, uh, then for holiday we went to St Petersburg with my mum; I went to Hermitage, which is bu-, big beautiful museum, with a beautiful art collection. It inspired me and I was so amazed by beauty of, uh, sculpture. So I decided to be a sculptor. Um, I was offered a place, uh, in academy of fine arts in Kiev – I was one of the youngest, uh, students there, and really good traditional education course. My favourite material is marble because its so beautiful and so translucent and you can carve, uh, such detailed pieces that it’s just amazing. But as well working with bronze, wood, uh, all sort of, like, fabrics, rubber, plastic toys even. I went to Europe and I saw beautiful national collections of, uh, in Italy and in France. Um, I was so inspired by renaissance art and, um, by some modern contemporary collections. Uh, I just want to join to this art world and make my point. I’m getting my ideas, uh, from all sorts of, uh, places – mainly from my emotions and, uh, when I’m, uh, looking at, uh, different political situations at, uh, different social occasions. Uh, for example, uh, I’ve been very upset about political situation in Ukraine and I made the sculpture out of fabric. Um, I based it on traditional Ukrainian dolls. It was, um, solid fabric, um, and just done by sewing it and, uh, adding ribbons. So I transferred it from little dolls, like mothers used to make for their daughters to a big scale sculpture, made out of fabric, and, uh, with ribbons, which, um, the 144 Art 0 0 sculpture’s unravelling. Um, usually I’m thinking and I have this clear image in my head and I start playing with plasticine. Well, sometimes I do a little, uh, pencil sketch. Um, after I would make a maquette, um, I will start making a bigger sculpture out of clay, and then make a cast, uh, from plaster and then I can start working on a big block of marble, I will start carving it and making it exactly like I made it in clay. Um, I love walking and I love travelling as well. So when I’m going to Italy and walking on the river banks, uh, up above in the Cora mountains, I can find a beautiful natural shape of stone, so I’ve been doing that, and, uh, found a few, make a sculpture out of it, got inspired and started to walk on the English river banks and, uh, beaches like in Dorset, um, in south coast of England. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the dictation, reading, vocabulary and grammar exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. They can also do the MyEnglishLab video activities after this point. Students research one of the artists mentioned in this lesson (Ayrton, Pehlivanli, Picasso, da Vinci, Gaugin, Hokusai) on the internet. In the next class, they can make a short presentation about them. Students do Exercises G2–2 and G2–3 and V3–7 on page 143 in the Language reference. My favourite piece is a sculpture called Cardinal. Uh, I love, uh, the natural beauty of the stone. I went to Portugal and I saw it in hills, just laying on earth and straight on I saw a sculpture in it. It has this perfect shape for, for a sculpture. I saw the, uh, where should be head and where I can carve hands. And it would have exactly right position for what I want to say. Currently I’m working on different sculptures made out of different materials. For example, I’m working, uh, on Kinder Surprise toys, uh, sculptures. And, um, making a sculpture straight on from toys, gluing them together and, uh, making this bright, um, funny little sculptures. Um, I was invited to, uh, make a piece for childhood exhibition in Rye Gallery. So I thought about them and a teddy bear, which is, um, such a classical image from childhood. So I made a teddy bear out of, uh, Kinder Surprise toys. 3bGive students two minutes to read the statements and answer any questions they can remember from the first viewing. • Play the video again. Individually, students answer the questions. They then check in pairs. 1b 2a 3c 4c 5a 6b 4 Students discuss the questions in groups of three or four. Allow between five and ten minutes, depending on their level of interest. 145 Art 0 0 9.4 SCENARIO: THE RUSSEL DRAKE GALLERY IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging Students read the scenario about a contemporary art gallery which is having problems. They listen to the gallery owners discussing the problem and then focus on the Key language. Finally, in the Task, students work in small groups to decide on an action plan for the gallery. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from listening and reading texts • learnt useful phrases to discuss implications and offer counter-arguments • participated in extended speaking practice Timings Possible lesson break: after Exercise 5b. WARM-UP This activity revises adjective order from lesson 9.3. • Write on the board: shape, age, size, colour, style. • Put students in pairs and tell them to describe an object in the room where the lesson is taking place. • Stop the activity after a minute and elicit sentences from the pairs. The pair with the most creative/ inventive/ interesting sentence wins. SITUATION 1 Focus students on the photo on page 92 and the reading text at the top of the page. • Give students three minutes to read the text and answer the questions. Students compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. Ask if any students have been to a contemporary gallery of modern art such as this. If they have, how did they find it? If not, would they like to? 1 famous for over 300 galleries of modern art 2 to stand out from the crowd and offer something different 3 8–10 pieces a month 4 It has not met its sales targets. 2a Lead in by asking whether any students have posted a review online about a place of culture which they have visited. If so, was it positive or negative? • Students read the instructions and then, in pairs, decide on the three most serious criticisms. • Emphasise that whilst it is clear some criticisms are more important than others, it is for students to decide themselves. 2bJoin pairs together to make groups of four. • Students should justify their opinions in each case. • Tell the groups of four to agree upon a set of three answers which they are all happy with. To start preparing students for the task, you might discuss their initial thoughts about how they might deal with some of the problems. 3 Elicit what kind of graph this is (a bar chart). • Individually, students read the instructions and decide on their opinion. • Take a class vote on the options. Ask one person who votes for each option to say why they think it is correct. • Guide them towards the answer and feedback in the answer key below. Talking or writing about charts such as this is a requirement in many English exams, such as the PTE Speaking (Describe image) and IELTS Writing (Part 1). Suggested answer: too low (Although there are more ‘very good’ than ‘poor’ responses, lots of ‘average’ responses is not really acceptable. Students could also make a case for it being ‘acceptable’.) KEY LANGUAGE: discussing implications, offering counterarguments 4 Check that students understand the meaning of commission (a percentage of money which is paid for a service). • Students read the instructions. Ensure they understand the scenario. Paraphrase if necessary. • Students read the statements. Quickly check to make sure there is no unknown vocabulary. • Play the recording. Students tick the arguments they hear. They then check with a partner. • Confirm answers with the whole class. 1, 2, 5, 6 146 Art 0 0 Audio script 9.2 Russell, Dennis, Vanessa R: D: V: D: V: D: R: D: R: D: One of the things we’re considering, Dennis, is to lower our commission. At the moment, we charge 50 percent – that’s confidential, by the way. But if we lowered the commission, we’d attract quite a few younger artists and that could be helpful for us. Maybe, but consider the implications. At the moment, your artists are paying 50 percent and not complaining – they’re accepting your terms of sale. If you lower your commission, other galleries might start doing the same thing; then you’ll be in a price war. How do you feel about lowering commissions, Vanessa? Well, I think there’s a strong argument for doing it. We do need to have more young artists on our books – I’ve said it for some time. It’d be a way of attracting them. It’d be quick and very effective. But think of the consequences, Vanessa. It’ll affect your profits if you lower your commission rate. Also, you need to take into account the reactions of the other gallery owners. They won’t be pleased if they hear you’re price-cutting. They’ll start doing the same thing and that won’t be in anyone’s interests. That may be true, but our situation’s getting pretty desperate. We’ve got to do something if we want to survive. Well, the effect of a lower commission rate will be harmful to your business, in my opinion. I’ve had a few thoughts about this, Dennis. You say that it’ll affect our profits. But it wouldn’t if we charged variable commission rates – I mean, charge different rates to different artists. Keep the rates we’ve got for artists who are popular with collectors and people who pay top prices, but give up-andcoming artists a lower rate. How about that? The problem with that is that it could really upset your best customers – the cash cows, if I can put it like that, who are keeping your gallery afloat. Mmm, I don’t know, maybe you’re right. OK, well then, what are we going to do if we don’t lower our commission? You’ve got a lot of options, believe me. There are plenty of things you could do that’ll get more people coming to your gallery and improve your bottom line. You can’t do all of them. Some, I’m sure, you’ll reject immediately. You’ll have to make up your minds and choose the best ones. Some will be expensive, others won’t cost too much. I’ve jotted down some ideas for you. Let’s talk about them. I hope you’ll feel some are worth considering. 5a Allow students two minutes to read the phrases. They should reflect back on the listening and see if they can remember where the phrases came. • Play the recording again. You may need to pause to allow students to catch up. Students number the statements in the order they hear them. • In feedback, play the recording once again. Stop after each statement has been said. Students correct themselves. (The phrases are in bold in the audio script above.) f, h, b, g, a, l, d, i, j, c, k, e 5b Discuss with the class what is meant by implication (a prediction of what will happen) and counter-argument (argument on the other side). • Students discuss the statements in pairs. They should focus on the Key language. • Take class feedback. Implications: a, f, h Counter-arguments: b, c, d, e, g, i, j, k, l TASK: deciding on an action plan 6 Give students 30 seconds to individually write a definition of action plan (a list of things which an organisation is going to do in order to solve problems). Then check understanding. • Ask students to read the instructions and set the activity. • Put students in groups of three or four. Since there are multiple stages for this exercise, ensure that the groups give an appropriate amount of time to each by telling them to move on when necessary. • Stage 1: Students have two minutes to individually read the list of ideas. They should tick or cross the ten ideas. In their group, they have a further three minutes to agree upon the best five. 147 Art 0 0 • Stage 2: Students take five minutes to identify the costs for each of their ideas. Monitor and help as necessary. Some groups may find this difficult and need more help. • Stage 3: Give groups a further five minutes to come up with ideas for other fundraising initiatives. Try to get them to think of three good ideas. • Stage 4: Before students discuss their action plan, brainstorm some of the things they will need to include in it (e.g. timelines, list of people involved, the order in which things happen). Groups then have 10–15 minutes to work out their action plan. 7 The best way to do this exercise is to get each group to present their action plan to the rest of the class. The ‘audience’ then ask questions. Set a time limit of two or three minutes per group. 8 The vote could be done as a ‘secret ballot’ so that people can really say what they think. When you have collected in all the votes, you tell the class who the winner is. After announcing the decision, ask the class to identify the strong points of the winning action plan. HOMEWORK OPTIONS 9.5 STUDY AND WRITING SKILLS IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging This lesson focuses on expanding students’ vocabulary and writing an online review. Students read a short text about expressing yourself well and look at alternatives for nice and other basic adjectives. In the writing section, students listen to an expert talking about travel blogs. Finally, students write their own travel blog for a place they have enjoyed visiting. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from a listening and two reading texts. • learnt about extending their range of vocabulary and practised this with different basic adjectives • written a travel blog Timings Students do the listening and Key language exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. If short of time, set Exercise 10 as homework. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 5. Students do Exercise KL–4 on page 143 in the Language reference. WARM-UP This activity introduces the topic of travelling. • Students should think of a place (in their own country or abroad) which they have enjoyed visiting. They should make brief notes about it. • In pairs, students make a brief (one-minute) presentation about the place. • Students can ask follow-up questions if desired. STUDY SKILLS: expanding your vocabulary 1 Ask students if they overuse any particular adjective and elicit good/nice and other examples. • Read the instructions with the class and give students five minutes to decide the meaning of nice in the different phrases. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you elicit answers from the class. • Finally, tell students that phrases 1, 2 and 5 are fixed expressions and not normally used with adjectives other than nice. 148 Art 0 0 Possible answers: 1 enjoyable, productive 2 pleasant, enjoyable 3 friendly, charming, I like her 4 fashionable, it suits you 5 refreshing, to make us feel better 6 friendly neighbours, pleasant environment 2 Give students one minute to read the text and then elicit if it is true of their language. • Focus on the fact that precision is more important in writing than in speaking. 3 Set the activity and tell students that they can use their dictionaries if necessary. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. • In feedback, check students’ pronunciation of difficult words (e.g. picturesque, stylish). 1 beautiful, picturesque 2 delicious, tasty 3 relaxing, restful 4 stylish, trendy 5 charming, friendly 6 productive, useful 4 • • • • A problem in many academic essays is that students repeat the same words again and again. Learning how to use synonyms correctly will help with this, and also help students to paraphrase. Give students eight minutes for this activity. Tell them to use their dictionaries if necessary. Elicit the meaning of precise (exact, specific). Warn them that some adjectives are more difficult to put in the lists than students will initially think. Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. Check students’ pronunciation of difficult words (e.g. monotonous, appalling). Ask students to read the paragraph. Check they understand the difference between a dictionary and a thesaurus (bring in copies of each). 1 brilliant, outstanding, terrific 2 appalling, awful, dreadful 3 absorbing, compelling, gripping 4 heartbreaking, moving, touching 5 monotonous, repetitive, tedious 6 amusing, hilarious, witty 7 exhilarating, nailbiting, thrilling 8 absurd, laughable, ridiculous Put students in pairs and give each pair one or two sets of these words. They then write four sentences showing the exact meaning of the words. 5 Collocations. This activity practises students’ ability to match adjectives with nouns. • Put students in pairs or small groups so they can brainstorm the collocations. • Go through answers and the notes in brackets below with the class. • Finally, emphasise that the adjectives here all have the same basic idea and it is the collocations that show the use of each. 1 absorbing, gripping, compelling (A book can be fascinating if factually based.) 2 fascinating 3 gripping, compelling, absorbing (A film can be fascinating if factually based.) WRITING SKILLS: an online review 6 Ask students if they have ever booked a holiday by themselves and if so, how they did it. Also elicit travel blog (a piece of informal online writing about travel) and guidebook (a travel book which provides more information about a place). • Individually, students read the statements. They should try and identify at least one advantage and disadvantage of each. Allow five minutes for this. • In pairs, students compare their answers. They should add relevant information to their own list. • Take brief class feedback. • In the same pairs, students discuss the second question. Explain that they do not have to choose just one option. Take brief class feedback. 7 Students read the introduction and questions. • Play the recording. Students note down answers. • In the same pairs as Exercise 6, they compare their answers. Take brief class feedback. 1 To create a social environment. Friends and family can follow you during the trip. You can keep in touch with a bigger group of people. You save money. You can tell your friends how the trip is going. People will know that you are safe. A blog is a permanent record of your journey. A blog provides good writing practice. Audio script 9.5 If you go on a fairly long holiday, maybe to a faraway destination, I think it’s a really good idea to write a travel blog. You see, one advantage of doing it is you can create a social environment with your blog. What do I mean by that? Well, you’ll create a group of people who are interested in what you’re doing. Your family and your friends can read your diary entries and respond to them, so they become part of your holiday. With your blog, you can keep in touch with a much 149 Art 0 0 bigger group of people – you won’t need to buy dozens of postcards to let them know what you’re doing. So you’ll save money – that’s always a good thing, I’m sure you’ll agree. Blogs are a great way of telling your family and friends about your holiday and how it’s going – you know, the interesting places you’re visiting, the people you’re meeting. And everyone who’s following you will know you’re safe because they’re constantly reading your messages. They’ll also be able to look at your photos and videos. Oh, one other advantage I want to mention: your travel blog is a permanent record of your trip – something you can look at again when you’re back home. So, I’m encouraging you all to write a travel blog. It’s good practice for improving your writing and you can tell everyone about the amazing experiences you’re having and maybe even about things that have gone wrong, especially if they’re funny and not too serious. 8 Introduce the exercise by asking students whether they know anything about the places mentioned. • Give students five minutes to read the blog and answer the questions. With weaker groups, elicit definitions of tourist sites (places people like to visit on holiday) and general impression (overall feeling). • Students compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. Ask if anyone knows anything else about Chagall or Matisse. You might even show students an example of both artists and discuss in more detail. 1 the market area, Cours Saleya; the Chagall and Matisse museums 2 They enjoyed the visit, were impressed with the food and Brazilian street performers in the market area. Their impressions of the Chagall and Matisse museums: It was exhausting to get to the two sites, but they were both ‘outstanding’ and ‘brilliant’. The Chagall museum had lovely gardens and a peaceful café. The Matisse museum was in a beautiful park and had a fantastic view of the city. In both museums the paintings were colourful and full of light. 3 In common: They lived in Nice at the same time and were both inspired by the light and colours of the area. Different: Chagall was born in Russia, whereas Matisse was born in Northern France. They had totally different styles of painting. 9 Give students one minute to look through the adjectives which are highlighted in bold and to think of any synonyms. They should not write anything down at this stage. • Put students in small groups. At first, they should share the words they have already thought of. When they cannot think of any more, they can use a dictionary. Give one student in each group the responsibility to write down the synonyms. Students write sentences that show the slight differences in meaning between each of these words. Each group could be given one word and its synonyms. In feedback, you should be the judge about the acceptability of synonyms. Suggested answers: trendy: popular, fashionable nice: delicious, excellent, superb, outstanding charming: friendly, attractive great: interesting, wonderful, fascinating exhilarating: exciting, thrilling funny: amusing, hilarious thrilling: exhilarating, exciting, nailbiting dreadful: awful, terrible outstanding: exceptional, impressive, magnificent peaceful: quiet, relaxing fantastic: wonderful, marvellous, outstanding brilliant: outstanding, superb terrific: brilliant, amazing, fantastic 10 Before students begin writing, get them to make brief notes about their trip. Check that they know a sufficient amount about the country/trip they are going to describe, otherwise their blog will be inadequate. You could direct them back to the Warm-up activity, if you did it. Students may benefit from telling a partner about their location before they start writing. Talking about it can help them clarify ideas and even come up with new ones. • Students will need a minimum of 30 minutes to write their blog. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the study skills and academic collocations exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. This is also a good time to do the MyEnglishLab video activities. Students do Exercise 10. 150 Art 0 0 10 Psychology Unit Objectives Grammar: Vocabulary: Scenario: Study skills: Writing skills: relative clauses; reduced relative clauses personality adjectives; phrasal verbs; word formation; idioms with mind; words from the text giving and reacting to advice; taking part in an advice phone-in writing a bibliography; referencing an advantages and disadvantages essay 10.1 GROUP PSYCHOLOGY READING AND VOCABULARY: personality adjectives IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging This lesson looks at how well groups work together. Students discuss teams they’ve been in and then focus on adjectives to describe people before practising the pronunciation of these. Students then read a webpage about how teams function and listen to a lecture about group dynamics. Next, students focus on vocabulary from the listening and finally discuss who in the class would take different roles in a team. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from a reading and a listening text • extended their range of vocabulary related to describing people’s personalities and working together • participated in an extended speaking activity Timings If short of time, omit Exercise 10b. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 6 or 9. WARM-UP This activity introduces the idea of describing people’s personalities (and appearance). 1 Focus students on the title of this lesson (Group psychology) and elicit that this is about how people in groups relate to one another. • Give students a few minutes to think of their answers to questions 1–4 before putting them in groups of three or four for the discussion. • Tell them question 3 means Did the people work/play well together or were there problems? • Get a few ideas from the class and take this opportunity to elicit/give group dynamics. 2 Ask students to read the adjectives and tick any they used. • Set the second question and tell students that they can use their dictionaries if necessary. • Ask students to compare ideas with a partner before you elicit a few ideas from the class. In feedback, ask students to give a brief definition of each word. 3 Do the first example with the class (ambition – ambitious) to demonstrate what the rubric means by nouns related to these adjectives. • Give students ten minutes to find the nouns and write adjective – noun pairs. • If you are short of time, put students in pairs and ask them to do half the words each. • When they have finished, ask them to compare their answers with a partner (or another pair). • Elicit answers from the class and write them on the board for use in Exercise 4. • Write the names of four famous people on the board who your students will know. • Students think of three adjectives to describe one of the people. They must use at least two personality adjectives and can use their dictionaries. • Students work in small groups and take it in turns to say their three adjectives. The other students must guess who they are describing. ambitious – ambition, authoritative – authority, conscientious – conscientiousness, creative – creativity, diplomatic – diplomacy, energetic – energy, knowledgeable – knowledge, objective – objectivity, practical – practicality, resourceful – resourcefulness Students could look up other nouns associated with these adjectives (e.g. authorities, conscience, creation, diplomat, practicalities). 151 New Language Leader Upper Intermediate Psychology 0 0 PRONUNCIATION 4 Critical thinking: Stress patterns. Give students a few minutes to write down all the words from Exercise 3 and to mark where they think the stress is. • Ask students to compare with a partner. • Students may not know if the stress pattern changes if it is marked incorrectly. This won’t happen until they have listened and checked their answers. It may be better to tell students to answer the question after they have listened to check. • Set the question about changing stress patterns and, if possible, elicit a few answers from the class. • Play the recording, pausing after each pair of words to allow students to check their answers. • Go through answers with the class, marking the correct stress on the board and eliciting/showing students where the stress pattern changes. • Play the recording again. Pause after each pair of words for students to repeat. Correct if necessary. See Exercise 3 (above) for stress. READING 5a Focus students on the title of the introductory paragraph in the text (Belbin model) and ask them if they have heard of this. • Students work individually to read the table and answer the questions in Exercise 5. • Emphasise that students should be honest in their appraisal. • Monitor and clarify vocabulary items as necessary. Quite a lot of the language used may be unknown. 5bNote: Only put students in pairs to say if they agree with their partner’s choices if your students know each other fairly well. Students may not be happy if their partner does not agree. • Ask the class if anyone would like to explain their choices to the whole group. Make this an open activity and do not force anyone to speak. Since students may have to work in groups at university in many different situations (e.g. projects, seminars), it is important to think about the best ways that groups can function. 6 Give students five minutes to match the adjectives. • Ask them to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. plant = creative (comes up with ideas); resource investigator = resourceful (developing contacts, finding opportunities); coordinator = authoritative (leading teams, delegating); shaper = energetic (dynamic); monitorevaluator = objective (fair, has good judgement); teamworker = diplomatic (peacemaker and mediator); implementer = practical (makes things happen); completer-finisher = conscientious (perfectionist, strong sense of duty); specialist = knowledgeable (special skills and expertise). The extra adjective is ambitious. LISTENING 7a Set the context and give students a few minutes to order the stages. • Ask them to compare with a partner. • Answers are checked in Exercise 7b. 7b Give students two minutes to match the names with the stages, but tell them not to worry if they are unsure. • Play the recording without pausing. Ask students to compare answers in pairs. • Check answers with the class. • Ask students if they experienced any/all of these stages in the teams they discussed in Exercise 1. 1 forming – b 2 storming – c 3 norming – a 4 performing – e 5 adjourning – d Audio script 10.2 Good morning, everyone. Our topic today is group dynamics. I want to talk about how groups develop over a period of time. So I’ll describe the stages that groups often go through. Erm, first of all, I’d like to mention an academic who did some interesting early work on groups. His name’s Kurt Lewin, you spell Kurt K-U-R-T, by the way. Lewin was one of the first researchers to study groups scientifically, so he’s important. He published his results during the 1940s and 1950s. And he created the term ‘group dynamics’ to describe how groups and individuals act and react in changing situations. OK, the next really important contribution came from a researcher, Bruce Tuckman. Tuckman developed a theory about groups in 1965. He argued that groups went through four stages. Now I’d like to look briefly at each of the stages in turn. 152 Psychology 0 0 First, ‘forming’. This is the stage when the group pretends to get on well with each other and everyone seems to be happy. It’s a kind of honeymoon period. Next is the ‘storming’ stage. As the name suggests, at this stage, members of the group are less polite to each other and they try to resolve their issues, even if they lose their tempers at times. Individual group members may fall out with each other as the true personalities of group members become clearer at this time. ‘Norming’ is the stage after that. Members get used to each other at this stage. They begin to trust each other, share information and are much more productive as they get down to the job of working together. often the most interesting part of these sorts of programme, and why people watch them. So Tuckman’s model is a good one, and it’s useful for analysing group dynamics. Now are there any questions so far? 8 Ask students to read the questions and try to answer them from memory. • Then play the recording again and ask students to compare answers in pairs. Go through answers and the notes in brackets below with the class. One of the skills tested in the PTE-A Speaking component is the ability to re-tell lectures. Here, you could ask students to give a ten-second summary of the key points of the lecture. 1 a 1940s, 1950s b 1960s 2 the period when everyone likes everyone else at the beginning of something (A honeymoon is literally the holiday a married couple take immediately after their wedding, i.e. when they are completely happy and in love.) 3 pop groups, football teams, reality TV shows The final stage is ‘performing’. The members of the group have common goals. The atmosphere in the group is good. They work efficiently together and cooperate effectively with each other. These are the four stages in Tuckman’s original theory about how groups develop. I should say that later on he added a fifth stage. He called it ‘adjourning’. That’s the stage when the group breaks up. Of course, some groups never even reach the ‘norming’ stage. If they don’t trust each other, and members find they cannot put up with each other, the group may break up early, before the ‘norming’ stage. Tuckman’s theory is useful and of practical value. Think for a moment about pop groups or bands you know. A classic example for me, although not from my generation is The Beatles, for example. They went through all five stages. During the ‘performing’ stage, they were very effective, and wrote and performed some of their best songs, but eventually, John Lennon moved away from the group and after Paul McCartney left, the band began to break up. You can also think of successful football teams which go through those stages. After early struggles, they have a period of success, with a core of the same team members, although a few individuals will leave and join. This stable team may do well and win championships and trophies. Then the team breaks up – for whatever reason – perhaps due to the age or the ambition of the players. Finally, a very contemporary example would be in reality TV, where the way the group works together is 9 Critical thinking: Evaluating ideas. Students gain further practice of reflecting on what they have learnt in the lesson and discussing their opinions of what they have learnt. • Students discuss the questions in groups of three or four. Take two or three pieces of feedback for each question. VOCABULARY: phrasal verbs 10aElicit the meaning of phrasal verb (a verb which is composed of a main verb and preposition). • Students do this activity individually and use their dictionaries if necessary. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. 1f 2e 3c 4a 5d 6b 10b Check that students know the form (get used to + -ing/noun) for question 2. • Students do this activity individually and then compare answers with a partner. • Get students to ask follow-up questions to get as much information as possible for each sentence. • Elicit answers from a few students and ask them for further information if possible. • For further practice, ask students to do Exercise V1–6 on page 145 in the Language reference. 153 Psychology 0 0 10.2 PEER PRESSURE SPEAKING 11a When creating groups for this exercise, try to make groups where you think students will work well, but where the personalities might represent different roles in the Belbin model. • Ensure that students read the introduction and points 1–3, and that they understand what they have to do. Clarify as necessary. • Give groups three minutes to discuss task 1. • For task 2, students should think back to Exercise 5a, where they discussed this question. This task would probably work best if the group has a good chair (e.g. someone who is a ‘coordinator’), to ensure that everyone participates. • Students discuss task 3 and identify who will do which of the tasks. Emphasise that each student should have roughly the same amount of work. • Groups will probably need at least 20 minutes to come up with their plans. It is for the groups to decide how best to manage this process. • Emphasise that by the end of the time limit, they need to have a finalised action plan to share with another group. 11a When joining groups together, try and ensure that they complement each other (i.e. that they have as many of the nine roles as possible). • Take feedback from four groups on the strengths/ weaknesses of their partner group’s plan. + Ask students to evaluate how effective their discussions in 11a were. What went well? What could have been improved? What was missing? HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the vocabulary exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Students do Exercise V1–6 on page 145 in the Language reference. IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging This lesson looks at peer pressure and how it affects people. Students read a webpage about peer pressure and teenage bullying. They study idioms with the word mind and practise using these. Next, students look at relative clauses taken from the text, focus on their use and practise using them. Finally, students take part in discussions related to peer pressure. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from a reading text • extended their range of idioms using mind • revised/extended their knowledge of relative clauses • participated in an extended speaking activity Timings If short of time, set Exercises 7a and 7b as homework. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 7b. WARM-UP This activity introduces the topic of whether we do things because we want to or because other people want us to. • Ask students if they always do what they want to or if they sometimes do what others want. • Give students three minutes to think of two things they regularly do because they want to and two things they do because other people want them to. • Students compare their answers in pairs. • Finally, ask who chose similar activities and elicit why we do things because others want us to. READING AND VOCABULARY: word formation 1 Focus students on the title of this lesson (Peer pressure). Elicit that peers are people around your age in the same social group and peer pressure is the influence that others have on your actions and opinions. • Discuss the question in class. Write up a few examples that the students provide (e.g. wearing fashionable clothes, joining in with bullying, doing something dangerous). 154 Psychology 0 0 2 Focus students on the URL and phone numbers and elicit who it is for (parents and children). • Students underline the questions on the webpage. Give them one minute to read the text, but tell them not to underline answers or take notes. • Put students in pairs to discuss answers to the four questions. Tell them not to read the text in detail. • Elicit possible answers from the class, but do not insist on complete accuracy at this stage. 1 doing/thinking something that others want you to do/think because you want to be accepted 2 how they dress/talk, music they listen to, attitudes they adopt (their opinions), how they behave 3 yes, definitely 4 They need to know who their children are socialising with and encourage them not to enter situations where they will be pressurised. 3 Students read the instructions. Check that they are clear about what they need to do. • Students read comments a–d. They then skim-read paragraphs 1–4 and match them together. • Students check in pairs and agree on the answers. • Take feedback. Check that students understand self-esteem (the level of confidence you feel about your own abilities), conform/conformity (behaving the same as the majority of people) and going against the grain (not conforming). a4 b3 c2 d1 4a Set a time limit of one minute for students to find these nouns. In feedback, ensure the word stress is correct (underlined in the answer key below). 5 Critical thinking: Evaluating effectiveness. In this exercise students reflect on the webpage and decide whether its contents match its goals (i.e. Is it successful in achieving what it wants to achieve?) • Students discuss with a partner for three minutes. • Take class feedback. If students disagree with a point which has been made, encourage them to challenge it, in order to develop critical thinking. 6 Take a brief definition of each type of bullying. • Students discuss the question in small groups. • Take class feedback. Since all these forms of bullying are bad, there is no ‘right’ answer, but take time to explore each of the three types. VOCABULARY: idioms with mind 7a If necessary, elicit what an idiom is (an expression where the meaning is not completely clear from the individual words). • First, give students 30 seconds to write a definition of mind. Take feedback. Guide students towards a definition: a person’s ability to think and reason. • Give students three minutes to do this activity and compare answers with a partner. • Check answers with the class and tell them that out of your mind can also mean extremely worried. 1b 2d 3c 7b Tell students they will need to change the form of some idioms when they put them in the gaps. • Give students three minutes to do this activity and compare answers with a partner. Check in class. • For further practice, ask students to do Exercise V4–8 on page 145 in the Language reference. 1 make up my mind (about something) 2 peace of mind 3 keep an open mind 4 out of your mind (with worry/fear) 5 in two minds (about something) approval, behaviour, conformity, suggestion 4b Elicit the four suffixes used (-al, -our, -ity, -ion) and write them on the board. Explain that these are often used to make nouns from verbs. • Individually, students predict what the nouns may be and then check in pairs. If they are unsure, allow them to use a dictionary. Check answers with the class. To help students, tell them how many of each type there are (3 x -ity, 2 x -ion; 2 x -al; 1 x -our). association, continuity, definition, disability, proposal, refusal, saviour, security 4e 5a GRAMMAR: relative clauses 8 Remind students that a relative clause adds more information to a sentence. Elicit an example (e.g. He’s the man that I spoke to yesterday.). • Do not elicit/give any further information about relative clauses at this stage. • Students underline the clauses in the text. Ask them to compare with a partner. • Elicit answers from the class. Note the relative pronoun that in part 2 is not actually written. 155 Psychology 0 0 Part 1: when we are influenced to do something; who are about the same age; with whom they socialise; which is the most common form of social influence Part 2: which means peer pressure can be powerful and hard to resist; who are low on confidence and unsure of themselves; (that) they would not normally do; who knew the correct answer to a question Part 3: which means others are less likely to call the behaviour bullying; when their children are being bullied Part 4: with whom their children are associating; in which they know they would be pressurised 11 Set the task. Focus students on the example (1 f). • Tell them some relative clauses may come in the middle of sentences 1–9. Monitor for mistakes, but encourage students to look at Exercises 8–10 and the Language reference to help them self-correct. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. 1 f We are seeking a counsellor to whom we can refer special cases. 2 e Even the bullies were crying, which was surprising. 3 i Kurt Lewin, who many see as the father of social psychology, fled to the USA from Germany. 4 h Teenagers like to turn for advice to other young people who they sympathise with. 5 d People who are easily influenced will follow someone else’s lead first. 6 c The type of peer pressure that leaves you feeling confused or hurt is never good. 7 g Peers are the individuals with whom a child or an adolescent identifies most. 8 b We took all the teenagers to the seaside, which made a good break for them. 9 a The bullying problem(,) about which we had a lot of discussion(,) has now been resolved. (Note: this could be defining or non-defining.) 9a Ask students to underline the correct word in definitions 1 and 2. (This should be revision.) • Ask them to identify which clauses from Exercise 8 are defining/non-defining. • Finally, check answers with the class, but do not elicit further information about these clauses at this stage. 1 non-defining 2 defining All clauses are defining relative clauses, except which means peer pressure can be powerful … and which means others are less likely … . 9bEmphasise that students do not need to use all the words in the box. • Give students five minutes to complete the rules, referring to the examples in the text for help. • Students compare with a partner and if necessary look at G1 on page 144 in the Language reference. • Check answers with the class. Refer to the webpage for examples. • Read through the Grammar tip with the class. 1 non-defining 2 whom 3 which 4 before 5 that 10a Give students one minute to think about the question. Elicit the answer from the class. If possible, produce the complete sentences so that all students can clearly see where the relative clause is inserted and the punctuation. 12a The focus of this exercise is to get information which will be used in Exercise 12b. Students have two minutes each to ask and answer questions. 12b Encourage students to use both defining and non-defining clauses if possible. They should also try and use a range of relative pronouns. • Three or four students read out their profiles. Other students say whether the sentences are correct. • For further practice, ask students to do Exercises G1–1, G1–2 and G1–3 on page 145 in the Language reference. SPEAKING 2 13 Students discuss the questions in small groups. If your class is made up of teenagers, question 4 may be redundant. Take feedback. 10b Give students one minute to find the example and then briefly compare with a partner. • In feedback, remind students that this kind of relative clause is non-defining. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the vocabulary, reading and grammar exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. … which means others are less like to call the behaviour bullying. Students do exercises G1–1, G1–2, G1–3, V2,3–7 and V4–8 on page 145 in the Language reference. 156 Psychology 0 0 10.3 PSYCHOLOGY AT WORK READING IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging This lesson looks at the psychological profiling of criminals. Students read about criminal profiling before focusing on vocabulary related to this topic. Next, students look at the use of reduced relative clauses in the text and practise using them. They discuss a book/film they have read/seen about profiling or serial killers. Finally, students write a summary of the text on psychological profiling they read earlier. Meet the expert video Watch a video of Dr. Jack Lewis, a neuroscientist, talking about working in this field. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from reading texts • revised and/or extended their range of vocabulary related to criminal profiling • revised/learnt about reduced relative clauses and practised using these • discussed a book or film about profiling or serial killers • written a summary of a text about criminal profiling Timings If short of time, set Exercise 9 or 11 for homework. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 5. WARM-UP 1a Use the Warm-up as a lead-in to this exercise and/or explain that the short text is about a person we wouldn’t normally expect to commit a crime. • Ask students to quickly read the profile. Elicit why we wouldn’t expect him to commit a crime. • Check students understand devoted to his mother (loved very much, always did things for her) and stable marriage (no problems with the relationship). • Then give students three minutes to discuss the possible crime before checking on page 167. • Ask students if they are surprised he committed this crime and why/why not. • Finally, tell students that this is a true case that happened in the UK. 1b Set the question and elicit ideas from the class. 2 Focus students on the title of the article and check they understand it (looking at the background, habits, interests of a person and deciding what they are like and what they might do). • Give students two minutes to read the article and answer the questions by themselves. • Check answers with the class. 1 A criminal profiler is someone who investigates the behaviour, motives and background of criminals. 2 They can identify actual or potential offenders. 3 Give students eight minutes for this activity. • Tell them to underline the relevant information in the paragraphs they identify. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. • Finally, ask students if they have read books or seen films/TV shows about criminal profiling, if they liked them and why. This activity introduces the topic of people we think wouldn’t commit crimes. • First, elicit a few reasons why people commit crimes (e.g. they are angry about something, depressed, need money, insane). • Then write on the board: politician, business person, police office, lawyer, prison guard. • Tell students to rank the people from most to least likely to commit a crime. • Students discuss in pairs and justify their answers. • Finally, elicit ranking from one student in the class and ask the others if they agree and why/why not. 1 para D: by investigating behaviour, motives and background of criminals 2 para D: place of residence 3 para B: serial killers, mass murderers 4 para C: James Brussels 5 para D: minute details of the crime scene 6 paras B, C, E: serial killers, aeroplane hijacking, suicide bombers, mass murderers, bomber 7 para A: criminal profiling 8 para E: at best useless, at worst harmful, no real-world value, wastes police time 4 Get students to re-read the final paragraph. Check that they understand what it says. • In pairs, students discuss their reactions. 157 Psychology 0 0 • In feedback, elicit opinions from one or two students. Encourage others to say whether they agree or disagree. 5 Give students a maximum of five minutes for this activity. Check answers with the class and check their pronunciation of psychiatrist. 1 motive 2 deduce 3 psychiatrist 4 profile 5 case file 6 assessment GRAMMAR: reduced relative clauses 6a Give students one minute to find the sentences in the text. • Write them on the board (or see the tip below). 1 a number of letters mailed by the suspect 2 the crime scene, enabling them to describe the specific methods of operation 6bStudents discuss this question in pairs. • Elicit answers from the class and highlight the relevant parts of the sentences on the board. • Explain that reduced relative clauses are often used to improve the style of a piece of writing. Also, we can use reduced relatives for clauses which use other relative pronouns (e.g. who, that). Sentence 1: (Note: this is a passive structure.) The relative pronoun which and the auxiliary were are dropped. Only the past participle mailed is used here. Sentence 2: The relative pronoun which is dropped and the verb (enables) is changed to the -ing form. 7 • • • If possible, reproduce the text so that the whole class can see it (perhaps on an interactive whiteboard or an overhead projector). As you check answers to Exercises 6b and 7, highlight the relevant parts of the text. Tell students there are seven reduced relative clauses in the text (in addition to the two examples in 6a), but they only need to find four. They should, however, try to find some which use the past participle and some which use the -ing form. Put students in pairs to answer questions 1 and 2 (see the tip below). Check answers with the class and in each case elicit the full relative clause. This is a fairly complicated area of language, so give students time to read the information in G2 on page 144 in the Language reference. past participle/passive clauses: also referred to as criminal profiling, methods used to detect criminals -ing form/active clauses: lead detective profiling the offender, delaying the identification of the real culprit Students may find question 2 difficult. If necessary use the first sentence in Exercise 6a and lead detective profiling the offender as examples. Show students how the full relative clause is formed (i.e. 1 which were mailed by the suspect, and 2 lead detective who profiles the offender). Then ask which is passive (1) and which active (2). Ask students to look again at how these are written in the text and answer question 2 in Exercise 7. 8 Give students five minutes for this activity. They can refer to Exercises 6 and 7 and the Language reference if necessary. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. 2 a taken 2 b taking 3 a making 3 b made 4 a causing 4 b caused 9 Focus students on the photo and ask if they have seen this image before. Elicit that it is from the film The Silence of the Lambs and ask students to tell you if they have seen it and, briefly, what it is about. If they have not seen it, ask them to predict from the previous content of this lesson and the photo what they think it’s about. • Students read the text to check their ideas. • Read the instructions and remind students that the present participle is the -ing form. Give them five minutes to do the activity. Most examples simply involve crossing out the pronoun and auxiliary. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. • Finally, ask students who have not seen the film if they would like to and/or ask the class if they have seen films or read books similar to this. • For further practice, ask students to do Exercise G2–4 on page 145 in the Language reference. profilers who are investigating criminal cases; a film which is directed by Jonathan Demme; Clarice Starling, who is, played by Jodie Foster; serial killer, who is named Hannibal Lecter; Lecter, who is currently serving; performance of Lecter, who was played by Anthony Hopkins; the Kay Scarpetta series, which was written by Patricia Cornwell; a criminal profiler who works working for the FBI 158 Psychology 0 0 6.2 IMPACT IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging • Go through the questions with the class, by book/ film, rather than question. Some groups may find it easier to take notes by making a table with four columns (for the four questions) and four rows (for the four speakers). Students listen to people talking about their favourite books, films or characters, including The Great Gatsby by F. Scott Fitzgerald. Students read an extract of the book and study referencing words. Next, they focus on narrative tenses and the form and meaning of the past perfect continuous. Finally, they discuss books and films they feel have had a significant impact. 1 1 One Flew over the Cuckoo’ s Nest 2 Jack Nicholson as McMurphy, Nurse Ratchet 3 yes, based on a book 4 prefers the film 2 1 Zatoichi 2 Takeshi Kitano as Zatoichi 3 doesn’t say 4 doesn’t say 3 1 Crouching Tiger Hidden Dragon 2 Michelle Yeoh and Zhang Ziyi 3 yes, based on a book 4 hasn’t read book, so can’t say 4 1 Sherlock Holmes 2 Holmes, played by Peter Cushing, Christopher Lee, Robert Downey; Dr Watson recently played by Lucy Liu 3 yes, based on books 4 prefers the books Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from listening and reading texts • extended their understanding of the use of narrative tenses and the past perfect continuous • discussed the impact of important books and films Timings If short of time, omit Exercise 8. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 8. WARM-UP Audio script 6.2 and answer key to Exercise 3 1 This activity introduces the topic of characters in books. • Write on the board: Sherlock Holmes, Harry Potter, James Bond (007). • Ask students to discuss in pairs what they know about each character. Elicit answers from the class. Example answers: Sherlock Holmes: a detective; his friend is Dr Watson; lives at 221B Baker Street, London Harry Potter: a boy wizard; goes to Hogwarts School James Bond: a British spy SPEAKING AND LISTENING 1 Elicit the meaning of impact in this context (a deep, long-lasting impression). Students explain why these films/books/characters have had an impact. 2 Emphasise that for this listening, students should focus on the who and the what (i.e. the facts). They will shortly listen again to focus on the why. 0 • Play the recording and get students to take notes. 0 • Students compare their answers and add 2 Which film has had the biggest impact on me … Mm … I’d have to say Jack Nicholson’s performance in One Flew Over the Cuckoo’s Nest. Trying to choose just one of Nicholson’s great performances is difficult and he was amazing in The Shining. But he is heroic, funny and menacing as McMurphy, who ends up in a prison ward for the mentally ill and leads a fight against Nurse Ratchet. This film isn’t only great entertainment. It goes much deeper than this and gives us a wonderful insight into society. Everything about the film is brilliant: the plot, direction, filming, casting and, of course, the acting. Rarely can a film make you laugh and gasp with horror and shock at the same time. Rarely can a film leave you so entertained yet thinking about its disturbing scenes. The book by Ken Kesey is brilliant, but I believe the film is better than the book. I really enjoyed the Japanese film Zatoichi, which starts as a straightforward samurai movie, turns into a comedy and ends as a dance scene. I love it mainly because the lead actor and director is Takeshi Kitano, who some may know as Beat Takeshi. Kitano is information to their own notes as necessary. Literature TV favourite, novelist, poet, cartoonist and painter, and he seems to have made a film that combines a number of his talents. Kitano plays the blind masseur Zatoichi, who turns out to be incredibly skilled with a sword. He 0 wanders into a town harassed by a criminal 0 gang and helps two geishas take revenge on famous as an actor, director, comedian, kid’s 92 has character flaws – like, he can be very arrogant, especially in his relations with his sidekick, Dr Watson. Watson accompanies him on most cases and he isn’t stupid, but Holmes is so brilliant! And he’s a very courageous person, especially when dealing with some very dangerous men. He’s 3 4 the men who murdered their parents. I loved Kitano’s performance as the chuckling, shuffling, friendly masseur who turns into a revenging warrior when required. He makes an intensely likeable main character while speaking very few words throughout the film. In terms of visual impact, I think I’d have to say Crouching Tiger Hidden Dragon with excellent performances from Michelle Yeoh and Zhang Ziyi, two of Asia’s greatest actresses. This movie has breathtaking fight scenes and contains beautiful landscapes. The cinematography is outstanding and I think it won an Oscar for art direction. I also loved the beautiful musical score and especially the use of the cello. The film was based on a novel by novelist Wang Dulu, but I can’t say which I preferred as I haven’t read the book. The film was a Chinese, Hong Kong, Taiwanese, American co-production directed by Ang Lee. The dialogue is in Mandarin, with subtitles, and in my opinion, that version is much better than the version with English voiceovers. I’ve enjoyed many of the Sherlock Holmes films and Holmes is the most portrayed movie character, with more than 70 actors playing the part in over 200 films. I enjoyed watching Peter Cushing and Christopher Lee portraying Holmes and also recent versions with the brilliant Robert Downey Jr. I also like the modern series set in New York, which stars Lucy Liu as Dr Watson. But to be honest, I prefer the books, which made a huge impression on me when I first read them, and the reason’s simple. Sherlock Holmes himself is a fascinating person – someone we can all admire. He’s got a brilliant intellect and incredible analytical powers. He’s also got amazing powers of observation – just by looking at people, he can deduce all kinds of things about them and their lives. He’s supremely talented as a detective and can solve the most difficult cases. But he has human failings as well. He knowledgeable and he s talented musically. He often plays the violin when he’s in an unhappy mood. He’s very believable as the main character in the stories. When I was young, my uncle used to read extracts from the stories to me and he could quote pages of the stories by heart. I love Sherlock Holmes and I’ve re-read the stories many times. 3 Play the recording again. Students compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. 4 Ask if anyone has read or seen The Great Gatsby or what they know about it. • Ask students to read the questions, then play the recording. • Students check with a partner before you check answers with the class. 1 The book is extremely well written. The language is evocative. The main characters, especially Jay Gatsby, are fascinating. 2 Possibly he realises that Nick may be able to help him meet Daisy again. 3 the reasons for its great impact: fascinating plot and characters; asks interesting questions; portrays brilliantly and accurately the lives of wealthy people in the 1920s Audio script 6.3 One book that has made a huge impression on me is The Great Gatsby, by the American writer F. Scott Fitzgerald. It’s always been my favourite novel. I’ve re-read it many times and each time I find new meaning in it. There have been two impressive films based on the novel: one with Robert Redford and Mia Farrow, and a more recent one with Leonardo di Caprio and Carey Mulligan. The book is about a wealthy man, Jay Gatsby, who tries to win back the love of Daisy, a beautiful woman he first met when he was young and penniless. Instead of marrying Gatsby, Daisy marries a rich man, Tom Buchanan, from her own social class and years later, Gatsby, who’s now 93 Literature 0 0 very wealthy, wants to revive their romance. The narrator of the story, Nick Carraway moves to Long Island where his cousin Daisy lives. He rents a small house close to the magnificent mansion of Jay Gatsby. Gatsby holds lavish parties every Saturday. Hundreds of people come to them and most of them are not invited and have never met their host. Nick is surprised to receive a written invitation to one of the parties, even though he’s never met Gatsby. In a key scene, Nick wanders around the party and meets a man who turns out to be Gatsby. Later on, Gatsby uses his friendship with Nick to meet Daisy again, the woman he loved and lost. The story doesn’t have a happy ending for Gatsby. He manages to have a romantic relationship with Daisy. However, she chooses to remain with her husband rather than start a new life with Gatsby. I like this book for several reasons. First, it’s extremely well-written. Fitzgerald is so skilful at describing the characters and their emotions. And 0 his language is very evocative. You really get the 0 feel of how upper class people lived in the 1920s in America. He sees this as a period of declining such a thing as true love?’ It was also, I think, because in the novel, Fitzgerald depicted brilliantly and accurately the lives and behaviour of wealthy people in America. 5 Students should try and match the words based on their first listening and their own knowledge. • Play the recording again. Students check existing answers and look for ones they do not know. • In feedback, ask students to explain the meaning / usage of each phrase. 1h 2b 3e 4f 5c 6a 7d 8g READING 6 Remind students that this is an example of fiction, so the way the text is written is different to most of the other texts they have read so far on this course. • Students read the questions and then the text. • Tell students to be concise in their answers. • Take feedback. 1 the narrator (Nick Carraway) 2 Jordan Baker (the narrator’s friend), Jay Gatsby (the in America. He sees this as a period of declining social and moral values. People are greedy and pursue pleasure and money at all costs. The novel holds a mirror up to this corrupt society. host) 3 at a party (at Gatsby’s house) 4 elegant, young (30–32 year-old) man with a charming smile 5 Gatsby leaves to take a call. 7 Critical thinking: Referencing. Ask what kind of words are highlighted (pronouns). • Ask students to make predictions about pronouns without looking at the extract (e.g. ‘She’ must refer to a female. ‘We’ to the narrator plus another/others.). • Students answer the questions individually and then check in pairs. Take class feedback. I find the main characters, especially Jay Gatsby, absolutely fascinating. Gatsby has a romantic view of life. He believes that you can repeat the past and achieve happiness. He is a mysterious person. There are all kinds of rumours about his past. As the story unfolds, you are not sure about his character. He is undoubtedly charismatic with a charming smile, but you wonder if he is not what he seems. For example, he did not inherit his fortune, as he says, but made money from selling alcohol, which was illegal at the time. Your feelings about him change as you learn more about his past. The characters in the book are all richly drawn and that is one of the book’s greatest strengths. I have a favourite bit of dialogue about Gatsby, which reveals his character. Nick says to him, ‘You can’t repeat the past.’ Gatsby replies, ‘Of course you can. Of course you can.’ 1 Jordan Baker and the narrator 2 the hydroplane 3 Jordan Baker 4 Gatsby’s 5 his smile 6 Gatsby 7 Gatsby 8 Jordan Baker and the narrator (Nick Carraway) 8 Due to the complexity of this question, it would probably be best to discuss in a class situation. GRAMMAR: narrative tenses 9a Ask students if they know the meaning of narrative and/or can name any narrative tenses. • Students work in pairs before you check answers with the class. You may need to revise the form/ function of some of these tenses, depending on your class. The Great Gatsby was published in 1926, just a few years after the Great War. The novel had a great impact. This was not just because of the novel’s fascinating plot, but because it poses interesting questions like, ‘Can you get back the past? Is there 94 Literature 0 0 1 were sitting = past continuous 2 looked, smiled = past simple 3 introduced = past simple; had got = past perfect; was picking = past continuous 4 hurried = past simple; was calling = past continuous 9b Students work with the same partner as in Exercise 9a. They should match these descriptions with both the tense and the examples in 9a. • Tell students that it may help them to draw timelines to work out the answers here. • Go through the answers. Elicit/Teach all the information in brackets in the answer key below. a past simple; sentence 2 b past continuous; sentence 1 c past continuous (first action), past simple (action interrupting the first action); sentence 4 (Note: In some sentences, the first action can continue simultaneously with the second, e.g. We were sitting in the park when we saw the boy.) d past perfect; sentence 3 (The impression came before the introduction). 10 Give students five minutes to do this activity individually and then compare with a partner. • Tell students to look at Exercise 9 and the Language reference on page 136 if they need help. • Check answers with the class and if there is disagreement, ask why students chose a form. 1 was playing, ran 2 was trying, had seen 3 were ticking, could not Ask students if they have read any of the novels quoted in this exercise or another novel by this writer. If not, would they like to, based on the extract given here? 11a Direct students to the example in the text (had been hovering). Students work individually and 0 0 then compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. 11c Students should work in pairs to answer these questions. Ensure that you give clear feedback when going through the answers. Get students to explain why the false answers are incorrect. 1 F (past simple/continuous used more often) 2 T 3 T 4 F (past perfect) 12 Give students five minutes to do this activity individually and then compare with a partner. • Tell students to look at Exercises 9 and 11 and the Language reference on page 136 if they need help. • Check answers with the class and if there is disagreement, ask why students chose a form. • For further practice, ask students to do Exercises G1–1 and G1–2 on page 137 in the Language reference. 1 was sitting 2 was shaking 3 had been waiting 4 heard 5 came 6 told 7 had happened 8 had borrowed 9 had crashed 10 had been driving 11 rang 12 was SPEAKING 13 Put students in groups of four or five for this activity. First, direct them towards the five adverbs listed in the coursebook and check that they understand what each means. • Then direct them towards the example and read it aloud. You may want to give another one or two examples if you think your class need them. • Students discuss the questions for between five and ten minutes. Monitor the discussions and prompt/direct students as necessary. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the vocabulary, reading and grammar exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Students do Exercises V3,4–7, G1–1 and G1–2 on page 137 in the Language reference. before 11b Students use the example in Exercise 11a to help them complete the gaps. • Elicit the form from the class, write it on the board and highlight the possible contractions of had (I’d, you’d, he’d/she’d, we’d, they’d). had + been + -ing form of the verb 95 Literature 0 0 6.3 READING HABITS 3 Allow students five minutes to read the text. Emphasise that they are reading for the main idea, and to answer the question. Students might find it useful to underline the most important information in each summary. • Students compare answers and identify the textual evidence supporting their view. IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging Students begin by reflecting on how and when they read, focusing on a questionnaire. Next, they read about reading habits around the world. After some vocabulary work, they listen to people talking about their reading habits. Students focus on the meaning and form of used to, would and get used to before discussing things they used to do as children. summary 3 4 Elicit from the class the best way to approach this activity (i.e. to scan the text for the country names, underline them and work out the answer). • Students should complete activity individually, and then check in pairs. • Take class feedback. Ensure they identify specific evidence in the text to support their answers. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from listening and reading texts • learnt more about used to, would and get used to • practised this language in a discussion 1 Japanese girls 2 Japanese boys 4 Indonesian girls Timings If short of time, omit Exercise 6. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 7b. WARM-UP This activity introduces the topic of the importance of reading in everyday life. • Give students one minute to think about everything they have read in the last 24 hours (e.g. instructions, recipes, timetables). Students share this information with a partner and compare notes. • Elicit answers from the class and write them on the board. Discuss with students why reading is important in all aspects of life. SPEAKING 1a Students rank the statements about reading. Emphasise that they should be honest rather than giving what they think is the right answer. • They can rank 1–9 or if there are some which are not appropriate, just rank as many as are relevant. 1bStudents compare their answers in pairs. In feedback, ask three or four pairs if their answers were similar or different to each other. 2 Students stay in the same pairs to ask the questions. Encourage questions like Is it the same for you? to avoid repetition. Literature READING 0 3 Thai boys 5 Critical thinking: Identifying facts and opinions. The ability to distinguish fact (information which is unarguably true) and opinion (a viewpoint, which may or may not be true) is a key skill at higher levels. This is especially true in academic life, where making this distinction is critical, and in exams. You may want to point out that IELTS and the PTE-A Reading may ask about the purpose of a text and what the writer’s view is. • Give students one minute to find one opinion and one fact. Ask one student for feedback and get the others to confirm whether they are correct. When you are certain students can identify the difference, give them three minutes to find three more facts and three more opinions. • Students check in pairs. Partners should check each other’s ‘facts’ and ‘opinions’ and discuss whether they agree or disagree with them. You should monitor and be referee. • Take three further examples of each in feedback from the class. Example opinions: 1 Policy makers in countries where there this gap is particularly pronounced should … reading proficiency levels. 2 Policy makers should take into account boys’ preference for reading different types of material. 3 There could be far more potential for strengthening boys’ reading skills by encouraging other types of reading in addition to literature. 96 0 Example facts: 1 Boys have different reading habits than girls. 2 In every country except Korea, girls reported reading for enjoyment more than boys. 3 In 14 countries, only a minority of boys said that they read for enjoyment. 4 In Japan … only 54 percent of boys and 58 percent of girls … enjoy reading. 5 90 percent of Thai girls read for enjoyment. 6 Where possible, create small groups with students from different countries. • Students discuss the questions for three or four minutes. Take feedback from a few groups. 0 0 Emphasise that the second part of the question is important in an academic context. Explain that 1 speaker 3 2 speakers 4 and 5 3 speaker 1 4 speakers 4 and 5 5 speakers 1 and 3 6 speaker 2 Audio scripts 6.4 and 6.5 1 When I was in elementary school, I was a devoted reader and a good student. I used to read in bed for an hour every night before I fell asleep. And at school I would go to the library every afternoon. I loved reading. Then my dad lost his job and we kept moving schools. As soon as I got used to the new school and new friends I would have to leave. And finally when trying to understand why something happens, it is important to really establish that one thing happens because of something else – not just that it happens after it in time. VOCABULARY: words from the text Matching words and phrases is a common question in IELTS reading tests. For students preparing for IELTS, you might make this exercise more authentic/tricky by asking them to close their books and looking at the highlighted words. They should try and write a definition of these terms. They then do the exercise as in the coursebook. 7a Give students five minutes to match the words and definitions. You might allow them to use a dictionary in the last two minutes. • Students compare answers with a partner, using a dictionary if necessary. Check answers in class. 2 3 1 proportion 2 preference 3 associated 4 virtually 5 gender gap 6 typically 7 outperform 8 relatively 9 pronounced 7bStudents complete the activity individually and then check with a partner. Take class feedback. • In feedback, pay close attention to pronunciation and stress, since the words are multi-syllabic. 1 outperform 2 proportion 3 pronounced 4 associated 5 relatively 6 preference 7 virtually 8 gender gap 9 typically LISTENING 4 8 Tell students that some questions might have more than one answer. • Play the recording. Students answer individually and then check in pairs. Take class feedback. I ended up in a school where reading was not cool, certainly not for boys. My grades got worse and I would only read one or two books a year. When I left school, I joined a band and started composing songs. I started reading again because reading helped me understand the world and understand myself, and helped me find ideas for my songs. I used to read more than one book at a time and sometimes I’d have three or four on the go. But in recent years, I’ve mainly stuck to one book at a time, although if I’m reading a hardcover, I’ll sometimes have a paperback on the side to bring on the train or to read in the bath. And that’s my favourite place for reading – the bath – and if it’s a really good book, I’ll keep reading till the water goes cold. Life would be a much less interesting place if I didn’t read. As a child I loved to read and I would read in bed almost every night. But now I seem to have lost my love of reading. I used to love it. And I mean love it. I was a bookworm. I used to read, like, a whole novel in one day or less than a day. I loved imagining myself in the book. But now I’ve lost interest in them – even my favourite books that I would read over and over. To be honest, I think it’s down to the internet. I seem to have lost my attention span and focus. I used to read entire books in one sitting, now I put them down to check my phone, forget about them, only read the beginning and then lose interest. I didn’t use to read a lot. It once took me a year to read Martin Johnson, the ex-England Rugby Captain’s autobiography. I used to read a page a night and I would get bored really quickly. I hated reading at school 97 Literature 0 0 5 because I’m dyslexic. However, I’m reading a lot more now. Recently, I’ve been reading the Lee Childs novels and I read two chapters a night and actually, I’m really proud of myself. Before I became a librarian, I used to read pretty exclusively within the fantasy/sci-fi genres. Even now those are my go-to book choices. However, I try to continuously remind myself to read across as many genres as possible because advising readers is a big part of my job. And actually I really enjoyed reading George Eliot’s Middlemarch. It’s not the sort of book I would normally read, but it had everything – great characters, great stories and great descriptions of the scenery and countryside. It was warm and funny and gripping. I’m reading more now than I did when I was younger … and I’m reading different genres as well. • In feedback, write the examples on the board and underline the relevant parts to highlight form. Negative: We use auxiliary didn’t + used to + infinitive (e.g. read). Questions: We use auxiliary did + used to + infinitive (e.g. read). In pairs, students ask two or three of the questions. This is good preparation for Exercise 15. 11 Students work in pairs and refer to Exercise 10 and the Language reference if they need help. • Monitor to point out mistakes if necessary. • Check answers with the class. Ensure students explain why answers are wrong. 9 Students read the text and complete anything they remember from the first listening. • Play the recording again. Students complete as much as they can by themselves and then check answers with the same partner as in Exercise 8. • Go through the text in class. 1 was 2 used to read 3 fell 4 would go 5 loved 6 lost 7 got use to 8 ended 9 got 0 10 would 11 joined 12 started 13 helped 0 1 would used 2 was 3 is 4 at the moment 5 didn’t used to wouldn’t 6 used to got used to 7 would used to 8 Did you used to Would you Ask students to look again at question 1 and ask them whether it is a fact or opinion (fact). Get them to practise their critical thinking skills by discussing with them why women had to write anonymously at that time. 12 Set this as a challenge. Students read the text as fast as possible. As soon as they think they know the problem, they put their hand up. After 30 seconds, ask the student who put their hand up first to say what the problem is. If they are wrong, ask the second person, and so on, until you get the ask the second person, and so on, until you get the correct answer. • Ask the class to identify a solution. GRAMMAR: used to, would, get used to 10a Tell students to find and read all the examples in the text before they choose True or False. • Check that students understand state, habit and accustomed to. • If students find this activity very difficult, ask them to read the Language reference on page 136. • Ask them to compare with a partner before you check answers and elicit examples from the class. • In feedback, emphasise that we can’t use used to for single actions/events in the past; we have to use the past simple (e.g. I used to go to the cinema last week is wrong). 1F 2T 3F 4T There is no variety. Only used to is used. Students rewrite this text so that it is more interesting, by using different forms. 13 Students should make brief notes about what/ how they used to read. Give them seven minutes to write a short text. • Students compare answers in pairs. Each partner should give feedback to the other about whether they have used the different verb forms well. 5T 10b Tell students to look at the examples carefully before answering the question. • Ask them to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. 98 Literature 0 0 PRONUNCIATION Exercises like this are good practice for the PTE-A Speaking section. In the exam, students must listen to and repeat a sentence exactly as they hear it, using correct pronunciation. 14 Play the recording. Students compare with a partner before you elicit answers from the class. • Play the recording again. Pause after each sentence to allow students to repeat. Correct pronunciation. • Finally, point out that the pronunciation of used to and use to is exactly the same in English, i.e. the /d/ sound disappears. In the second sentence the /d/ sound is pronounced, which is why it is incorrect. 6.4 SCENARIO: THE NEW FILM PROJECT IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging Students read the scenario about making a pitch for a new film to a production company. They listen to two people discuss their idea for a film and then focus on the Key language. In the Task, students work in pairs to make a presentation to other members of the class about a film project. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from listening and reading texts • learnt useful phrases related to the language of persuasion. • used this language in a ‘real life’ situation to give a presentation about a film they would like to make The first sentence is correct. Audio script 6.6 I used to read in bed for an hour every night before I fell asleep. 15 Put students in small groups and give them ten minutes to discuss their ideas. Monitor to note mistakes when using the target language. • When finished, get a few ideas from the class. • Finally, correct some of the more common or important mistakes you noted earlier. Timings Possible lesson break: after Exercise 3b. WARM-UP This activity introduces the idea of a film pitch (a short summary of the main points of a film). HOMEWORK OPTIONS • Ask students to think about a film they like. • Students have two minutes to make notes. They then give a short (30–60-second) summary of the plot to a partner. Their partner can ask questions if they wish. Students do the vocabulary, reading, listening and grammar exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Student do Exercise G2–3 on page 137 in the Language reference. SITUATION 0 1 This exercise revises the topic of genre, which was introduced in lesson 6.1. • Students read the email and questions individually. They then answer the questions in pairs. • Take feedback from three or four pairs. Try and elicit several common film genres and write them on the board (e.g. horror, comedy, thriller, action). 0 KEY LANGUAGE: persuading 2 Elicit the meaning of persuading. Since this is a central concept for the task, it is important that students are clear what it means (convincing somebody that you are correct about something so that they accept your argument). Literature • Students read the questions. • Play the recording. Students answer individually 0 0 and then check with a partner. • Take brief class feedback. 99 danger. Its biggest selling point would be that it’s a thriller and also a horror film. OK, to summarise, our concept has a fascinating storyline. We think it’s got tremendous potential. The audience will want to know 1 thriller and horror 2 two women returning from college 3 the 20–40-year-old group Audio script 6.7 Jerry, Francesca J: F: J: F: J: F: J: I’ve got a great idea for a film, Francesca. I’m sure it’ll be a winner. Really? OK, try it out on me. Imagine I’m the management listening to your pitch. If it’s really good, we can work on it and enter the competition. OK, I’m confident you’ll like my idea. I hope so. OK, I’ll start. Good morning, everyone, I’m sure you’ll find our concept exciting and original. I’ll start with the storyline. Two women are returning from college to their parents’ houses. On the way, they find the road’s closed, with a notice saying ‘Do not enter’. A local man explains that there was an awful murder last night at the house on the hill. The women are in a hurry. They ignore the notice and go down the road. They’re never seen again. I think you’ll agree, it’s a really interesting and creative idea. Of course, we’ll have to work out the details. It’s just a storyline at the moment. But it’s got a lot of potential and it could be a real winner. A woman disappears and no one knows what’s happened to her. It’s really … intriguing. Turning now to the actors. We’d like to get stars, if possible – young actors who’ve already proved themselves. We’re thinking of Naomi Watts and Jennifer Lawrence – the one who was in Hunger Games. They’re both really attractive and good actors. They’d be perfect. The budget, I think, would allow us to use well-known actors. They’re bound to appeal to the audience who’d go to the film. OK, so, who is our target audience? Who do we have in mind? I’d say the 20- to 40-year-old group. They’re the ones that go regularly to the cinema. They’ll love our concept. It’s got such a wide appeal: two female characters, mystery and F: J: F: J: F: potential. The audience will want to know what’s happened to the two women. Have they disappeared for ever? That’s the mystery the film will solve. There’ll be all kinds of twists and turns in the plot and a lot of human interest. We really believe in our concept and hope we’ve managed to convince you, too. What do you think, Francesca? Do you like the idea? I absolutely love it! It’s a fantastic plot. Well done! Great, I thought you’d like it. I do. You’ve convinced me, totally. Nice presentation, too. Let’s start working on it because the management will ask a lot of questions and expect more details. I’d say we’ve got a winner, Jerry, with this concept. OK, let’s meet tomorrow after work in the canteen. OK with you? Fine. See you roundabout six. 3a Students tick as many of the statements as they can remember from the first listening. • Play the recording again. Students complete the exercise individually. • In feedback, ask which statements were not mentioned, to speed up the process. + Ask students to identify which of the language in the questions is less formal (question 1: it’ll be a winner; question 3: really interesting; question 6: they’ll love; question 9: great). tick: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 8; cross: 7, 9 3b Students turn to page 175 and look for statements which are similar to 7 and 9 in Exercise 3a. • Take class feedback. Explain that being able to say what you want in more than one way can be useful in terms of increasing the variety of what you say, and to restate your position. 7 It’s got such a wide appeal. 9 We really believe in our concept and hope we’ve managed to convince you, too. 100 Literature 0 0 TASK: making a persuasive presentation 4a Set the activity. In pairs, students brainstorm their ideas and develop a rough outline of the story. Give them ten minutes for this. 4bGive students a minute to read the notes and the useful phrases. Check in class that everything is understood. If not, clarify as needed. • In pairs, students check they’ve discussed all the key information. They must also work out how to divide the five-minute presentation equally. Some groups may benefit by an additional five minutes to do a ‘dummy run’ rehearsal. 5a Explain the marking system to be used. Ask students to describe the kind of things they would expect to see in a ‘brilliant’ presentation. • Students give their presentation to the class. 0 Monitor time and do not allow students to go (too0 far) over the five-minute limit. • Get students to ask questions. You may need to do 6.5 STUDY AND WRITING SKILLS IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging This lesson focuses on making effective presentations and writing an online review. Students listen to five people talking about effective presentations and look at rhetorical techniques which help improve the quality of a presentation. They watch a video which illustrates some of these techniques and practise using them. Next, students consider key features of an online review, focusing in particular on adjectives and adverbs. Finally, students write their own review of a film they have seen. Study skills video Watch the video to see a talk about the film The Girl with the Dragon Tattoo. Get students to ask questions. You may need to do this at first to encourage the others. If your class is reluctant to ask questions, nominate people before each presentation. 5b Add up the scores and declare the winner. It would probably be best to do this in secret and not reveal everybody’s final scores, so as to avoid demotivating weaker groups. • Give general feedback about the presentations. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from listening and reading texts • developed their understanding of rhetorical techniques and practised how they can improve presentations • extended their range of adverbs and adjectives • written an online review of a recent film Timings Students do the Key language, listening, vocabulary and academic collocations exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Students do Exercise KL–4 on page 137 in the Language reference. If short of time, omit Exercise 7. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 7. WARM-UP To introduce the theme of the first half of the lesson, students should reflect on the presentation they gave at the end of lesson 6.4. In pairs or small groups, students discuss how they think they did in their film presentation and how other people said they did. STUDY SKILLS: making an effective presentation Extended speaking, whether in the form of a presentation or discussion, is a common means of assessing a student’s English speaking ability (e.g. IELTS Speaking task 3). 101 Literature 0 0 1 Check students understand memorable (something you can remember for a long time because it was so good). Students then read the statements. • Play the recording. Students answer individually and then check in pairs. Take class feedback. 1d 2c 3e 4a 5b Audio script 6.8 1 I went to a lecture on English Literature. To make her key point, the lecturer quoted two lines from the American poet Robert Frost: ‘Home is where you go to and they can’t turn you away.’ She repeated the two lines several times during her talk to make her points. I heard that presentation 25 years ago and I still remember the quote. Her presentation was truly outstanding. 2 The lecturer was talking about trends in the current economic climate. Her presentation could have been boring, but the slides she used to illustrate her points were striking and incredibly imaginative. So everyone listened to her very intently. 3 There was another presenter at the conference on the current economic climate. He started by telling us an anecdote – something about a train coming through a tunnel and almost crashing when it came out the other side. He took about two minutes to come to the punchline. He took so long to tell the story that the audience were amused and listened carefully to the rest of his talk. 4 The presenter had worked for years for the BBC. His talk was on how to give an effective 0 presentation. He spoke in a low but powerful 0 voice which carried to the back of the room without the need of a loudspeaker. He had it was impressive. When done, ask three or four students to share their experiences. 3a Rhetorical techniques. Students read the explanation of this term. Ask them whether they can think of an example. Prompt them with what they just heard in the listening (e.g. a quotation). Explain that the use of rhetorical techniques is useful for improving the quality and effectiveness of a presentation. However, if they are used too much, the effect may be lost. Presentations are a common feature of higher education. Students may need to do them at the beginning of seminars, in class or for assessment. 3b Students should work in pairs for this exercise. Monitor closely and help where needed. • Tell students not to get stuck on one question if they are not sure. They should do the easier ones first and then move on to the more difficult ones. 1 c 2 d 3 e 4 g, k 5 i 10 j 11 a 4 • 5 • • 6b 7e 8h 9f In pairs, groups or with the whole class, create additional examples of each rhetorical technique. Elicit/Check dragon (a large, mythical, scary creature, like a dinosaur) and tattoo (body art). Students read the description and then discuss the questions in pairs. Take brief class feedback. Students read the questions. Play the video. Students complete individually and then check in pairs. Take class feedback. 1 They are trying to find out what happened to Vanger’s niece, Harriet, who disappeared 40 years ago. 2 Lisbeth. There are so many contrasts in her character. She is a fascinating person. 3 outstanding actors in the two main 5 roles; the film is based on a superb book such a magnificent voice that his presentation was memorable. It was the best presentation I’ve ever heard. The speaker used all kinds of rhetorical devices – you know, techniques to get across his ideas in a memorable way, like tripling – that’s using words in threes – contrasting ideas, repetition, alliteration, quotes from literature. It was an amazing demonstration of how to make a presentation effective. 2 Students swap partners and discuss the questions. Emphasise that they must give reasons as to why Study skills video Hi, everyone. The film you’re going to see tonight is The Girl with the Dragon Tattoo. It’s based on the first of three Swedish novels written by Stieg Larsson and it features two main characters, an investigative journalist, Mikael Blomkvist, and a young female researcher, Lisbeth Salander. The books were a huge success internationally. Their sales to date have been well over $100 million. The film has been equally successful. One critic, comparing it to the book wrote, ‘This mystery is 102 Literature 0 0 just as devastating, suspenseful and satisfying on screen.’ And another one wrote, ‘This dynamite thriller shivers with suspense. In a word, wow!’ by two extraordinarily talented actors, Daniel Craig and Rooney Mara – they’re perfect for their roles. And the second reason is that the film’s based on a superb novel that millions of people have enjoyed. OK, I’ll start by outlining the plot of the film. It’s very complicated and I hope my summary will make it easier for you to understand the twists and turns in the story. After that, I’ll talk about the two main characters. And finally, I’ll suggest a couple of reasons why the film has been so popular and highly praised. OK, I hope you’ve found my presentation useful and informative. Let’s watch the film. 6a Working in the same pairs as Exercise 5, ask students to discuss what techniques they can remember and note them down. • Play the video again and get students to note down any additional techniques they notice. • Take feedback and write correct rhetorical techniques on the board for use in Exercise 7. Right, let’s start with the plot. The film’s about an investigation by a journalist, Mikael Blomkvist. He’s hired by a millionaire, Henrik Vanger, to find out what happened to Vanger’s niece, Harriet, who disappeared 40 years ago. Henrik suspects that someone in the family, the powerful Vanger family, murdered Harriet. Tripling: a computer hacker, very anti-social, looks like a punk; a serious person, with a journalist’s curiosity and a strong social conscience; She has a tattoo, nose ring and many earrings. Alliteration: twists and turns; strong, singleminded and stubborn Quotation: ‘This mystery is just as devastating, suspenseful and satisfying on screen’; ‘This dynamite thriller shivers with suspense. In a word, wow!’ Simile: looks like a punk; looks like a frightened animal; her skin is pale like porcelain china. Imagery: This dynamite thriller shivers with suspense. Repetition: Henrik suspects that someone in the family, the powerful Venger family, murdered Harriet. Contrast: a single event/a series of terrible murders; often a victim, she always takes revenge on her enemies Rhetorical questions: Who wouldn’t find her fascinating? Why has the film been so successful? In his investigation, Mikael gets help from a young female researcher, Lisbeth Salander. She’s a computer hacker, very anti-social and looks like a punk. They soon realise that Harriet’s disappearance isn’t a single event, but rather linked to a series of terrible murders in the area. They begin to discover a dark and appalling family history and when they do this, they put themselves in great danger. So, I’ve given you an idea of what the film’s about. Moving on now to the two main characters, Mikael Blomkvist and Lisbeth Salander. They’re an interesting contrast. On the one hand, there’s Mikael, the journalist, played by Daniel Craig, who’s better known for playing James Bond in the Bond films. Mikael’s a serious person, with a journalist’s curiosity and a strong social conscience. He’s 20 years older than Lisbeth. On the other hand, there’s Lisbeth Salander, by far the most interesting character in the film. Who wouldn’t find her fascinating? A small woman, at times she looks like a frightened animal. But at other times she’s strong, single-minded and stubborn. She’s a very troubled person because she had a difficult childhood. Physically, she’s very attractive in an unusual way. She has shiny, spiky, black hair, yet her skin is pale like porcelain china. She has a tattoo, nose ring and many earrings. Often a victim, she always takes her revenge on her enemies. So, Why has the film been so successful? Probably for two reasons. The main characters are played 0 Literature 6b If students found the first exercise difficult, tell them which techniques can be found. They should then try and find at least one example of each. • In pairs, students check the audio script, either confirming what they have already found or finding additional answers. • Take class feedback. Write up any remaining techniques on the board. 7 Students will need some time to prepare this, as they need to create five minutes of material as well as including rhetorical techniques. 0 103 • Monitor closely during this exercise, since students may need help in identifying how to use rhetorical techniques. • When they are ready, students make their presentation in groups of three or four. You might ask them to assess these presentations using the same criteria as on page 63. Some groups may find this exercise easier if they only have to do a three-minute presentation, so 0 they can focus more on the rhetorical techniques. 0 WRITING SKILLS: an online review • Check answers with the class and get two or three reasonable suggestions for each adjective. Suggested answers: interesting → gripping, fascinating, absorbing, compelling funny → humorous, amusing, hilarious exciting → thrilling, dramatic, exhilarating, nail biting stupid → crazy, absurd, laughable, ridiculous nice → pleasant, lovely, beautiful good → excellent, brilliant, outstanding, WRITING SKILLS: an online review good excellent, brilliant, outstanding, terrific boring → dull, tedious, monotonous, repetitive bad → terrible, appalling, awful, dreadful 8 Elicit the meaning of online review (an opinion of a film put on a website). Students then discuss the questions in pairs. Take brief feedback for each. 9 Students discuss the questions with a partner. All the items are possible in an online review, except what happens at the end. 10 Tell students that the film review is for Skyfall, the 2012 James Bond film. Ask if anyone has seen this film and if they have an opinion about it. • Give students two minutes to skim-read the text to answer the question. Then put students in pairs to discuss. Encourage them to underline/highlight specific language which shows the author’s view. • Take class feedback. positive, but with some negative points 11 Students read the information in the coursebook. Check their understanding of cast (people who act in a film) and setting (the location of a film). • Ask students to predict where some of the aspects might be found (e.g. that the recommendation comes at the end, in para D). • Individually, students match the aspects with the paragraphs. They then check in pairs. • Take class feedback. Ask students to provide evidence that supports their answer in each case. 13a Adverbs. Elicit why adverbs are important and what their purpose is (they add considerable meaning to language, helping it to be more specific/focused). • Explain to students that they should find matching pairs of adverbs. You should say that they do not have exactly the same meaning, but can often be used in a similar way. • Check answers with the class. Check pronunciation of the final -ly sound. Do not focus on meaning as this is the focus of Exercise 13b. completely – totally, definitely – certainly, really – truly, particularly – especially, generally – usually 13b Students quickly match the adverbs with their meanings. Check answers with the class. In pairs, students create their own sentences using the target language. 1 totally, completely 2 definitely, certainly 3 generally, usually 4 particularly, especially 5 really, truly 14 If there is time, students write their review in class. They will need at least 30 minutes to do this. 1 A, C 2 A 3 A 4 C 5 A, B 6 A, C, D 7 B, C 8 D HOMEWORK OPTIONS 12 Adjectives. Check that students understand the additional information in the instructions. • If necessary, explain what a thesaurus is (a book which groups words that have similar meanings). Allow them to use their mobile devices if desired. • Ask students to try and think of at least one synonym for each adjective. When they have done this, they compare their answers in pairs. Students do the study skills, reading, reading and listening and writing skills exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Students do Exercise 14. 104 Literature 0 0 7 Architecture Unit Objectives Grammar: Vocabulary: Scenario: Study skills: Writing skills: the passive describing buildings; idioms; prefixes talking about requirements; deciding on facilities in a hotel identifying fact and opinion an opinion-led essay 7.1 ICONIC BUILDINGS IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging This lesson looks at architecture and people’s favourite buildings. Students read about three famous buildings and focus on vocabulary connected with architecture and construction. Finally, they discuss iconic buildings and write a paragraph describing one. Meet the expert video Watch a video of an architectural journalist talking about innovative designs. Objectives 0 By the end of the lesson, students will have 0 • extracted specific information and language items from reading texts • Elicit answers from the class. • Finally, ask students if they have visited, like/dislike each building. Le Corbusier quote: This quote suggests that the main purpose of a house is ‘function. The idea of ‘aesthetics’ is therefore less important. You might discuss with students whether they share this view or hold the opposite. VOCABULARY: describing buildings 1 To give students some ideas for this activity, you could focus them on the photos on pages 66–67 or refer them to the Warm-up activity. • Students discuss the question in pairs before you elicit a few ideas from the class. 2a Tell students to do as many adjectives as possible before using a dictionary. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. • In feedback, elicit that classical is a European style from the Roman/Greek period (ca. AD 1000– 500 BCE), but some modern buildings use this style. • Tell students that the neutral adjectives can be either positive or negative, depending on the opinion of the speaker/writer. • extended their vocabulary related to architecture and construction, and practised using this • participated in a discussion to express their opinions about an iconic building and written a paragraph about it Timings If short of time, set Exercise 10 as homework. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 5b or 7. WARM-UP This activity introduces the topic of iconic buildings. • Write the following buildings on the board, but not the dates in brackets: the Colosseum (ca. AD 80), the Eiffel Tower (1889), Tower Bridge, London (1894), the Sydney Opera House (1973), the Empire State Building (1931), the Taj Mahal (1648), the Great Wall of China (building began 500 BCE). • Check that students know each building. It may help to elicit/tell students which cities they are in, take in photos/use the photos on pages 66–67. • In pairs, students order the buildings from the earliest construction date to the latest. Ask students whether they know any more words which could be placed in these categories. Allow them to look some up in a thesaurus or online. 2bWarn students that more than one adjective goes in some categories and a couple of adjectives can go in more than one category. • Students work individually and then compare answers with a partner. New Language Leader Upper Intermediate Architecture 0 Positive: elegant, graceful, impressive, magnificent, stylish, imposing, innovative Negative: derelict, dilapidated, run-down, ugly Neutral: ancient, classical, contemporary, ornate, traditional 0 105 • Check answers with the class and write the words on the board in preparation for Exercise 3. 1 dilapidated, derelict, run-down 2 traditional, ancient, classical 3 ugly 4 innovative 5 elegant, stylish, graceful 6 ornate 7 contemporary 8 imposing, impressive, magnificent PRONUNCIATION 3 Word stress. Elicit the importance of word stress in English (to be clear and to make your spoken English follow the ‘rhythms’ of English). • Focus students on the first adjective you wrote on the board in Exercise 2b, elicit the main stress and mark it on the word (see answer key below). • In pairs, students mark stress on the other words. They can say the word to each other if necessary. • Check answers with the class. • Ask students to work individually to group the words according to their syllable stress. • Students compare answers with a partner. Play the recording, pausing after each word for students to check. • Play the recording again, pausing after each word for students to repeat, and correct if necessary. First-syllable stress: ancient, classical, derelict, elegant, graceful, innovative, stylish, ugly Second-syllable stress: contemporary, dilapidated, imposing, impressive, magnificent, ornate, run-down, traditional 4 Give students one minute to look at the photos and decide their opinions. • Put students in pairs to describe the buildings and discuss which they like. Students describe one of the buildings. Their partner must guess which is described. Give students a few minutes to think of a building they know (it doesn’t need to be famous). In small groups, students describe their buildings and0ask 0 each other questions for more information if necessary. Alternatively, you could provide some • In feedback, elicit the stressed syllable on each word and ask students to mark this in their books. The main stress is marked in the answers below. 1 g damage 2 e rebuild 3 c construct 4 h demolish 5 b maintain 6 a restore 7 d commission 8 f design 5bTo help students get started, elicit the first stage (commission) and then give them two minutes to order the other words. • The order is not obvious, so put students in pairs to compare their lists and discuss the options. • Elicit answers and write them on the board. Ask students if they agree with the order as you write each item. Accept any reasonable answers. • Finally, give students the suggested order below. Monitor for use of the passive structure while students are discussing the order of the verbs. This will help assess their ability before the grammar focus in the next lesson. • For further practice, ask students to do Exercises V1–5 and V2–6 on page 135 in the Language reference. Suggested answers: 1 commission 2 design 3 construct 4 maintain 5 damage 6 restore 7 demolish 8 rebuild READING 6a To lead in, (re)elicit the name of each building and where it is (Colosseum: Rome, Italy; Taj Mahal: Agra, India; Eiffel Tower: Paris, France). • Explain that students will read about each building later. This is a prediction activity. • Set the activity and give students one minute to guess the answers. • Ask students to compare with a partner. • Elicit a few guesses from the class. Making predictions about what you are going to read is a good technique to use in exam tasks, such as the IELTS or PTE-A Reading. This will help to provide clues to the content and structure of the text, e.g. using the title of a text to predict content photos of buildings for use in discussion. 5a Tell students to match as many words as possible before using their dictionaries to check meaning. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. or using topic sentences to get the gist of a text. 6b Give students five minutes to read the texts and check their answers. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. • In feedback, check that students understand gladiators (Roman fighters for entertainment). 106 Architecture 0 0 • Finally, ask students if they have visited/would like to visit any of the buildings and why/why not. • Take class feedback from three or four students, or from one student from every country (if your 1 F (opened in AD80) 2 T (gladiator and animal fights) 3 T 4 F (recently renovated and partly restored) 5 F (built in memory of an Emperor’s wife) 6 F (less than 500 years ago) 7 T (from environmental pollution) 8 F (there was a lot of opposition from the public when it was built) 9 T (until about 1930) 10 T (built as a temporary structure) Make Exercises 6a and 6b more communicative by dividing the class in three and getting each group to focus on only one text. In 6b, students read their text to check their guesses and swap information with students who read the other texts. In Exercise 7, either ask students to find the words in their text only and then swap information or ask everyone to read all three texts. 7 Students do this activity individually and then compare answers with a partner. This kind of matching task is commonly found in IELTS Reading and Listening exams. • Go through the answers and check pronunciation of any difficult words (e.g. amphitheatre). 1 amphitheatre 2 survived 3 renovate (Note: renovate: in good condition; restore: to original condition) 4 tomb 5 dome 6 exterior 7 interior 8 landmark 9 temporary 10 eyesore class is multinational). 10 Give students fifteen minutes to write their paragraph using the notes they made earlier. • Monitor to help with vocabulary if necessary. • Take the work in for marking, paying particular attention to the use of vocabulary from this lesson. • Alternatively, post the paragraphs round the room and ask students to read them all. Then ask them which buildings they already know and which they would like to visit. MEET THE EXPERT 1 Students discuss the questions in pairs. Encourage them to give reasons for all the points. 1 a Belfast (Northern Ireland) b Sheffield (England) c Sao Paulo (Brazil) 2 a music, theatre, dance and art; b housing; c culture and leisure 3–4 Students’ own answers 2 Follow on from Exercise 1 by asking the class what they discussed about the Sesc Pompeia building. Encourage students to comment on the opinions of other students, but do not clarify or correct yet. • Students read the sentences in the book. • Play the video. Individually, students tick the sentences they hear. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. a, c, d, f SPEAKING AND WRITING 8 Students should take a few minutes to think about which building they would like to describe. This exercise may work best if they have some time to research the building online. • Students talk for around 30 seconds on each topic with a partner. The research stage means you will need to give students lots of time in the lesson. Alternatively, they could research and make notes in their own time and write the paragraph in class. 9 Critical thinking: Interpreting ideas. In this activity students reflect on what they have read and listened to about buildings and apply it to their own context. • Students discuss the questions, ideally with someone from a different country. • You should monitor discussions, as the concepts under discussion are quite complex. Meet the expert video Laura Mark, architectural journalist I’m Laura Mark. I’m a technical reporter for The Architects’ Journal, which is a weekly magazine for architects. I studied architecture before I joined The Architects’ Journal and I also worked in practice for six years before then. My three favourite buildings are the The Mac, in Belfast, which is a cultural art centre, Parkhill in Sheffield, which is a social housing scheme, and the Sesc Pompeia in Sao Paolo Brazil, which is a community centre. The Sesc Pompeia is a social scheme, a community centre, built in the slum area of Sao Paolo for the people who live there. It was built between the years of 1977 and 1986. And it 107 Architecture 0 0 housed many different uses, including, um, an exhibition centre, uh, community use and sports hall, sports centres, churches and a kind of a restaurant space as well. It was built by an organisation that wanted to bring education, culture and sports to the local people. They built several centres like this across Brazil. The Sesc Pompeia was designed by Lina Bo Bardi and its quite unusual because at the time, women architects didn’t really build that much in Brazil and this is quite a large of example of a project by a woman architect. And, um, what makes it even more unusual was that she was designing, using an existing factory building – which was, had been on the site for a long time and had already been, um, kind of used by a local community. 0 0 They already were kind of using the building and lacking in many of today’s buildings; they don’t quite manage to get that right, but she did. Um, and I think what, another thing, another aspect which is really important is that she reused this existing building and it already had a community about it. And she didn’t just go in there and get rid of it. And I think a lot of architects could learn from that today. The building was really popular when it first opened; people loved it. And it still remains that way to this day, it still has the community uses that were originally there. And Lina Bo Bardi even us-, still used the building right up until her death in 1992. 3a Individually, students complete as much as they can based on the first viewing. 3bReplay the video. Students check their answers, playing in it, and so she had to work with them to create a space which they wanted. And I think a big key to that was that she moved onto the site whilst the building was in progress. And she had her office there, she worked with the local people, she worked with the crafts people working on a project and kind of really got in there and got building, I think. and confirm with a partner. Take class feedback. 1 slum 2 sport 3 several 4 wanted 5 70 metres 6 stark contrast 7 visually appealing 8 use 4 Students work in groups of three or four and discuss the questions for five to ten minutes. Take feedback from three groups for each question. The existing factory was built out of red brick and concrete. The concrete used was, uh, quite unusual at the time; it was one of the early examples of it being used in Brazil at that scale. And what Lina Bo Bardi did was she uncovered these materials. She took away the plaster that had been covering them up for so many years and revealed them. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the writing skills and vocabulary exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. They can also do the MyEnglishLab video activities after this point. So the materials had, like, a raw aesthetic and were kind of on view just as they were. And then next to this existing factory she built two concrete towers, very tall, 70 metres high. And then, within these towers, she punched windows through and these were then, the openings of these windows were then painted bright red, which is a kind of stark contrast to the, uh, raw concrete of the building. Students think about a building they visited on holiday in the past and write an email to a friend telling them why they liked/didn’t like the building. Students do exercises V1 5 and V2 6 on page 139 in the Language reference. I really like the Sesc Pompeia because it’s, it’s striking, it’s visually appealing, but at the same time it’s got this community feel about it. And when you look at the building, the concrete and the kind of materials could, could be really harsh. But, actually, it’s quite maternal, it’s loving and it’s got this fun feeling about it, which is kind of 108 Architecture 0 0 7.2 SOLVING PROBLEMS IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging Students read a text about four innovative solutions to housing problems. They study passive structures in the article and focus on meaning and form. Next, students listen to an architect talking about solutions to housing problems. Finally, they discuss housing problems specifically related to young people having to live at home for longer. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from a reading and a listening text • developed evaluating skills • revised/extended their understanding of the use of the present simple, future simple and present continuous passive • discussed housing problems faced by young people still living with their parents Timings If short of time, omit Exercise 5 or set it as homework. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 7. • Emphasise that the key word for discussion is interesting (they do not necessarily have to like it). • Students discuss with a partner which building is most interesting. They must give reasons. • Go through the photos one by one and ask who thinks each building is the most interesting. 2b Give students two minutes to skim-read the article. They should be looking for key words to help match the photos with parts 1–4. • Take class feedback. Explain as necessary. A2 B1 C4 D3 3 Students complete as much of the table as possible based on their first reading. Give them a further five minutes to re-read and complete as much as they can. Explain that there may not be answers for every question. • Students check in pairs. Take class feedback. Building A: Yasuhiro Yamashita; Tokyo; n/a; 146 m2; clever use of space made use of every centimetre Building B: dRMM; UK; glass; n/a; glass cover transforms the building giving extra space Building C: Etgar Keret; Poland; iron; 91 cm across; Poland’s narrowest house Building D: Gary Chang; Hong Kong; polished chrome; 32 m2; each space can change into 24 configurations + In pairs/small groups, students discuss which of WARM-UP This activity introduces the topic of living spaces. 0 • Give students three minutes to note down all the 0 places they have lived in their lives. They should make brief notes about each. the buildings they would most like to live in. 4 Critical thinking: Evaluating. In this exercise, students work with other students to evaluate information and decide which is more important. • Put students in groups to discuss the questions. make brief notes about each. • In groups of three, students discuss the places – their size, location, features, etc. They should focus on both the positive and negative aspects. • Take class feedback from three or four students. SPEAKING AND READING 1 Students may not have a lot of background knowledge about this topic, so may need some support/guidance. • If possible, ask students to work with a partner from a different country (where appropriate). • Take feedback from three of four students, or from a student of every nationality (if appropriate). 2a Students look at the photos. Explain that they are all strange or unusual buildings. Ask one or two groups to share their ideas. Evaluating is an important skill when writing academic essays, since students must read and assess the importance of information. Evaluating the quality and usefulness of texts is one of the reading skills tested in the PTE-A. 5 Individually, students match the words with their meanings. • Students compare answers in pairs. They should try replacing the words in the text with the definitions, to check whether their answers still make sense (e.g. for question 1: This excellent and unusual building …). • Check answers with the class. 1 remarkable 2 ingenious 3 numerous 4 cramped 5 configuration 6 miniscule 109 Architecture 0 0 GRAMMAR: the passive (1) LISTENING 6a Introduce the idea of the passive by asking students what the normal word order in English is (subject, verb, object). Elicit/Teach the structure of the passive: object, verb, (subject). • Check that students understand agent (subject, doer of the verb). • Ask students to read the passive sentences and match them with the descriptions. • Take class feedback and check understanding. 8a Set the context and play the recording. • Tell students not to worry if they cannot write the complete questions at this stage; a close approximation is sufficient. • Also tell students not to worry about the answers the speaker gives at this stage. They will listen again for these. • Students check answers with a partner and work together to get the language right. • Check answers with the class and write them on the board. a experts think it will soon be recognised as a landmark in its own right; is wedged b At present, several sliding houses are being manufactured by dRMM. 1 What do architects find interesting when designing buildings? 2 What type of architecture has particularly impressed you in terms of solving problems? 3 What’s your next project? 6b Discuss the question with the class. As revision, ask what the purpose of each of the tenses is and why they are being used in this situation. Audio script 7.2 Marta, Students present simple: is wedged present continuous: are being manufactured future simple: will soon be recognised S1: For weaker groups, write up the three verb forms on the board so that students can analyse them and not be confused by irrelevant detail. 6c In pairs, students work out the constructions of the passive forms. • Take class feedback. Write the forms on the board. • Direct students to the Language reference if needed (page 138). present simple: am/is/are + past participle present continuous: am/is/are being + past participle future simple: will be + past participle 7 Students do this activity individually and then compare with a partner. • Tell students to look at Exercise 6 and the Language reference on page 138 if they need help. • Monitor to point out mistakes, but encourage students to self-correct if possible. • Check answers with the class and if necessary, elicit the reasons for each one. 1 are being manufactured 2 will be built 3 is made 4 are being built/will be built 5 will be converted 6 is being carried out 0 7 will not/ won’t be finished 0 What do architects find interesting when designing buildings? M: A good question. I’d say the most interesting thing relates to our role as an architect. In most cases, what are architects trying to do? Well, we’re trying to design an ideal place to meet human needs. That’s really our main motivation. It’s our ‘duty’ if you like, to create a place that integrates interior design with the needs of the people who’ll be using the building. It’s, how can I say, a relationship in which the individual and the place are integrated. They depend on each other. S2: What type of architecture has particularly impressed you in terms of solving problems? M: That’s an interesting question. I’ve lived in and visited a lot of hot climates and I really like the way that Islamic architecture deals with the problem of extreme heat. Houses are often built around a central open courtyard which ventilates them. And they often have a central basin or fountain, which provides a cooling effect and the soothing sound of falling water. When you visit the old mosques and palaces, which did not have electricity, you notice that the temperature is often just right. I sometimes use some of the central features of Arab architecture, which include patios, open courtyards and water features, 110 Architecture when designing hotels. Those features are really useful in regulating heat and cooling buildings during long, hot summer days. S3: What’s your next project? M: Well, it seems that affordable housing is the new buzzword and we’ve just won a contract to deliver 300 housing units on sites in and0 0 around Copenhagen. These will be very reasonably priced and a large proportion will SPEAKING 9 Ask students to read the statements and then give them five minutes to make some notes with examples to support their opinions. If students do not have much knowledge of this topic, you might let them search online at first. • Students work in groups of three or four and discuss these questions for between ten and fifteen minutes. • In feedback, ask one or two groups to share their ideas with the rest of the class. In many speaking exams, such as IELTS, students have to discuss this kind of issue, i.e. those with personal relevance and interest to young people. be reserved for essential workers such as nurses, police officers and teachers. Most affordable housing looks very boring, but our project offers a huge variation of housing sizes and configurations. The project is based on a prefab basis module of wood which surrounds a central core for a wet room or shower and technical installations and a staircase. Then the modules can be put together horizontally and vertically, like building blocks. We’re really looking forward to getting started. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the grammar and vocabulary exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Students write up a report about their discussions in Exercise 9. 8b Check students are clear that they are identifying the answers to the questions from Exercise 8a. • Students work with the same partner. They discuss whether they can remember what the answers to the questions were. • Play the recording again. Students check/note down their answers. 8c In the same pairs, students compare notes. Take class feedback. For weaker groups, you might let students check the audio script on page 176 to ensure they have the correct language. 1 trying to design an ideal place to meet human needs 2 Islamic architecture which deals with the problem of extreme heat built around a central courtyard which ventilates the rooms on the outside 3 affordable housing in Copenhagen 111 Architecture 0 0 7.3 BUILDING BRIDGES IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging This lesson looks at bridges around the world. Students read an article about important bridges and then discuss how these compare. Students then focus on idioms related to bridges and the use of prefixes with words in the text. Next, students look at passive structures in the text and focus on the meaning of these before practising them. Finally, students discuss two bridges, using information provided, and write a paragraph to describe one of them. Objectives By the end of the lesson, students will have: • extracted specific information and language items from a reading text • revised and/or extended their range of idioms and prefixes • revised/learnt about the past simple and present perfect passive 0 0 • discussed two different bridges and written about one of them. • Ask students to briefly discuss the second question in pairs. Elicit a few ideas from the class. 2 Read through the instructions with the class. Give students three minutes to read the introduction (the text in the right-hand column on page 70) and tick the reasons. • Students compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. 2, 4, 5 3 Read through the questions with the class and check they understand resist (prevent the effects of something), dimensions (length, width, etc.). • Give students five minutes to read the rest of the article and answer the questions. • Monitor to help with vocabulary (words students must know to answer the questions, e.g. harp) or ask students to use their dictionaries. • Students compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. 1 Charles Bridge 2 Akashi Kaikyo Bridge 3 Golden Gate Bridge 4 Alamillo Bridge 4 Critical thinking: Comparing features. Students Timings If short of time, set Exercise 5 as homework. Possible lesson break: after Exercise 6b. WARM-UP This activity introduces the topic of bridges and why people like/dislike them. • Focus students on the photos on pages 70–71 and ask if they like the designs of these bridges. • Ask students to think of a bridge they like or dislike and think about why. • Put students in pairs to talk about their bridges, giving information such as where it is, what river it crosses, how old it is, what it looks like, what it’s used for, as well as why they like/dislike it. Students should ask each other questions for further information. • Finally, ask a few students to tell the class about their bridges and why they like/dislike them. READING must use the knowledge learnt in the lesson so far to critically evaluate the different bridges. They must identify the specific features which are similar or different. • Give students two minutes to read the information on the bridges again. • Put students in pairs to discuss the similarities and differences. • Ask two or three students to tell the class what similarities and differences they talked about with their partner. You could take this opportunity to monitor for students’ use of comparative structures and phrases. In feedback, elicit corrections to some of the mistakes you noted and/or give students alternative ways of expressing themselves. The ability to compare and contrast is a key skill in many exams, when both writing and speaking (e.g. IELTS Writing task 2). VOCABULARY: idioms, prefixes 5 Elicit/Teach idiom (a group of words whose meaning is difficult to predict from its contents). • When students read the first paragraph of the article, ask them to underline all the idioms they can find. Tell them the idioms all contain bridge. 1 Focus students on the photos and ask them if they know anything about these bridges. They may already have touched on this in the warm-up. 112 Architecture 0 0 • Check that students have found four idioms and elicit them from the class. • Tell students to use the idioms to complete sentences 1–4. Remind them that they may need to change the form. • Ask students to compare with a partner before you check answers with the class. • In pairs, students try to express the idioms in other words. They can read the article for clues. • Elicit ideas from the class (see below). • For further practice, ask students to do Exercise V3–7 on page 139 in the Language reference. 1 burn my bridges 2 cross that bridge when we come to it 3 all water under the bridge 4 build (some) bridges Idioms in other words: 1 lose something I’ve got when I may still need it 2 deal with that when it happens 3 it’s already happened, let’s forget about it 4 make friends and form relationships 6a Do the first part of this activity with the whole class. Write each word on the board and underline the prefix. • Give students one minute to match the prefixes with the meanings. Check answers in class. 1 re- 2 in-, un- 3 mis- 4 over6bStudents do this activity individually and then compare with a partner. • In feedback, elicit/give the stress on the original words (e.g. important) and then on the word with the prefix (e.g. unimportant). • For further practice, ask students to do exercise V4–8 on page 139 in the Language reference. 1 unimportant 2 misunderstand 3 overcrowded 4 insignificant 5 redefine 0 6 insensitive Show students that prefixes are contained in the 0 GRAMMAR: the passive (2) 7a Give students three minutes to underline examples. • Ask students to compare answers with a partner. In feedback, check that they have underlined all the correct examples. • Give students a few minutes to find any unknown vocabulary from the examples. Then put them in pairs to discuss the form. • In feedback, write examples of the past simple and present perfect passive on the board and highlight the relevant parts to show the form. • Finally, remind students of the contractions of have (’ve) and has (’s) and then elicit/explain that adverbs generally come after the auxiliary (was, were, have or has), e.g. has never been. (Note: tragically is after been in the text because there are two adverbs in this sentence (occasionally is the other). It is a choice of style and makes the sentence easier to read.) Past simple passive: Examples: was destroyed, was built, (was) named (Note: The auxiliary was is not used here, but the form is still passive.), was opened Form: was/were + past participle Present perfect passive: Examples: has since been rebuilt, has … been tragically misplaced, has never been shattered, has been built Form: have/has + been + past participle If possible, reproduce the article so that all students can see it (perhaps on an interactive whiteboard or an overhead projector). When you check that students have underlined the correct examples, to highlight the form and for feedback in Exercise 6b, highlight the relevant parts of the text. 7bAsk students if they found any other passive forms in the text and elicit examples (including those in this exercise if possible). • Give students 30 seconds to match the sentences with the forms and elicit answers from the class. information about a word in a good dictionary. Understanding prefixes can be a big help when faced with unfamiliar vocabulary in reading and listening exams. Knowing what prefixes refer to can help students guess the approximate meaning. with the forms and elicit answers from the class. • Then elicit the form of each from the class and write it on the board (see answer key below). • For further information, ask students to read G2 in the Language reference on page 138. 1b 2a Form 1: was/were + being + past participle Form 2: to be + past participle 113 Architecture 0 0 8 Explain that the report is about complaints made by local residents during the building of a hotel. • Orient students to the text by asking them to brainstorm what the complaints might be and then quickly read the text to check. (The complaints in the text are noise and pollution). • Give students five minutes to do the activity. • Ask them to compare with a partner and use Exercise 7 and the Language reference for help. • Check answers with the class and ask students to give reasons. • For further practice, ask students to do Exercises G1,2–1 and G1,2–2 on page 139 in the Language reference. 1 have been received 2 was completing completed 3 was constructing being constructed 4 were delivering being delivered 5 were digging being dug 6 were making being made/made 7 was doing done 8 have been were closed 9 have been received 10 has now been built 11 is to be done 12 to be publish published 9a First, elicit/tell students that the subject in a passive sentence comes at the end of the sentence. • Students do this activity in pairs before you check answers with the class. • In feedback, ask students to underline the long subject expression (the strange-shaped building in the City of London) in sentence 2 and the known information (it was designed) in sentence 1. • For further information, ask students to read G3 on page 138 of the Language Reference. 1b 2a The bridge is supported by a pylon and cables which form the graceful shape of a harp: a this bridge has been built to: b The bridge was opened on 21 May: b It was opened to traffic: b SPEAKING AND WRITING 10 Ask students to look at the photo of their bridge. • Tell them that the information below the photo is about their bridge or about another student’s bridge. • Give them a few minutes to tick the pieces of information they think are about their bridge, using their dictionaries if necessary. • Then put students in pairs to tell each other the information they didn’t tick in the previous stage. • Students must not look at each other’s photos, but can ask questions. They should take notes while they are talking. • When students have all the information about their bridge, give them 20 minutes to write their paragraphs, using the notes they made in the previous stage and the information they ticked earlier. • Monitor to help with vocabulary and point out mistakes with the passive structures, if necessary. • Finally, take the paragraphs in for marking, paying particular attention to the use of passive structures. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the listening, vocabulary, reading and grammar exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Students write an account of a situation in their past using at least two of the idioms in Exercise 5. The Gherkin (or 30 St Mary Axe or the Swiss Re Tower) is a building in London, completed in 2004. It has a strange shape (curved sides and pointed at the top) and is sometimes lit in green at night. People think it looks like a small cucumber (a gherkin). 9bGive students a few minutes to do this activity individually, then ask them to compare answers with a partner. • Check answers with the class and elicit the long subject expression or the known information in each highlighted passive. • Give students a few minutes to find difficult words from the sentences in their dictionaries. • For further practice, ask students to do Exercise G3–3 on page 139 in the Language reference. Students do exercises G1,2–1, G1,2–2, G3–3, V3–7 and V4–8 on page 139 in the Language reference. 114 Architecture 0 0 7.4 SCENARIO: ON THE HORIZON IN THIS LESSON Lesson topic and staging This lesson focuses on the language of requirements. Students discuss facilities they expect to find at a good hotel. They are introduced to the scenario by reading an invitation to tender for a contract to design a luxury hotel. Next, students listen to architects talking about designing part of the hotel and focus on the 0 Key language. Finally, in the Task, students discuss and 0 finalise the facilities for the ground floor of the hotel. • Put students in small groups to do the activity. Get ideas from a few groups. 2 Focus students on the title of the text and check they understand Invitation to Tender (a company invites others to try to win a contract by putting together a proposal, including costs, etc.). • Ensure that students understand the meaning of facilities in this context (rooms/equipment/services provided by the hotel). • Give students one minute to quickly scan the text for the names of facilities. You might tell them that there are four mentioned. Check answers with the class. conference room, meeting rooms, seminar • Play the video. Students take notes. • Take class feedback. Get students to compare the answers with their earlier suggestions. Video script 12.3, answer key to Exercise 6 Sophia, George, Karim, Li 7 • S: OK, here’s an interesting question sent in by one of you. ‘Why do students plagiarise?’ Karim, what’s your opinion? K: I think, erm, often, it’s because they don’t have confidence in their own ability or ideas. So they feel safer using the ideas of other writers or speakers. Or it could be that the student’s studying in a very competitive environment. So they feel they have to copy the work of a well-known writer to get a good mark or high grade. S: What do you think, Li? L: Well, you know, some students are just too lazy to think about the material they’re reading. It’s too much effort to write notes in their own words. You look surprised, Sophia, but it’s a fact. S: Mmm, maybe there’s some truth in what you say, Li, but you’re being a bit harsh. It may be the case sometimes. George, any thoughts on this question? G: I think there’s a cultural angle. Students from certain parts of the world may not understand that they’re plagiarising when writing an essay. In their countries, perhaps they are expected to quote the ideas of great writers – it’s a sign of respect and good scholarship; and perhaps they don’t have to reference their sources. So, when they come to study in the UK, they don’t do it – and that’s very understandable. S: An interesting thought, George. Well, we’ve come to the end of our time. I’d just like to say that these days everyone uses the internet a lot for research, so it makes plagiarism very easy. But it’s risky to do it, or to plagiarise from other sources such as books, because there’s software available now to spot plagiarism, like Turnitin. Staff can check quickly and effectively if they feel someone has copied material. So the answer is, don’t plagiarise, you’ll probably be caught. Thanks, everyone. I hope you’ve enjoyed this round-table discussion on plagiarism and that you’ve learnt something from it. • 8 • • Turnitin has a vast database of academic materials, students’ previous essays and internet sources. It checks students’ essays against this database to see what percentage has been stolen without reference. Elicit what Turnitin is and if possible, show their website in class. If you do not have access to the internet, explain how the software works. In pairs, students discuss the question. In feedback, discuss ideas with the class. Students work in groups of three or four. They should read and discuss each question. Allow a maximum of eight minutes for the exercise. This exercise would work best if one student is the chair. If they feel the debate for one question is going on too long, they should take a vote. Take class feedback. Ask students to explain their answers. (P = Plagiarism; NP = Not plagiarism) 1 P 2 P 3 NP 4 P (source must be acknowledged) 5 NP 6 P 7 NP (as long as it is clearly common knowledge) 8 NP (but this is careless practice) 9 NP (if the teacher has agreed that you may do so) 10 NP 9 Read through the introduction and instructions. Ask students to find out the topic of these texts by quickly reading the original paragraph. • Give students eight minutes to read the four texts and discuss which are examples of plagiarism. • Go through answers with the class. Elicit the additional points made in the answer key below. Version A: Paraphrase. The writer has used his/her own words to paraphrase the original text. Version B: Plagiarism. There’s too much use of the original words and the information is in the same order as the original. Version C: Paraphrase. There’s a significant amount of rewriting of the original text. Version D: Plagiarism. There’s little attempt to change the order of ideas or the words used in the original text. WRITING SKILLS: an opinion article 10 Introduce this part of the lesson by eliciting what students think an opinion article is (a piece of writing, e.g. in a newspaper or magazine, which puts forward a particular argument). • In pairs, students have one minute to discuss the title and the question in the coursebook. 199 Technology 0 0 • Take brief feedback from three or four pairs. 11 Ask students to spend a couple of minutes reading the article before looking at the paraphrases. • Elicit from the class the main characteristics of a good paraphrase (accurately reflects what the writer says; changes the original language). • Give students ten minutes for this exercise. If they find it difficult, extend the time limit. • Go through the statements, asking in each case whether or not the paraphrase is accurate. If students have different opinions, let them argue and put forward their viewpoints. HOMEWORK OPTIONS Students do the reading, writing skills and academic collocations exercises for this lesson in MyEnglishLab. Students do Exercise 13. 1, 2, 4, 8, 9, 10 12a Stylistic features. Elicit the meaning of stylistic features (language, grammar and style choices which are found in particular types of text). Point out the examples. • In pairs, students try to find at least one example of each stylistic feature from the text. 1 dangers, tragic, dramatically, widespread, frightening, tremendous, excited 2 paras 2, 7, 8 (two examples in each) 3 paras 1, 2, 3, 5, 7 4 It’s (para 1), mustn’t (para 6), I’m (para 8) 5 screen-based, two-dimensional 6 our brains now under such a widespread attack 12b Students work with another pair to compare their answers. They should try and list as many examples as possible. You could make this into a competition with the groups of four, with one point available for each correct answer. 13 This type of writing task is typical of IELTS Writing Part two and the Write essay question in the PTE-A Writing test. • Students read the statement. Explain that they have to write in favour of this opinion (whether they actually agree with it or not). • Give them fifteen minutes to brainstorm ideas and organise these into paragraphs. • When writing, students should refer to the text on page 125 and the list of features in Exercise 12a to help them. Give them 30–45 minutes to write this. • If done in class, monitor to point out mistakes and help with vocabulary if necessary. • Encourage students to write a first draft and to check it for mistakes before writing a final one. • Take the articles in for marking, paying attention to positioning and plagiarism. 200 Technology 0 0 Extra Practice key 4 will have arrived; 5 won’t have left; 6 will have returned; Unit 1 1 1 a; 2 a; 3 a; 4 b; 5 b; 6 a 7 will have listened; 8 will have spent 2 1 Do you prefer chicken or fish? 2 Are you reading anything interesting at the moment? 3 Does this mobile phone belong 3 1 c; 2 f; 3 b; 4 h; 5 g; 6 e; (not used: a, d) 4 1 … look at the implications of …; 2 It has a serious to you? 4 Is your course getting more difficult? 5 Does disadvantage; 3 it’s a risky option; 4 it could be really bad …; anyone know the answer to this question? 6 Do you agree 5 That could be a big problem for us; 6 … have a huge impact on our sales (not used: consequence, disadvantages) with him? 7 Are the students learning about pollution this week? 8 Do your parents know how to send emails? 5 1 diagnosis; 2 authoritative; 3 reassuring; 4 sensitive; 3 1 wrote; 2 had sold; 3 has led; 4 has appeared; 5 attended; 6 decided; 7 had been; 8 completed; 9 has written; 10 lives 4 1 tricky; 2 vicious; 3 obvious; 4 problem; 5 dealing; 5 symptom; 6 knowledgeable; 7 complication; 8 sociable 6 1 f; 2 g; 3 c; 4 a; 5 d; 6 h; 7 b; 8 e Unit 5 1 1 d; 2 c; 3 e; 4 b; 5 a 6 situation; 7 deal; 8 solve 5 1 bump into; 2 stay in touch with; 3 track down; 4 confirm; 2 1 managed; 2 didn’t have to; 3 couldn’t; 4 in getting; 5 concept; 6 prove 5 couldn’t; 6 to find; 7 was able to; 8 could 6 1 b; 2 d; 3 c; 4 e; 5 a 3 1 couldn’t/wasn’t able to; 2 could/was able to; 3 didn’t have 7 1 e; 2 b; 3 c; 4 d; 5 f; 6 a to; 4 were able to; 5 had to; 6 succeeded Unit 2 1 1 b; 2 a; 3 a; 4 a; 5 b 4 1 recap; 2 sum; 3 confirm; 4 summarise; 5 summary; 2 1 ’ve looked at; 2 ’ve been reading/’ve read; 3 ’ve been 5 1 fogbound runway; 2 turbulence; 3 rough weather; 6 agreement; 7 covered worrying; 4 ’ve been living/’ve lived; 5 ’s been raining; 4 puncture; 5 tailback; 6 platform alteration 6 ’ve bought 6 car: airbag; anti-lock brakes; seat belt; traction control 3 1 he works; 2 if they are; 3 it is; 4 we can get; 5 it is; road: one-way street; speed cameras; traffic signals 6 she does law: speed limit 4 1 Could you tell me how much it costs? 2 I’d like to know 7 1 impact; 2 automated; 3 preliminary; 4 human; 5 distant; when the film starts. 3 Do you know whether she’s coming to 6 advances the party? 4 Can you tell me if this model is available? 8 1 d; 2 a; 3 f; 4 b; 5 c; 6 e 5 I wonder where they put the keys; 6 I’d like to know what causes earthquakes. Unit 6 1 1 b; 2 a; 3 a; 4 a 2 1 was sitting; 2 looked; 3 had been sitting; 4 had/had brought; 5 1 e; 2 a; 3 f; 4 c; 5 g; (not used: b, d) 5 was; 6 had been working 7 hadn’t had; 8 went; 9 brought; 6 1 inner; 2 vandalism; 3 crime; 3 detached; 4 blocks; 5 open; 10 sat; 11 was looking; 12 had/had brought 6 connections; 7 abandoned; 8 abandoned 3 A When I was a child I use used to read …; Then I would to 7 1 carbon emissions; 2 fossil fuels; 3 endangered species; read …; B Years ago I would used to live …; It would used to 4 natural habitat; 5 faces extinction; 6 of glaciers be …; C Didn’t you used use to live …; I would used to live 8 1 relatively; 2 deliberately; 3 comparatively; 4 mainly; …; D … get used to live living in the city …; He would 5 pensively; 6 normally thought think … Unit 3 1 1 a few; 2 students; 3 hardly any; 4 none of; 5 Several of; 4 1 … it’ll be a winner; 2 I think you’ll agree …; appeal to the 6 a little; 7 little; 8 Few; 9 much audience; 4 … it’s got tremendous potential; 5 … persuade to 2 Quidditch is a fictional sport invented by the author J.K. you, too 6 correct Rowling for the best-selling Harry Potter books. It is a ball 5 1 blog; 2 poetry; 3 biography; 4 short story; 5 psycho drama; game in which the players try to score goals. There are four 6 autobiography; 7 romance; 8 novel balls and two teams of seven players. Usually the players are 6 1 autobiographer; 2 poet; 3 biographer; 4 dramatist; 5 critic; wizards and witches and play the game by flying on their broomsticks. The goals are ring-shaped and are above the 7 1 awful, dreadful; 2 dull, tedious; 3 evocative language; 6 novelist ground. The object of the game is to score more goals than the opposing team. 4 heart-warming; 5 perspective Unit 7 1 1 has been stolen; 2 was being watched; 3 am being kept 3 1 the; 2 the; 3 The; 4 the; 5 –, – ; 6 the awake at night; 4 was given a watch; 5 is required; 6 can’t be explained 4 truly remarkable; 2 exceptional; extraordinary; outstanding; astonishing; There seems to be no end; undoubtedly; 2 1 was being established; 2 was given; 3 was built; 4 being admirable 1 d; 2 a; 3 c; 4 f; 5 h; 6 e; 7 g; 8 b allowed; 5 have been influenced; 6 have been constructed; 5 1 Steve; 2 Caroline; 3 Lucy; 4 David; 5 Miranda; 6 Walter 7 was/is inspired; 8 is being damaged; 9 to be restored 6 1 d; 2 b; 3 e; 4 a; 5 c 7 1 agility; 2 coordination; 3 flexible; 4 tolerant; 3 1 a; 2 b; 3 b; 4 a 5 determination; 6 make; 7 obsessive; 8 apart Unit 4 1 1 1b 2a; 2 1b 2a; 3 1a 2b; 4 1b 2a; 5 1b 2a 4 1 got; 2 through; 3 vital; 4 absolutely; 5 idea; 6 find; 7 offer; 8 need 5 1 ornate; 2 innovative; 3 ancient; 4 ugly 2 1 won’t have seen; 2 will have had; 3 won’t have finished; New Language Leader Upper Intermediate Extra Practice key 0 201 0 6 1 rebuilt; 2 damaged; 3 commission; 4 demolish; 5 designed; work; 7 … the team for which my brother plays football; 6 maintain; 7 restore; 8 construct 8 … the project on which we used to work together 7 1 d; 2 a; 3 c; 4 b 3 1 … the person about who whom I am talking; 2 This phone, 8 1 insoluble; 2 overcrowded; 3 revitalised; 4 misunderstood; that which was …; 3 … the place where I grew up in; 5 unimportant 4 Michael, who is very intelligent …; 5 The students, who are Unit 8 1 1 … allowed us to use …; 2 We stopped the car to look at …; from many, …; 6 … a woman that she never admits … 4 1 designed; 2 left; 3 standing; 4 recommended; 5 giving; 3 Would you consider give giving us …; 4 … I forgot locking 6 bought to lock …; 5 The door seems to be locked …; 6 … I’ll try send 5 1 c; 2 g; 3 d; 4 h; 5 f; 6 a; 7 e; 8 b sending him …; 7 Did you remember turning to turn off …; 6 1 get on with; 2 get used to; 3 broke up; 4 fall out with; 8 I always try to stay … 5 put up with; 6 get down to 2 1 1b, 2a; 2 1a, 2b; 3 1b, 2a; 4 1a, 2b 7 1 diplomatic; 2 conform; 3 indecisive; 4 conscientious; 3 1 has had his/her house searched; 2 am having my car 6 objectivity washed; 3 had his watch repaired; 4 have my hair cut; 8 1 c; 2 b; 3e; 4 d; 5a 5 has had her contract cancelled; 6 had our bags searched 9 1 psychiatrists; 2 case files; 3 assessment; 4 profiles / profiling; 4 1 d; 2 f; 3 a; 4 h; 5 b; 6 g; 7 e; 8 c 5 motive; 6 deduce 5 Across: 1 networking; 3 hierarchy; 5 curiosity; 7 creativity; 8 sensitivity; 9 collaboration Unit 11 1 1 was working; 2 had lived; 3 should see; 4 would see us Down: 2 intuition; 4 adaptability; 5 consensus; 6 influence there, the next/following day; 5 had been, his, their; 6 his, had received, the day before/the previous day 6 1 phenomenon; 2 profound; 3 cutting edge; 4 pushing the boundaries; 5 dynamic; 6 collaborate; 7 synergy 2 1 she doesn’t have a job …; 2 the weather there is always …; 3 they’re going to France …; 4 had been to a terrible school …; Unit 9 1 1 absolutely; 2 really; 3 absolutely; 4 really/very; 5 they had watched the final episode of Emergency! the night 5 slightly/extremely; 6 very; 7 good; 8 enormous/big; before; 6 pollution from cars causes … 9 interesting; 10 hotter; 11 starving; 12 upset 3 1 warned; 2 refused; 3 apologised for; 4 offered; 5 persuaded; 2 Bridget Riley is probably the most …; These are works which usually feature patterns …; … she skilfully used black and 6 agree 4 1 to carry my case; 2 getting married so young; 3 me not to white …; Her first big exhibition was in London in 1962; … buy anything in that shop; 4 for shouting at me; 5 me to learn the guitar viewers frequently complained …; she used colour imaginatively; In the late 1980s, she began to experiment … 5 Suggested answers: 1 Why is Cambridge worth seeing? 3 1 is mainly; 2 opened the envelope carefully; 3 In 2004 I; 2 It is an important educational, cultural and business centre. 4 usually get home; 5 certainly know; 6 have often seen; 3 Facilities for tourists are getting better and better each year; 7 did you get there; 8 finished his essay quickly 4 Its buildings, parks and countryside make it a beautiful 4 1 … it could really upset …; 2 But it wouldn’t if we …; place to live; 5 The university is becoming more and more 3 That may be true …; 4 … take into account the …; 5 might start doing …; 6 to do something if we … popular with international students; 6 What are the main historical sights of the city? 5 1 artist, art lover, collector, critic, painter, sculptor; 6 1 language; 2 institutions; 3 cuisine; 4 religion; 5 the arts; 2 abstract, contemporary, realist, modern; 3 controversial, 6 architecture 7 rituals/traditions; 8 climate groundbreaking; thought-provoking, 4 preview, 7 1 d; 2 a; 3 e; 4 b; 5 f; 6 c retrospective; 5 masterpiece 8 1 valuable; 2 responsible; 3 international; 4 multicultural; 6 1 moving; 2 painfully;3 useless; 4 criticised; 5 highly; 5 misunderstanding; 6 antisocial; 7 predates; 8 timeless 6 entirely; 7 totally; 8 highly; 9 totally; 10 different; Unit 12 1 1 d; 2 a; 3 c; 4 c; 5 c; 6 b; 7 c; 8 b 11 wrong; 12 utterly 7 1 gripping; 2 heart-breaking; 3 dreadful; 4 monotonous; 2 1 If I’ll go …; 2 … we are were rich …; 3 … if I can could play 5 critical; 6 outstanding … ; 4 As long as you would look …; 5 ... if she would bring brings …; 6 … won’t wouldn’t it be … Unit 10 1 1 the man I met yesterday; 2 the DVD player which/that 3 1 h; 2 c; 3 f; 4 b; 5g; 6a; 7e; 8 d doesn’t work very well; 3 is the woman whose house was 4 1 would have talked; 2 had done; 3 had had; 4 would be; destroyed in the earthquake; 4 sister, who is a doctor, lives in an old house/sister, who lives in an old house, is a doctor; 5 1 … as much as money; 2 … not in good shape …; 3 It’s true 5 had gone; 6 wouldn’t have been what you say …; 4 these objections plenty; 5 ; 6 That’s a fair 5 the computer game I told you about; 6 course, which began in September, is very difficult/course, which is very difficult, began in September point …; 7 … I think you’ll agree …; 8 6 1 appliances; 2 device; 3 apparatus; 4 equipment; 5 gadget 2 1 … the problem on which he’s working; 2 … a cause in 7 1 user-friendly; 2 state-of-the-art; 3 durable; 4 obsolete; which she really believes; 3 … the bill about which we 5 handy; 6 environmentally friendly disagreed; 4 … the course for which they applied; 5 … the 8 1 unable; 2 inequality; 3 dislikes; 4 inaccurate; 5 mistrust; one in which we often stayed; 6 … the architect for whom I 6 unnecessary; 7 inefficient; 8 inappropriate New Language Leader Upper Intermediate Extra Practice key 0 202 0